Images (2)
दस्तावेज़
| id |
id
28276097
|
|---|---|
| contentType |
contentType
document
|
| source |
source
import
|
Source image fields (6)
Extracted text
OCR Page 1 of 2DIARY
Book 152
November 20 - November 24, 1938
Regraded Uclassified
- A -
Book
Page
Automobile Tires
See Bids, Collusive or Tie
B I I
Bank of America
HMJr, Douglas, and Crowley confer concerning
proposal to delist Transamerica securities -
11/23/38
152
406
Bids, Collusive or Tie
Automobile Tires: Oliphant memorandum and results of
action by Department of Justice - 11/23/38
422
Brazil
See South America
Business Conditions
Haas memorandum on situation for week ending 11/19/38
86
- C -
China
Conversations at Changsha between British Ambassador
and Chiang Kai-shek as reported by Captain McHugh,
Assistant Naval Attache - 11/20/38
1
Report from American Embassy, London, on report on
British financial assistance for China 11/20/38
243
HMJr transmits to FDR (at Warm Springs) material used
at conference with Chen and Chao (Director of
National Reilways) - 11/22/38
329
Civilian Conservation Corps
Change in Uniforms: Peoples' progress report - 11/21/38
242
- F -
Fiscal and Monetary Advisory Board
Meeting; present: HMJr, Eccles, Bell, Ruml, Hanes,
Taylor, Haus, White, Currie, and McReynolds -
11/21/38, 10:15 A.M.
102
a) Memorandum: "Railroad Equipment -
A Possible Bottleneck" - 11/21/38
158
b) Memorandum on existing expenditure programs
financed without use of direct public debt
or which might be so financed - 11/21/38
160
Meeting to consider possible Works Progress Administration
lay-offs - 11/21/38, 4:15 P.M
164
a) Drafts of letter to FDR
181
Meeting - 11/22/38
276
Regraded Uclassified
- G -
Book Page
Germany
Resume of revenues - 11/20/38
152
24
Discussion of total debt as reported by American
Embassy, Berlin - - 11/23/38
386
Great Britain
See Stabilization
- H -
Hungary
Report by Royall Tyler acknowledged by HMJr - 11/23/38.
428
- J -
Japan
Embassy asks that interview be arranged with Arakawa,
Financial Commissioner at London, Paris, and
Washington - 11/23/38
420
- L -
Latin America
See South America
Life Insurance Companies
Harris-Hadley memorandum on cash position - 11/21/38
232
- P -
Peacetime Price Control Committee
See Purchasing, Government
Purchasing, Government
Peacetime Price Control Committee: Peoples' memorandum
on meeting held November 18th - 11/21/38
247
a) Peoples' memorandum on peacetime price control
250
b) Chart showing organization; functional control
of prices
255
- R - -
Refugees
Bowman sends copy of McBride report on opportunities for
agricultural colonies in Central America - - 11/21/38
18
Copy of Bowman's letter to FDR - 11/21/38
46
HMJr's letter to FDR concerning discussion with Bowman -
11/21/38
68
Buell (Foreign Policy Association) transmits copies of
letters from staff member in Latin America - 11/21/38
196
Outline of plan for refugee problem - - 11/23/38
408
Ezekiel memorandum on refugee problem - 11/23/38
414
Regraded Uclassified
- S -
Book Page
Secret Service
Report from Cole, Examiner of Questioned Documents,
concerning three typewritten documents and whether
they were prepared on same typewriter - 11/21/38
152
241
South America
Proposed letter (not sent) to FDR explaining view
that rendering economic assistance to Latin American
countries is one of two directions in which United
States can effectuate foreign policy - 11/21/38
256
Brazil:
Conference with regard to possibilities of financial
agreement; present: HMJr, Taylor, White, Lochhead,
and Penteado (Attache at Brazilian Embassy) -
11/22/38
269
Loans under consideration by Export-Import Bank
372
HMJr explains to Welles that United States Treasury
will not enter conference of Secretaries of Treasuries
of North and South America - 11/22/38
354
Speed, William
Sulzberger asks HMJr's assistance; Speed involved as
bank director of Louisville National Bank - 11/24/38.
403
Stabilisation
Great Britein:
Conference before further talk with Bewley; present:
HMJr, Taylor, White, and Lochhead - 11/22/38
361
a) Conference with Bewley regarding sterling
exchange rate - 11/22/38
316
Memorandum from British Embassy to United States
Treasury indicating views of His Majesty's
Government in view of question raised by Sayre
on exchange value of pound sterling (11/17/38)
355,357,358
- T -
Tires, Automobile
See Bids, Collusive or Tie
Transamerica
See Bank of America
Tyler, Royall
Report on Hungary acknowledged by HMJr - 11/23/38
428
Regraded Uclassified
- U -
Book
Page
Unemployment Relief
HMJr and Hopkins again confer on emergency -
11/21/38
152
36
a) HMJr wishes Hopkins to see draft of letter
to FDR concerning "national emergency"
Weetings of Fiscal and Monetary Committee to consider
possible Works Progress Administration lay-offs -
11/21/38
102,164,276
a) Drafts of letter to FDR.
181
Expenditures to date by Works Progress Administration
and United States Housing Authority, and consequent
situation of Works Progress Administration, discussed
at 9:30 meeting - 11/22/38
262
Drafts of proposed letter from FDR to D. W. Bell re-
apportioning Works Progress Administration funds
because of "unforeseen extraordinary emergencies" -
11/22/38
323
a) Draft OK'd by Oliphant and Bell
324
b) Instructions to McKay for delivery - 11/22/38
328
United States Housing Authority
See Unemployment Relief
- W -
Works Progress Administration
See Unemployment Relief
Regraded Uclassified
1
Report No. 10-38
20 November, 1938
STRICTLY CONFIDENTIAL
THE CONVERSATIONS AT CHANGSHA BETWEEN THE
BRITISH AMBASSADOR AND CHIANG KAI-SHEE
1. The recent talks at Changshe on November 4th and 6th
Between the British Ambassador and Chiang Kai-shek were not,
as had been generally rumored In the press, the medium for the
former to convey to the latter peace terms from the Japanese,
The shoe WAS, in fact, quite on the other foot. Chiang Kai-shek
did most of the talking, na 18 indicated in the Aide Memoire
of their first conversation, a. verbatim copy of which 18 appended
to this report.
2. Although I had felt that Chiang WSE still adament on the
question of continuing resistance and knew in advance that Sir
Archibald's visit was the result of an invitation which the Gener-
allasimo had extended to him during the course of their last meet-
ing at Hankow late in July, I myself was led to believe by the
persistent reports coming over the radio news broadcasts just
prior to his arrival at Changeha that he might be the purveyor of
terms. It was obvious that If Japan could not arrange terms after
the almost simultaneous capture of Hankow and Canton, there were
no key points or centers in the field ahead of them the capture of
which could be used either to bring pressure on the Chinese or
which could be publicized in Japan as the "final victory" of the
war. I was led to the further suspicion of possible peace efforts
by the Ambessador, as his entourage approached Changeha from
Kunming, by secretive hints from my friend, the Commanding Officer
of HM8 "Sandpiper", that he had received very important desptaches
for H.E. which contained amazingly easy peace proposals, I gather-
ed that either the British Embassy in Shanghai or Tokyo was forward-
ing these, the general nature of which included a ninety nine year
lease on Manchoukuo, demilitarization of China north of the Yellow
River, complete withdrawal of Japanese troops to the coast (with
certain conditions) and agreement to negotiate with the Kuomintang
conditional upon certain changes in personnel and policy.
3. I later discussed these points with Sir Archibald direct.
He laughed and said they were what his friend Mr. Tani (the Japanese
Minister At Large in Shanghai) had frequently spoken to him about,
When he had asked Mr. Tani, however, if he might discuss these terms
with the Generalissimo and present them B8 & formal proposal, Mr.
Tani had benten a hasty retreat, saying they were only his own ideas
end not officially approved. (obviously lacking the Army's con-
currence)
4. The British Ambassador arrived at Changsha on the evening
of November 3rd accompanied only by a young private secretary and
his new Military Attache, Lt. Col. C. N. Spear. At the invitation
of the Captain of HMS "Sandpiper", I was among those who met him.
Mr. Donald had arrived that afternoon from Nan Tuch (Heng Shan),
where the Generalissimo was staying, to arrenge the talks, The
Generalissimo end Madame Chiang came up the same night and went to
the private ville of the Governor of Hunan on the outskirts of the
city. Chiang Kai-shek had just returned from a trip to Nenchang by
car where he had gone for A military conference. (He and his party
had flown from Hankow to Hengyang when they evacuated on the night
of October 24th and he went to Manchang soon afterwards.) Bir
Archibald expressed pleasure at seeing me when he arrived and
immediately inquired in Mr. Donald's presence if we might have A
chat while he WELLS there. Mr. Donald had arranged for him to lunch
with the Generalissimo on the following day, November 4th, and
to have his first talk with the Generalissimo in the course of the
afternoon. Sir Archibald theroupon suggested that I come the day
following.
Regraded Uclassified
-2-
5. 1 met Mr. Donald the next morning while he wha writing
to secort the Ambassador to lunch. Re discussed in general the
failure of the British to live up to their commitmente na A
member of the League of Nations and help China; their silence
over the oapture of Canton and the portents of that action to
Hongkong: and asserted that it was idle to criticize the Chinese
methods of fighting the war- He said they were doing it their
own way because they are Chinese, but that what England and the
U.S.A. had to decide was whether they wished to see China go under
and with that event lose their prestige and potential trade In
China, or preserve these by helping China now. He was convinced
that if Great Britain are nothing about Canton, her ailent ac-
quieaence would have serious reperoussions on her prestige else-
where, especially in India.
6, I BBW 51P Archibald the following noon, November 5th,
just before lunch, but any opportunity to speak with him privately
about his talk the any before was forestalled by the entry of Lt.
Col. Buear and the nost. He therefore only remarked in general
about what had transpired saying that Chiang Kai-shek had asked
him some very emberrassing questions 8.8 to what London whe going
to Ro about Canton. Air raid alarms prevented me from seeing Mr.
Donald this date, the foreign residences being on en island in
the river and the Chinese soldiers along the banks having the d1s-
eable habit of taking pot shots at anything which moved during
on air alarm. (If one could have been sure they were aiming at him,
15 would not have mattered, but the danger lay in the strey shots.
7. I met Mr. Donald the following morning, November 6th, by
croasing the river before breakfast to beat the alarms. He re-
marked, however, that my inability to oross on the previous day
had not mattered as he had been busy all morning writing the Aide
Kemoire of the conversations between the Ambassador end the General-
issimo of the day before. He asked if I had seen the Ambassador
and If he had told me about his talk. When I replied that the Am-
basendor had mentioned the general tone of his talk, but had been
precluded by other guests from discussing 1t, Mr. Donald dilated
a bit on the fact that the Generalissimo had bluntly nsked London
what they were going to do. Mr. Donald discoursed again on the
possible results to British trade and influence If they failed to
not and then advised me to see Sir Archibald again and ascertain
If he would give me the full details of the Aide Memoire. He
characterized it 28 A very important document which he felt Washington
should Also see, but and he d1d not feel free to reveal it without
permission MS my Ambassador would naturally resent any such liberty
If he were similarly placed. I informed him that I was to have
lunch that noon with the Ambassador and would endeavor to obtain n
chat with him later when I felt reasonably sure he would grant the
necessary permission.
8. Mr. Donald then informed me that if the democracies fail
Chine at this time, she obviously would have to turn elsewhere and
that the question of her policy for the coming year would be the
chief point on the agenda at the forthcoming meeting of the Central
Executive Committee of the Kuomintang which would take place in
Chungking early in December, I inquired if there were any chance
of 6 turn toward Russia and nsked if during the intervening period
after we had left Hankow at the beginning of August until our re-
turn just before the fall of the city the Russions had presented
any quid pro quo to the Generalissimo In return for increased ald
from them. (Both Mr. Donald and Medame Chiang had repeatedly denied
to me in the past that this had ever occurred, saying that China
had paid for All of the help she had received from Moscow.) He
replied that the Russians now had something over one hundred planes
at Lanchow and that they had approached the Generalissimo shortly
before the decision was made to leave Hankow with the proposal that
Regraded Uclassified
-3-
they would make not only those, but ss many more available to him
If he would agree to continue resistance against Japan. Chiang had
snorted and replied that he intended to continue resistance whether
they helped or not. (It seems pertinent to remark here, as I have
stated previously, that Chiang Kal-shek has been consistent from
the very beginning in this respect and in his policy to carry on the
our to & finish. He has taken the point of view that his cause 18
just one and that sister democracies could not TAil ultimately to
come to Chinn's assistance, He has spurned all suggestions of help
with conditions attached - viz: the British suggestion last Spring
that he remove Dr. Rung.)
9. Mr. Donald then stated that if China turned away from the
democracies he thought it would be toward Germany and the totall-
tarian states: that they had already given far more material aid
to China through their barter agreement and military advisors than
any other country and that the barter system not only had great
potentiality in the post-war reconstruction of China, especially
since China would have no money, but that the Germans had proved
themselves peculiarly adept nt doing business with the Chinese.
I inquired how this could be reconciled with the Berlin-Tokyo agree-
ment and where China would stand vis-a-vis Japan in such an event.
He then revealed one of the most important points in the Aide Memoire,
namely, that the Generalissimo had always known and now had especially
good renson to believe that he could get very easy peace terms from
Japan anytime he would agree to the exclusion of the British from
China. He said he ha^ already advised Chiang, however, that If it
came to that point, he should make terms through Berlin rather than
directly with Japan. He reiterated his belief that A German-Japanese
economic alliance would have 8. genuine chance of success in develop-
Ing China after the war. (I had already discussed with Mr. Rogers
In Hongkong sometime ago the Dossibilities of an extension of the
German barter system on A grand scale to China, but from the point
of view of weaning Germany away from Japan and effecting some kind
of understanding with England, France and other states. He had ex-
pressed serious concern over the potentiality of this weapon of
Hitler's, saying that he was intimately acquainted with Dr. Schaot
and respected his ability- It 1E & question worthy of serious thought,
particularly if 1t. includes Japan and excludée the rest of us.
10. I then went to lunch with the British Ambrasador and
immediately afterward nsked if I might have a word alone. He readily
assented and took me to his bedroom where he walked up and down and
talked without restraint for over an hour. I recorded the following
memorandum of this conversation immediately afterward:-
11. I opened the conversation by recalling to him what he had
told no the any before of Chiang Kai-shek having faced him with the
falt accompli of Centon: mentioned 8 conversation I had had with
Regers over the Dossibility of weaning Germany away from Japan in
some sort of joint economic agreement with other nations; of the
latent possibilities in the barter system; of the belief held by
Donald and Captain Stennes that Germany might assist Japan in China
by this means; and inquired what he thought of the possibility of
China turning away from the democracies completely and resching an
understanding with the totalitarian states.
12. Sir Archibald said that he too had been giving serious
thought to this question. He said he had just been engaged All
morning in preparing 2% draft message to London. He said that in
his conversation the day previous with Chiang Kai-shek, he had
asked Chiang frankly for a statement of his military position end
his possibilities for continuing resistance, telling Chiang It WELL
much more desirable to get it from him direct than to have to guess
at It, The Ceneralissimo replied that he now had sixty divisions
Regraded Uclassified
north of the river, sixty south thereof and B like number in reserve.
(The Ambassador asked me what strength these would represent and
neemed surprised when I told him that they averaged five to eight
thousand effectives before going into the line and the figures given
undoubtedly included many units which by now were more skeletons.)
Ohiang had stated that these would soon be reorganized for active
guerrilla warfare and that his policy would be to present to the
Japanese a constant threat of attack while continuing general realst-
ance, always giving way where necessary to avoid too severe lossee
and ultimately to choose his own ground for battle. The Generalissimo
had said he had supplies for more than B year yet Rt the 'present
state of wastage' and expected to continue his program of resistance
unsbated.
13. The Ambassador said that Chiang had spoken with great
frankness and with considerable agitation on his position vis-n-vie
Great Britain. He stated that he had held China together nll these
months on the plen that aid would be forthooming eventually from
the democratic countries, notably Great Britain, and bluntly asked
for a showdown and a simple "Yes" or "No" on the question. He put
it up to the Ambassador that if China were not going to obtain aid
from Great Britain and the U.S.A she obviously would be faced with
turning elsewhere and asked Clark-Lerr what he would do If he were
similarly placed. The Ambassador told me he obviously had to agree.
14, Sir Archibald smid he had then asked Madame Chiang, who
WAS translating, If the Generalissimo would not come out frankly
with what was in his heart. Madame Chiang inquired If he really
wanted the truth and the Ambassador replied that they would be much
better off to have it out then and there. Chiang Kni-shek became
visibly excited At the question and said that Great Britain might
08 well understand that they were at the parting of the ways. If
Great Britain chose to help China, she would have China forever;
If she rejected this final appeal then China would turn completely
away from Great Britain and never have anything more to do with
her; that he himself would never consult Clark Kerr on A single
question. The Genernlissimo added that the Chinese have long
memories and that if Great Britain forsook China at this time, they
would never forget it and would make them pay for it ultimately.
15. The Ambassador said that the problem was c. very serious
one and that he was p.t n. loss A8 to how best to cope with it. Re
recalled to me his previous efforts at obtaining a loan for China
to support the currency and said he had gotten his Foreign Office
Treasury where he had been blocked by Sir John Simon. He said
completely with him on the question, but had been unable to remarked get the
that I no doubt knew the latter's attitude toward Japan. He
that Sir John Ilved in absolute fear of Japan and was constantly
who constantly sent home despatches about the power of Japen. Sir
encouraged in this by his colleague in Tokyo (Sir Robert Craigie)
Archibald said that he and Craigie differed absolutely on the
question of the effect of the present war upon Japan; that he felt
the war WAB a tremendous strain on Japen which sooner or Inter must
produce & general breakdown (he said he felt this might come with-
in another six to eight months time) while Craigie kept insist-
ing that Japan was in no such danger and had not yet felt the strain
of the war to any extent. Clark Kerr and that he thought our rep-
resentatives in Japan lived too cloistered an existence to know the
true state of affoirs there.
16. Sir Archibald remarked that the loan involved WAS A
relatively small amount and that he #88 now engaged in drafting
Kai-shek had mentioned the fact that if Great Britain could only
despatch to try and re-open the question. He BAID that Chiang
give him something tangible to show the country such as A loan to
support the currency he could satisfy them. Clark Kerr was not
sanguine RB to the prospects of & loan, however. He remarked that
T. V. Boong had told him during B recent conversation in Hongkong
Regraded Uclassified
-5-
that China was endeavoring to establish n stabilization fund
of six million pounds sterling to which the Chinese banks
would contribute half and had msked if the British banks would
contribute the balance. (Rogers conceived this idea in Hongkong in
September while I was there.) The Ambassador said that he had
first approached the Hongkong and Shanghai Banking Corporation
who, while favorably inclined, had refused because there was no
ample security for their depositors and bondholders. He had then
referred the matter to the Bank of England from whom he had not
yet rotten an answer, He remarked that he had quite understood
the Hongkong and Shanghei Bank's position, but that the Bank of
England could afford to be sentimental and take B. chance occasionally
DE they had done in Austria in 1922 where they had gotten away with
it. He stated that he had proposed the original loan to China as
the first step of e long-view policy with the second step to be
taken next year if the situation were still favorable: that if it
proved otherwise it would always be possible to step Aside and that
the loan itself would always be emply justified as an investment
in good-will.
17. The Ambassador then told we the following in strict con-
fidence. He said that last July while fie was having dinner one night
with the Chinng Kai-sheke along with Hall Patch and others of his
Mineton, Madame asked him to step outside and speak to the Generallusim
nione for n minute, She warned him to listen cerefully to what the
Cenerolissimo said ns he had rehearsed it and that she had never
before known him to make such a statement to a foreigner,
18. Chaing Kai-shek had commenced (speaking in short sen-
tenoes, whereas he usually is hard to interpret because of his
length) by saying that he had known several British Ambassadors.
Se spoke well of Lampson, whom he had liked. Cadogan he had also
liked although he found him less sympathetic and lacking in
imegination. Knatchbull-Hugesson he had not chred for go much,
Sut he, Clark Kerr, the Generalissimo had found by for the most
understanding of them all, Chiang Kai-shek therefore desired to
know if Clerk Kerr would be willing at times to out saide his
official rank and advise him on matters no he might request.
Clark Kerr said he himself uttered a lot of deprecatory sputter-
1n5 during this effusive outburst by the Ceneralissimo and assured
him The would be most glad to comply with the request. As they
walked out Madame Chiang again impressed upon him how absolutely
unique and unusual this action had been on the part of her husband,
19. A few days Inter the Genernlissimo invited him to onll
first request. He thereupon asked Clark Kerr if the latter thought
and, referring to this incident, said he would like to make his
the Chinese Government needed reorganising and, if BO, what would
he suggest. The Ambassador said he turned to Madame Chinng and
neked if he really could reply frankly. She urged him to do so,
He then told Chiang KAI-shek that he thought reorganization very
meriously needed. He said If he were Chiang Kai-shek his first
dove would be to call all members of the family to Hankow, In-
cluded Madame Sun Ynt-sen, end to bring the Young Harshal out of
retirement, He would then line them up and present a solld front
to the Japanese ('have all of them twenk their noses at the
have a drastic result in Japan. He recommended that Dr. Kung be
Japanese', as he expressed 1t). He BR1d he thought this would
retained AS President of the Executive Yuan (remarking aside to
me that he did this to save Kung's face, but placed him where he
could do no harm). He suggested that Madame Sun be made Minister
of Cooperatives or something similar (telling me he purposely
included her to take care of the Communist element) and strongly
recommended Madame Chiang AB Minister of Foreign Affairs. (Although
Regraded Uclassified
the foregoing sounds semi-jocular, he related it in all
meriousness.)
20. Be then went on to recommend to the Generalissimo
that he reorganize the entire Government along the lines of the
membership of the People's Polition1 Convention (which he said he
thought had been very well chosen) and that he pointed out to
Chiang Keishek the need for placing men according to ability and
qualification rather than giving all of the plums to former com-
rades and old cronies, The Ambassador said his suggestions met
with A chilly response and obviously did not meet with the ap-
proval of the Genernlissimo who remarked that If l'ademe Sun ceme
to Hankow she would only be R mouthpiece for the Communiste. The
Ambassador said he had talked with Madame Sun in Hongkong; that
he liked her best of the whole family; and that she had expressed
her desire to go to Hankow If the Generalissimo would only invite
her,
P1. The Ambassador promised to show me the despatch he was
drafting to the Foreign office concerning the Aide Memoire and
readily assented to my request to be permitted to read the Aide
Memoire. His copy WAS at the moment out on the gunboat. He
neked me to return in a day or two to see the despatch, remarking
that he actually had no business doing this, He said he had re-
cently proposed that the British, French and U. S. Governments
should make separate but RS nearly identical as possible declara-
tione affirming their support of China. The French, be stated,
had indicated their willingness to do 80, but the proposal W&B
frowned on and killed by the U.S.A. He inquired who our present
counsellor of Embassy in London WAS and said he understood this
officer had been instrumental in it. The Ambassador termed the
attitude of his own government toward the recent situation "con-
temptible". He seid he un erstood the genoral limitations which
restrained the U.S.A. from taking direct action, but inquired if
I knew whether this were further constricted or aggravated by
any particular individuals in Washington. I denied any such
knowledge. The Ambassador and his party had dinner with the
Generalissimo that same evening, but na the perty was fairly
large, nothing further transpired.
22. The following morning, November 7th, I met Mr. Donald
as be while going for a talk with the Ambassador. When I told him
I had received permission to see the Alde Memoire, he pulled his
00DY out of his pocket and loaned it to ne while he went to keep
his engagement. He likewise conveyed to me an invitation from
l'adame Chiang to come to lunch the following day. I returned to
my quarters at once and made the attached copy of the Aide Memoire
23. Lunch the next day WAS B simple family effair served on
a card table with only Mr. Donald in addition to the Chiange.
Vadame Chieng told me before lunoh that the Generalissimo had
been told that I with acquainted with what he had said to the
British Ambassador. The Generalissimo appeared looking quite
fresh and showing no signs of the strain he had exhibited during
the latter days at Hankow, I have seen him numerous times in the
past 30 there were no formalities between us.
24. I let him open the conversation and he started by neking
me when the new U. 8, battleships would be completed and If they
would be larger and more numerous than those being built by Japen.
He appeared elighily surprised and disappointed when I told him
they probably would not be 1sunched until 1942 or 1943. (I had
to gliess nt this AB I have been out off from the news B. good deal
Regraded Uclassified
recently. but did not want to give him eny encouragement on this
Boore.) I told him I did not know what Japan's building program
10, but that I doubted if they could afford to compete with us.
He then asked how much longer President Roosevelt had to serve
and seemed to brighten when I told him two years. He maked if
the President could be re-elected and nodded pleasantly when I
told him there wes no legal ber to this, He inquired if I thought
public opinion against Japan WAB growing in the U.S.A. and nodded
understandingly when I told him that I thought it WAS, but added
that its development WAB gradual and that the American public
naturally were more interested in their own affairs and were orimar-
Lly desirous of peace.
25. I then repeated briefly what Clark Kerr had told me of
the Genermlissimo's military program and inquired if this were
wesentially correct. He agreed except to amend the part about
sixty divisions north of the river and sixty more south thereof.
Be seld that WRB roughly the present distribution, but that he pro-
posed to use sixty east of the two railway lines, sixty to the
west thereof and the balance in reserve under reorganization. He
explained that A great many of these divisions had been in the
field for several months and that some were now reduced to the
strength of only one company, These had to be pulled out for rest
and peorganization while others hed to be brought up, Other than
the mention of the railway lines, he did not mention B. front as euch,
but merely asserted that he intended to keep the Japanese under the
constant threat of attack in all arene, He spoke of the guerrilla
tactics which had been carried out all of these months and sAid the
Chinese would depend on these rather than sucrifice their strength
in trying to hold any particular point. Re appeared to no to be
very confident in this respect and I believe he 1s imbued with the
experience he had in fighting the Communists for years.
26. I had expected the Genernlissimo to ask me questions about
what we were going to do to helo him and when he failed to do 80,
I referred to what he hed said to the British Ambassedor and in-
quired If I were to Infer that this noplied with equal force to the
U.S.A. He "88 celled away from the table just as I finished putting
the question, but na he ΓoBe to leave he replied that he thought that
hAd better wait until be could discuss it directly with my
27. I walked for an hour after lunch in the garden with Madame
Chinng and Mr. Donald. I asked Madame Chinne for an explanation
of the Canton debacle which would explain or refute the assumption
of the general public that there had been n "sell=out". She denied
vicorously that there had been any ribery. She referred me to the
Generalissimo's public statement of October 30th and added that
Yu Han-mou had failed to make the proper disposition of his troops
because his staff officers and troop leaders were inferior. She
mentioned that A statement in regard to this had been included in
the Generolissimo's public announcement, but Mr. Donald interrupted
to any that "we" (presumably he and Hollington Tong) had cut out
that part. She then went on to say that this plus the fact that
the British had failed to intervene had produced the present
situation, but added that they were now fighting to recover the
lost ground and said the Generalissimo had had a telegram just the
previous evening that Samshui had been re-captured. She denied that
the Japanese had made any progress along the reilway north of Canton.
She stated that the Generalissimo W&B receiving hundreds of telegrams
from overseas Chinese demanding that China continue to resist Japan
and calling for the punishment of Yu Hen-mou and Wu Teh-chen. She
did not, however, enlarge on the latter point.
Regraded Uclassified
-0-
28. I naked point-blank how the Generalissimo could adopt
the alternative be had mentioned to the British Ambassador of
making eney terms with Japan if he would completely renounce the
British. I pointed to the widespread feeling against Jepan and
the fact that the Japanese army exists na a physical enemy and
inveder. She are not blink an eye, but replied simply that she
thought the people would do whatever the Generalissimo told them
WAS best when the time came, I then referred to the 1924-1930 era
when the anti-foreign feeling was so high; contrasted it with
recent months when the people had been 60 friendly to foreignere;
and Asked If officials would take the lead in turning the people
against Grent Britain in order to make possible a peace treaty with
Japan. I added that the comparison of the two periods had led me
to believe that public opinion in China could be influenced very
easily by officials. She dodged the question by saying that she
and the Generalissimo had worked very hard for a long time to bring
about R friendly feeling toward foreigners. I asked again About
the questions which had been presented to the British Ambassador
and inquired if they did not apply with equal force to the U.S.A.
She reiterated that any actual statement on the question should
await B. meeting between the Generalissimo and my Ambassador, but
and that we "might well consider the questions ssked Great Britain
R.B. the handwriting on the wall".
29, I Baw the British Ambassador again that afternoon for
another long talk. He asked if I had seen the Aide Memoire. When
I told him I had, he stated he had radioed All of it to London ex-
cept the reference to Hainen Island which be thought was super-
fluove and weakened the argument. He said he did not desire to give
London any point on which to quibble. He apologized for not being
able to show me his despatch which he said had Just gone to the
ship to be coded, but told me it followed the lines of what we hAd
discussed the previous time, He hended me from his table another
despatch which he had just drafted in which he had outlined briefly
the Generaliseimo's general attitude and determination to continue
resistance.
30, When I referred to the points in the Aide Memoire AS an
"Ultimatum" he picked me up immediately. He emphasized that there
had been no questions of an ultimatum on the part of Chiang Kai-shek
during their conversation and that he himself, after reading the
Aide Memoire, had sent B second telegram to London to emphasise this.
He said that Chiang had out the questions simply as statements of
fact to which he desired an immediate answer; that Chiang had stated
that he had always desired friendly relations with Grent Britein
and up to the present had been confident that Great Britain would
help China, but that the time had arrived when he had to have some-
thing tangible to show the people. if it were only R. loan to support
the currency. When Chiang had stated that he had 'several other
courses open' if London failed him, the Ambassador had Asked if
Russia were one of these. Chiang had silently essented, but had
offered no further information on this point. 81r Archibald seemed
surprised when I told him that both Madame Chiang and Donald had speci-
fically denied on several occasions that the Russians had ever pre-
sented a quid pro quo to the Generalissimo. I mentioned the recent
case of the planes at Lanchow And he said that Donald had also told
him that.
31. The Ambaessdor seld that he WAB nt a lose to understand
his country's attitude; that he could not understand why they
fear Japan, especially now when Japan 18 obviously too weakened
even to think of fighting any other country. He SALE that prior
to assuming this poet he had asked in the Foreign Office if they
could give him any directive as to the policy they wished to puraue
out here. Re was told that he would have to work it out largely
for himself, but that in general they thought the Chinese and
Japanese should fight it out among themselves. He again referred
to their present position 88 "contemptible" and 2910 frankly he did
Regraded Uclassified
-9-
not know how to colve the problem,
32. I had made plane to leave Changaha at once and get to
Chunghing AB soon as possible with my information. The Ambassador
had elrendy pursuaded the Chinese to send him on to the cosst via
Manchang to Foochow. I accompanied him from the above interview
to the gunboat where he was greeted with a message from his rep-
resentative in Chungking urging him to come here to avoid offend-
ing the government officials. The Ambassador changed his plans on
the spot and, turning to me, inquired if I would like to join his
caravan. I accepted because it afforded me an opportunity for
further conversation and likewise provided company through the
bandit region of eastern Kweichow which people had been advising
me to evoid.
33. When I went to the local airport to see him off as he
left by private plans for Hongkong on the afternoon of November
19th, he told me he had been receiving urgent messages from Sir
Robert Craigie asking for permission to show the Aide Memoire to
his American colleague. He said Sir. Robert also had recently
changed his tune very dicedly with regard to Japan and that he hoped
to draft 8 message on the plane enroute to Hongkong to get off to
London from there and take advantage of this change of heart while
it Insted.
34. M Γ. Donald informed me just before I left Changeha that
they had decided to cable the Aide Memoire to Dr. Hu Shih in
Washington, but that they had added an injunction that he was not
to show it to anyone until he received permission. Mr. Donald said
they had done this to permit me to reach Chungking with it first.
35. I have presented the foregoing in rather exhaustive de-
teil with & double purpose, (1) I desired to give ne accurate as
order that it could be evaluated in ita true perspective, and (2)
possible an account of what actually transpired and WAS said in
to bring out my belief that the information was not "cooked up"
or "planted" on me by either the British or Chinese. I merely
happened to be on the spot when the talks took place and to have
had the advantage of prior intimacy with both parties plus an 1n-
formal status which permitted them to talk freely to me.
36. Conclusions
After my arrival in Chungking with the foregoing in-
formation our Ambassador requested that I submit to him 8 Memo-
rendun containing my reactions and opinions concerning the present
situation in the 11ght of what I had experienced at Changsha. I
append hereto B.B Enclosure "A" a copy of this memorandum AB my
conclusions to this report.
Regraded Uclassified
CONFIDENTIAL
OFFICE OF THE NAVAL ATTACHE
AMERICAN EMBASSY
CHUNGKING
24 November, 1938,
MEMORANDUM FOR THE AMBASSADOR
Subject: The Conference at Changaha Between the
Generalissimo and the British Ambassador
and the Interest of the United States in
the Situation Resulting Therefrom,
1, Upon first reading the Aide Memoire and taling with
Mr. Donald and Madame Chiang thereafter, I gained the impression
that Chinng Kni-shek had presented the British with an ultimatum
and I 00 referred to it, as noted in my report, in my second
converention with Sir Arohibald, The document contains both the
time element in its request for an immediate "Yes" or "No" reply
from London and what on first glance appears to be an implied
threat in its assertion of there being alternative courses of
action if the Britiah fall. In the light of the British Ambassador's
subsequent explanation and of further consideration of the situation,
however, I believe that Chiang Kai-shek merely confronted the British
with a cold assertion of fact and the simple statement that if they
do not come to China's aid, China must perforce seek assistance
elsewhere.
2. The situation 16 unquestionably very serious and must be
50 denlt with, It presents a difficult problem and certainly one
not to be brushed aside with & 11ght wave of the hand or R. vague hope
that '811 will oome out All right in the end'. It 18 true that at
the moment we are not AB much "on the spot" as the British, for
we are not e member of the League of Nations, we have made tangible
efforts at granting some kind of financial assistance to China
through the purchase of their silver and the recent negotiations
with the !, P. Chen Mission, and our note to Japan of October 6th
has been very favorably received by the Chinese. The Britlah are
committed to specific courses of action which they are not implement-
ing: they have hinted at loans they are not producing; and they are
maintaining n. strange silence toward the preempting by Japan of
large commercial interests through which they once dominated the
trade of the FRB East. More than this, they have actually negotiated
with the Japanese on at least two occasions; the Customs Agreement
and the British American (Yee Tsoong) tobacco interests.
3. But in the sense that we are the leading democracy of the
world and stand for announced principles which have been contra-
vened right and left ever since the invesion of Manchuria in 1931;
that it has been possible for Japan to obtain important war materials
from us; that we have a large cultural stake in China which 18 in
danger of being swept away. we too are "on the spot". It 18 my
firm belief, therefore, that If China turns against Great Britain,
we shall ultimately share the same fate unless we produce more
tangible assistance to China, and do it in the near future.
Regraded Uclassified
11
-2-
Chine 4. 18 fighting for her life, for her independence as 8 nation.
The problem of the moment can be stated very simply:
Japan has declared her purpose on more than one occasion of
dominating not only China, but the whole of the Far East: of
creating an "Asia for the Asintics.
5. What do we want, Ohine or Japan?
6, The situation of the moment, as I see it, 10 as follows:
China has been fighting a losting battle for sixteen months, confi-
dent that sooner or later the democracies must come to her 88816-
tance. The failure of the British even to make a statement, much
1038 tale any action when Japan occupied Canton and cut off Hong-
kone, came 88 n cruel blow and rude swakening to the Chinese. They
have therefore asked the British, 'Are you going to help us or not?
Are you even going to stand up for your own interesta? If not, ee
must know it now and adopt some other policy.' China has now
reached the point where she 18 Almost completely cut off from supplies
and has only enough remaining to carry on the fight B. few months
longer. She cannot wait until the moment of total exhaustion comes
to make her decision.
7. Our problem has to be analyzed from the two angles 88
stated, Do we want a atrong, stable, penceful and independent Chine,
or de WE want an Aein dominated by Japan?
8. The Japanese program is clearly one of driving us and our
institutions out of Asia, Any attempt to minimize this, to regard
it as temporary, to apologize for it, to seek hope in the fact that
N portion of the Japanese people may have been unsympathetic with
this war or to argue that our trade with Japan has been far more
valuable to us than our trade with China 18 short-sighted nnd
avagive to BAY the least. Let the ultimate goal of the Japanese be
diearly understood from the first, for it 18 cold and simple fact,
regardless of what friends of Japan may argue,
9. That the Japanese army may utilize the ald of the Germans
or other totalitarian states for e. time during the process of
wchieving this domination constitutes no saving clause for us. Any
benefit which either we or the British may derive through the
Japanese in the post-war economic rehabilitation period of the
present conflict, even If they emerge only semi-victorious, will
be temporery exactly in proportion to the degree of their victory
and the period of time it takes them to reach the point where they
feel strong enough to kick us out, Any attempt to assume greater
hope than this 18 totally unwarranted in the face of what has al-
read- transpired. They are arrogent, truculent and their promises
to us APV wholly unreliable. No statement that they make to us
Is worth the paper upon which it 18 written or the breath required
to utter it unless it be one of those not infrequent occasions when
they let slin their real purpose. Anyone who may think his future
18 safe in their hands 19 taking D. very long chance.
their present venture 1s problematical. I have felt from the out-
10. The extent of the victory which they may achieve from
set of this war, es I have stated in previous reports, that they in
were walking into e swamp; that there are not enough Japanese
of people; and that eventually the Chinese will suffocate them
Japan to patrol and police this vast country with its millions
or rise and massacre them AS they did the Manchue after 250 years
under their rule. But the long point of view offers little solace
and no solution to our own immediate problem.
Regraded Uclassified
11. It has recently been suggested by a competent
authority on Japan that the Japanese do not intend to attemp!
the "pacification" of all China; that they propose to sit down
on what they have, open and maintain the lines of communication,
establish trading outposte BB one would do in darkest Africa: and
let the Chinese stew in their own juice" back in the interior.
It is this lesser goal, with the possibilities presented if the
Japanese obtain the cooperation of the Germans and their barter
system, which givea food for thought and is & problem worthy of
But what we do know 1s that it will exclude us and alam our *Open
serious consideration. What its possibilities are we do not know,
Door" in our face.
12. Let it not be forgotten also that the present attempt
at conquest on the mainland of Asie in the Japanese Army program
and that the Jepanese Navy still has to be heard from. They have
had very little part in this war to date. The Navy program has
long been known to advocate expansion toward the South Seas. China
like the wealth of undeveloped resources that many writers have
18, in reality, a great b1g farm and does not possess anything
claimed. But to the south lie the Malay Peninsula and the Dutch
East Indies with their known wealth of rubber, tin, oil and other
resources. will Japan ignore these if she succeeds in Chine?
13. In our present efforts to establish reciprocal trade
eventually to unrestricted trade among democratic nations, we have
igreemente with free nations throughout the world, which may lead
our most potent weapon for an ultimate solution. But Again this
13 not P. solution for the present crisis. Should we, can we sit
idly TO And watch the world's next biggest democracy and one of
the most potential areas for the extension of this policy co-
opted and stifled by Japan and her allies And closed to our commerce
simply because that nation is still too cumbersome and lacking in
munitions and supplies to take care of itself?
14. Thus for we have given the Chinese elmost nothing but
moral support in this WELL while affording the Japanese the materials
for WAP. That we have done this latter not intentionally but mere-
ly In curruance of our own "open door" policy to any purchaser who
has the money with which to buy is not a satisfactory reason con-
sidering the result it 1s producing for us in Asia and the prospects
for the door which we hope to Keep open there.
15. The second angle of the problem 16 the Chinese side. In
my questions to Madame Chiang I indicated my apprehension that the
Chinese night be aroused against us by inflammatory speeches in
order to pave the way for peace with Japan, But it has ainoe been
policy of non-interferenee and fail to supply them with tangible
suggested to me, and it 16 very plausible, that If we continue our
evidence of our good will, they may automatically turn Against us,
There 18 no reason why they shouldn't. They Are B. nation fighting
for their life and, NS the British have been told, If the democracies
do not help them, they naturally must turn to those who will.
16. As I stated in B. recent despatch, I believe this feeling
would ensily arise and would be very difficult to combat. I lived
In China during the period of intense anti-foreign feeling from
1924 onward, when whole cities burst into flames of hatred overnight
end illiterate coolies mouthed alogane against the foreigner: when
every Chinese eye had a baleful glint in it 88 a foreigner passed;
end when laborers, dock workers, factory employees and servants
accompanied by the most fantastic demands long before the O.I.O.
staged "go-slow" strikes, "sit-down" strikes and outright strikes
over thought of these devices.
Regraded Uclassified
17. I have been very favorably Impressed during recent
years, and especially during the one Just passed, with the
generally friendly attitude displayed toward us. It 1s true
that since the outbreak of the present war foreignere living
in China have been on common ground with the Chinese in hating
the Japanese and that this has greatly enhanced the feeling of
friendliness on the part of the Chinese toward foreigners, But
I have been apprehensive for B. long time that the day might come
when they might turn up with the cry that we had failed them, for
the Chinese are past mastere in the art of alibi and will never
Recept the blame for the loss of the war themselves. Individ-
ually they have never wanted the war from its very beginning.
They are A peace-loving people and they have constantly hoped
that someone else would come along and fight it for them. Had
this third party appeared, they would have tossed him the baby
forthwith and let him carry it. The Chinese aviators have al-
ready demonstrated this on several occasions, both with the
Russians and the "Foreign Legion" 14th Squadron, But the Chinese
has to fight this war alone in order to achieve any degree of
unity And they have alrendy derived immeasurable benefit from It
in this respect.
18. I remarked in my report No. 1-38 last January that I
thought An 1deal result for this wer would be for it to go on long
enough to burn the corruption and venality out of Chinese official
life and et the same time to brenk the hold of the Inpanese army
on the national life of Japan. That the Chinese and Japanese
should fight it out between themselves has unquestionably been the
point of view of many people and this has been correct un to 42
point. But 8.8 one who hes been in the thick of the wer almost
from its beginning and who has travelled rather extensively through
the country in recent months, it is my considered opinion that we have
reached the point where we no longer can leave the outcome to chance.
Some people may sit back and any complacently that the Chinese will
never be Able to do without the U.S.A. either economically or polit-
ically, but personally I am not 89 sure.
19, Furthermore I believe that 1f feeling starts against us
1: can be fanned into flames very quickly by *soap box" orators
and rAdio broadcesters on the charge that we let them down. The
cry may start against the British who are far more culpable and
vulnerable than we for we made no promises and we are not a League
L'ember, Our position and our reasons for not helping have been
perfectly clear to us; they have been nothing like that clear to
the Chinese. And if n. hue and cry should start against the British,
there would be little differentiating done by the Chinese masses
between British and Americans. It may be and that the British
were specific targets in Shanghat, Canton and Hongkong in 1925 and
1926 and that we did not suffer B8 much in comparison, but those
were specific areas where the target could be identified. Such
WAS not the case in other parto of China, na residents of Changaha,
for example, will testify, and such will not be the case this time
If It comes.
20. I have emphasized the potential turn of feeling against
UP to bring out one point: that irrespective of the outcome of
this war, the recent conferences At Changsha impressed me particular-
1y with one fact -- namely that we are faced with the immediate
question of retaining China's good will. Whether the mar ends in
a stalemate with neither side winning, or Japan wins, or China com-
promises with Japan, we have this question to answer now, We have
154 years of cultural effort behind us in China. Almost every
other member of the present government 18 American educated. But
our pupils Are the ones who will be mont disappointed, and in many
Regraded Uclassified
-5-
cases disillusioned, 17 we fail them now.
21. The main question, however, still 10: Do we want A
strong and independent China, or one dominated by Japan? The
immediate problem 18, Will we act to preserve China's good will
while me still retain it? The answer to the latter will largely
constitute the answer to the former. It hardly needs saying
that If Japan schieves any marked degree of success in this ven-
ture, we shall have to build a navy several times as large ae
the one we now contemplate. The best insurance we onn obtain
for peace and for the futther development of our trade program
1n is strong, independent, peaceful and friendly China together
with a chastened, not B ruined Japan. The only hope of achieving
that, I believe, 1g to retain the good will of the Chinese before
it in too late.
22, The present Oovernment of China, despite its nany short-
comings, 19 the only one in recent years that has ever done any-
thing for the people. It has represented that which we regard
AF rational and that with which we have some chance of doing
business along the lines we desire and in accordance with the
principles for which we stand. It WAS achieving steady progress
in the development of China before this war commenced. There is
bound to be chaos and disorder for a time after this war, whoever
wine. Let there be no mistake about that. But the support of
Chinng Kai-shek and his government offers by far the most hope for
n solution of this ohaos and & return to normalcy in the minimum
possible time.
23. It is not n question of the Kuomintang versus the Eighth
Route Army and which set of principles should guide the govern-
ment of China. That La something for the Chinese to work out for
themselves after the Japanese have been pulled off of their backs.
In that respect our interest again lies in maintaining the friend-
ship of the Chinese and in influencing them thereby to adopt
orderly processes of government in harmony with those for which
we stand. It need only be remarked in passing that the so-called
Communist Party continue to support the Central Government with
Apparent sincerity; that they have again refrained at the recent
People's Political Convention from endorsing any resolution
critical of the Government; that they still profess unbending
opposition to Japan (which 18 probably the best assurance available
to any who may fear a nudden Chinese compromise with Jagan); and
that they show signs of developing into a democratic or popular
earty rather than communists All we think of the term. If this trend
continues, they will provide China after the war with the healthy
political opposition which any democracy needa and thereby force
the elimination of the undestruble and corrupt elements in the
Kuomintang.
24. There are many people in the U.S.A., and among them
some officials, who appear to think that there 1s no ground be-
tween our and full retreat. It has been my conviction for B.
long time that there 16 a very wide stretch in there and that in
It lies the means to peace through firmness and dignity. We have
got to do more than voice our principles and write notes about
them. We have got to insist step by step that they be recognized
and respected. In a world which 1s relying on force we cannot
possibly hope to survive by 11p service to altruism. We must
utilize our tremendous potentiality, both economically and finan-
cially in support of the principles for which we stand.
Regraded Uclassified
-6-
25. Nor CAN this he accomplished through a policy of
indirection. It must be B. studied program in which pressure
10 applied step by step with the will to fight if necessary 8.8
the last move. This 16 the point that our people must come to
realize -- that we cannot run away from war or leave it until
some VREUS future date when we might be inveded. When the time
arrives, if it ever does, that any foreign power or combination
thereof feels strong enough to attempt to invade the U.S.A., it
will probably be too late for us to resist effectively. But
the United States can be invaded in more ways than by an army.
The Influx of cheap Japanese products in recent years and its
harwful effect on our labor situation was a case in point.
26. I have watched the Japanese ever since they invaded
Menchuris in 1931. They have proceeded step by step - phase by
share - looking back over their shoulders at us after each move.
When we failed to do more than protest, they proceeded with the
next move and have grown increasingly bolder. I Am convinced
they can be stopped by firmness, by a progressive program of
pressure, backed by the will to fight If necessary 0.8 a last re-
sort. It will be this realization by them of that determination
on our part which will stop them.
27. There are many ways and means to apply this pressure,
We have already intimated retaliation in kind in our note of
October 6th. It 1s to be hoped that we take steps to implement
12. For immediate use there 16 the elastic tariff scale and I
believe its use thoroughly justified immediately in respect to
situations such as now exist At Taingtao and other North China
ports in the manipulation by the Japanese of their Federated
Bank currency in discrimination against our merchants. Further
and more drastic steps will have to be authorized by legislation
and our every move should be directed toward obtaining what we
need in this respect.
28. Ours 1s no longer R question of oulling the British
chestnute out of the fire. The time has come when we must Act
to SATE sur own, for they are already accrching. If we anye
theirs for them in the process, that will be their Food fortune -
and possibly not such an unfortunate result for us at that:
Respectfully submitted,
J. 1/, McHugh
Ceptain, U.S.M.C.
Assistant Naval Attache.
Regraded Uclassified
CON-IDENTIAL
AIDE MEMOIRE OF CONVERSATION BETWEEN THE GENERALISSIMO
AND SIR ARCHIBALD CLARK KERR ON NOVEDIBER FOURTH, 1938.
(Verbatim Copy)
(Enclosure B to Report No. 10-38, dated 20 Nov. 1938)
The Japanese occupied Canton with two motives in wind.
The first 1g the effect of such occupation upon China, and the
second 1s the effect upon Great Britain. To strike at Chine
18 of secondary importance while to strike at Great Britain
18 of major importance. By occupying Canton, Japan only cuta
the Canton-Hankow Railway and blockades the waterways impeding
transportation and stopping supplies of munitions. Canton, too,
is on important base for national resistance, and Japan hopes
by its occupation to break down the morale of the Chinese people.
However, the cost of landing and maintaining her forces there
will not be compensated by the above results alone. But in
striking a death blow at Britain's historical prestige and
traditional morale, she immeasurably enhances her own position
and value. The present blow to Great Britain is not RS great
in effect na it will be in the future. Japen hopes that just
as Britain's power and prestige suffer in South Chine, here will
rise proportionately in the eyes of the Chinese and All Asiatic
peoples.
Thus she hopes to occupy completely the historical Dlave
formerly enjoyed by Great Britain during the last hundred years
M.S. the dominant factor in Far Eastern affairs.
By the successful occupation of Centon, Japan hopes that
the old reliance of China upon Great Britain will now be abandon-
ed in favor of Japan. Japan thinks that if she can break down
British influence in South China she can break it down elsewhere.
And the British Government and people may well ponder what the
Anawer will be.
What I want to know is, "What will be Great Britain's Far
Enstern policy in view of this latest move on Japan's part?"
will Grent Britain view the occupation of Canton in the
anme light as she viewed the occupation of Manchuria, North China
and Shanghai?
Moreover, what will Gréat Britain do in view of this latest
development?
I would like to have e definite answer to this question.
In view of the fact that Great Britain's intereste and
prestige are threatened, will she quietly accept this fait
accompli or will she demonstrate in no unmistakable terms her
real intentions unequivocally, to safeguard her economic and
oolitical interests in the Far East, and, above all, to follow
her historical policy of upholding high principles to which she
has committed herself, or will she abandon these principles and
secrifice her standing?
China has been fighting lone-handedly for the past sixteen
months. We have looked to Great Britain and hoped for help,
but up to the present we have received nothing tangible. We
appreciate that we secured munitions through Hong Kong, and upon
n. mutually advantageous basis, but that avenue has now been closed.
Regraded Uclassified
37
-2-
As long BB South China was not attacked, we made allowances
for Britein's hesitancy to extend practical aid to us, but now
that Japan has out off British trade there 18 no reason why
Britain should healtate to extend help to us.
As time goes on, our people and the Chinese army will
become more and more disappointed in view of the absolute lack of
concrete and tangible evidence of British support. And that 18
something which the Chinese Government will be constrained to
take into account.
I would, therefore, like to know whether Great Britain will
live up to her historical and traditional standards, and extend
where to her obligations as et member of the Lengue of Nationa,
economic or some other practical help to China?
I would like to have this answered in A definite "Yes" or
"No".
For the past sixteen months we have been hearing A lot of
discussion about loans, and we have been out off from time to
time with excuses that loans were impossible because of Parliamen-
almost tary overnight to Czechoslovakia of n. loan similar in nature to
complications, But the whole world witnessed the granting
that asked for by China.
Now the moment has come when we must have definite knowledge
of Grest Britain's intentions.
If Great Britain turns her back alike upon us and her princi-
ples, then I shall never bring up this question again. Nor shall
I over mention anything concerning Great Britain's Far Eastern
policy. Nor shall I consult Great Britain B.B. to China's future
policy or attitude, or enything concerning the Far East.
I can hardly believe, however, that an Empire which produced
such significance of the repercussions of the occupation of Centon, of and
statesmen 0.8 Disreeli and Gladstone could fail to see the
the inactivity of Great Britain upon her future in the whole
Asia.
This 18 the life and death turning point in British Far
never before, and that we are determined to carry on prolonged
Eastern British Government should realize that China today 18 unified 38
policy. Whether Britain extends aid to us or not - the
resistance. however, not beneficial to Great Britain, and thus excluding the
Japan 16 unquestionably striving to have peace, on
her terms, from Asiatic affairs, Japan would be willing to concede
gains she has acquired since hostilities began. If that question
comes up, what 1s China's answer going to be?
If Japen wine the wer, the old and outstanding interests of
Great Britain in China will be finished.
upon We it depends the future policy of the Chinese Government. There
must know what Great Britain's answer is to be, because
are several roads open to us.
One thing that must be kept in view 19 that Japan, having
B. occupied move will protend to Hong Kong can be left to the imagination.
Canton, will probably occupy Hainan Island. What such
view of the importance of the questions raised in this the
conversation, In will you kindly communicate immediately with
British Government and let me have a. reply?
Regraded Uclassified
THE
VILL APPRECIATE SUGGESTIONS FROM ITS PATRONS CONCERNING INSURAVICE
18
1220-8
CLASS OF SERVICE
WESTERN
SIGNS
DL Day Letter
This is"A full-rate
NM Night Memage
elegram or Cable
am unless Its de-
NL- Night Letter
ed character is In-
ated by a suitable
UNION
LC= Deferred Cable
NLT- Cabla Night Lener
in above or preced-
the address.
WHITE di of
NEWCOME CARLTON
J.C. WILLEVER
Ship Radiogram
PRESIDENT
CHAIRMAN OF THE SOARD
FIRST VICE-PREMENT
Bling time M above in the date line - full-rate telagrame and day letters, and the time of receipt at destination of @ - GSTANIA RD TIME
eceived at 108 East Baltimore St., Baltimore, Md.
CA14 811 NL COLLECT 7 EXTRA 1/141 =SANTAMONICA CALIF 19
DR ISAIAH BOWMAN= 697-35
OAK PL BALTO=
THE FOLLOWING STATEMENT PREPARED AFTER CONSULTATION WITH MY
COLLEAGUES DOCTORS FITZGIBON POLITICAL SCIENCE AND HUSSEY
HISTORY BOTH OF WHOM SPENT RECENT MONTHS IN CENTRAL AMERICA.
THIS SUMMARIZES OPPORTUNITIES FOR AGRICULTURAL COLONIES.
INDUSTRIAL AND COMMERCIAL OPENINGS FOR LIMITED NUMBER MIGHT
BE EXPECTED IN TIME. WAGES FOR AGRICULTURAL AND INDUSTRIAL
LABOR EXTREMELY LOW IN ALL SECTIONS. ROAD SYSTEMS BEING
CTIVELY EXTENDED IN MOST COUNTIRES AND AIR SERVICE MAKES
MANY REGIONS NEWLY ACCESSABLE.
9 COSTARICA OFFERS BEST POSSIBILITIES FOR SEVERAL
10,000 GROUPS. COUNTRY DEMOCRATIC AND SYMPATHETIC TOWARD
IMMIGRATION. UPPER RIM OF MESETA CENTRAL AND UPPER SLOPES
BEYOND THAT RIM CONTAIN FERTILE VOLCANIC SOIL WELL DRAINED
EASILY CLEARED AT ELEVATION OF 3,000 TO 6,000 FEET. WHILE
LOWER ELEVATIONS OF MESETA ARE THICKLY PEOPLED HIGHER
ELEVATIONS ARE SPARSELY INHABITED. DISTANCE TO MARKET NOT
GREAT OVER FAIR ROADS RAPIDLY BEING IMPROVED. CLIMATE
EXCELLENT. WESTWARD SLOPE TOWARD=
THE QUICKEST, SUREST AND SAFEST WAY TO SEND MONEY IS BY TELEGRAPH OR CABLE
Regraded Uclassified
THE COMPANY WILL APPRECIATE SUGGESTIONS FROM ITS PATRONS CONCERNING ITSERVICE
19
1230-#
LAST OF STRVICE
WESTERN
SIGNS
DL - Day Letter
This is a full-rate
NM
Night Measure
Telegram or Cable-
NL
from unless its de-
Night Letrer
end character is In-
licured by a suitable
UNION
LC Deferred Cable
NLT - Cable Number Letter
on above or preced-
he the address.
Ship Radiogram
R. M. WHITE
HEWCOME CARLTON
J. c. WILLEVER
PRESIDENT
CHAIRMAN OF THE SCARD
FIRST PRESIDENT
- filling time PLAI stown in the date line on full-rate telegrame and day letters, and the time of receipt at dostination NOTE all SUNDARD TIME
eceived at 108 East Baltimore St., Baltimore, Md.
CA14 2/160=
NICARAGUA ALSO SPARSELY INHABITED AND ABOVE 3,000 FEET
OFFERS POSSIBILITIES PARTICULARLY ABOUT HEADWATERS OF
ANCARLOS AND ON PACIFICWARD SLOPE. PENINSULA OF NICOYA
LSO OFFERS POSSIBILITIES AS DOES RATHER ROUGH MOUNTAIN
ERRAIN OF TALAMANCA CORDILLERA. MOST OF REGIONS MENTIONED
ARE SUITABLE FOR CEREALS BEANS AND FRUITS FOR SUBSSITANCE
GRICULTURE AND COFFEE FOR EXPORT. THIS COUNTRY PARTICULARLY
ATTRACTIVE BECAUSE POPULATION IS MOSTLY WHITE.
9 HONDURAS. MOST OF HIGHLAND 3.000 TO 5,000 FEET
LEVATION CONTAINS SPARSE POPULATION. THE SOIL IS GOOD THE
RAIN VARIES FROM 30 I: 50 INCHES RESULTING IN A GOOD GROWTH
OF VEGETATION AND EXCELLENT FORESTS OVER MUCH OF THE AREA-
LONG DRY SEASON FROM NOVEMBER TO APRIL OFFERS A PROBLEM AND
HAS HELPED TO KEEP AGRICULTURAL DEVELOPMENT DOWN BUT SHOULD
NOT PREVENT EXTENSIVE PROFITABLE GRAIN FARMING IF ROADS ARE
CONSTRUCTED AS OUTLETS TO MARKET THOUGH INTENSIVE AGRICULTURE
MAY NEVER BE POSSIBLE. A MU CH LARGER ANIMAL POPULATION
SHOULD BE POSSIBLE ALSO WITH INTELLIGENT MEASURES AGAINST
TICKS WHICH NOW CONSTITUTE A SERIOUS HANDICAP=
THE QUICKEST, SUREST AND SAFEST WAY TO SEND MONEY 15 BY TELEGRAPH OR CABLE
Regraded Uclassified
20
THE COMPANY WILL APPRECIATE SUGGESTIONS FROM ITS PATRONS CONCERNING ITSERVICE
1230-8
CLASS OF SERVICE
WESTERN
SIONS
DL Day Latter
This Is a full-rate
NM Night Menage
elegram of Cable-
ram unless le de-
NL-Night Letter
end character is in-
licated by a suitable
UNION
LC Deferred Cable
NLT Cable Night Letter
les above or preced-
be the address.
a. 9. WHITE
REWCOME CARLTON
2. c. WILLEVER
Ship Radiogram
PRESIDENT
CHAIRMAN OF THE BOARD
mast VICE-PREMOSNT
be Sling time as shown in the date line un full-rate telegrama and day latters, and the time of reneipt as detisation as shown on all manages, la STANDARD TIME
eceived at 108 East Baltimore St., Baltimore, Md.
CA14 3/160=
1970 NOV 20 AM 4 23
MINING TOO OFFERS GOOD POSSIBILITIES KNOWN DEPOSITS OF GOLD
AND SILVER BEING NUMEROUS. THESE AREAS ARE SUITABLE FOR
PIONEER SETTLEMENTS AND WITH FURTHER EXTENSION OF ROADS AND
RAILROADS SHOULD SUPPORT MANY 10,000 GROUPS. PINE LUMBERING
NDUSTRY ALSO PROMISING. ATTITUDE OF GOVERNMENT TOWARD
MMIGRATION DOUBTFUL.
9 NICARAGUA. UPLANDS FROM MATAGALPA TO UPPER SEGOVIA
REGION SPARSELY INHABITED BUT CAPABLE OF SUSTAINING TWO OR
THREE 10,000 GROUPS BY SUBSISTANCE AGRICULTURE, TROPICAL AND
SUBTROPICAL HORTICULTURE, AND COFFEE PRODUCING FOR EXPORT
IF MARKET EXISTS. ROADS FROM MANAGUA AND TO ATLANTIC COAST
RIVERS BEING IMPROVED.
9 GUATEMALA. TWO REGIONS OFFER GOOD PROSPECTS.
HIGHLANDS OF ALTA VER A PAZ 3,000 TO 4,000 FEET ELEVATION
HAVE HEALTHFUL CLIMATE, RICH SOIL, ABUNDANT VEGETATION:
HEAVY RAINS, BUT WITH GOOD DRAINAGE DUE TO UNDERLYING
LIMESTONE. ROAD SYSTEM UNDER CONSTRUCTION; RAILWAY AND RIVER
OUTLET TO LIVINGSTON; AIR LINE TO GUATEMALA CITY. ANOTHER
REGION IS HIGHER PART OF WESTERN END PACIFIC COASTAL PLAIN
EAST AND WEST FROM COATEPEQUE AND ALONG FOOT OF VOLCANIC
RANGE=
THE QUICKEST, SUREST AND SAFEST WAY TO SEND MONEY IS BY TELEGRAPH OR CABLE
Regraded Uclassified
21
THE COMPANY WILL APPRECIATE SUGGESTIONS FROM ITS PATRONS CONCERNING ITS SERVICE
1220-8
cust CMP SERVICE
WESTERN
SIGNS
DL Day Letter
This is a full-rate
NM Night Message
Telegram or Cable-
with unless its de-
NL Night Letter
und character is in-
disned by a suitable
UNION
LC Deferred Cable
NLT Cable Night Letter
6m above or preced-
by the address.
n.a. WHITE
REWCOME CARLTON
J. c, WILLEVER
Ship Radiogram
PRESIDENT
CHAIRMAN OF THE BOARD
FIRST VICE-PREAIDENT
to the time as above LA the date line on full-rate telegrame and day letters, and the time of receipt at destination - shown on NOV all comps, 20 la STANDARD AM 4 TIME 65
Received at 108 East Baltimore St., Baltimore, Md.
CA14 4/178=
EASTWARD FROM THERE. THIS IS PIEDMONT SLOPE ABOUT 1,000 FEET
HIGHER THAN NEIGHBORING UNITED FRUIT COMPANY BANANA REGION,
WELL DRAINED VOLCANIC WOIL SUFFICIENT RAINFALL AND EXCELLENT
WATER SUPPLY. SOME DANGER OF MALARIA. GOOD FOR CATTLE. SUGAR
CANE. CORN. BEANS, TROPICAL AND SUBTROPICAL FRUITS. ROADS
LEAD TO GUATEMALAN HIGHLANDS AND RAILROADS TO PORTS OF OCOS
AND CHAMPERICO. PRESUMABLY THE PETEN REGION THOUGH ONCE
OCCUPIED BY POPULOUS MAYAN CITIES IS IMPOSSIBLE NOW UNLESS
AN EXTENSIVE PROGRAM OF MALARIA ERADICATION COULD BE CARRIED
OUT. THE TWO RECOMMENDED GUATEMALAN REGIONS ALREADY CONTAIN
MANY GERMAN FINCAS, MAINLY COFFEE FARMS, ALSO SOME
INFLUENTIAL ENGLISH AND AMERICAN FARM OWNERS. SUBTROPICAL
HORTICULTURE AS YET UNEXPLOITED BUT PROMISING. GOVERNMENT
LIKELY TO FAVOR IMMIGRANTS, BUT SOME FOREIGN LAND OWNERS
LIKELY TO OPPOSE. IN BOTH REGIONS IMMIGRANTS MIGHT BETTER
DE SCATTERED THAN CONCENTRATED IN COMPACT COLONIES.
AVAILABLE LANDS OCCUR IN LIMITED TRACTS.
9 BRITISH HONDURAS. (BELICE) INTERIOR HILL COUNTRY
OF THE SOUTH WOULD SEEM TO OFFER PLACE FOR MANY SETTLERS IN
COUNTRY BETTER THAN IN BELICE WHERE OVER 1,000 WHITES
ALREADY LIVE. THIS WOULD STRENGTHEN BRITAIN'S HOLD ON THE
TERRITORY. =
THE QUICKEST, SUREST AND SAFEST WAY TO SEND MONEY IS BY TELEGRAPH OR CABLE
Regraded Uclassified
THE
n. APPRECIATE SUGGESTIONS FROM ITS PATRONS CONCERNING ITS SERVICE
22
1220-6
CLASS OF SERVICE
WESTERN
SIGNS
DL - Day Letter
This is a full-rate
NM - Night Message
Vegram or Cable-
(m unless its de-
ML Night Letter
red character Is in-
Listed by a suirable
UNION
LC Deferred Cable
NLT Cable Night Letter
12% above or preced-
INE the address.
a. a. WHITE
HEWCOMB CARLTON
J. G. WILLEVER
Ship Radiogram
ressivent
CHAIRMAN OF THE BOARD
FIRST VICE-PRESIDENT
Due sling time as stown in the date line un full-rate telegrame and day letters, and the time of resulys at destination as abown on all manager, is STANDARD TIME
Received at 108 East Baltimore St., Baltimore, Md.
BS NOV 20 AM 4 23
CA14 5/172=
5
PANAMA. THE PACIFIC SLOPE WESTWARD FROM THE CANAL TO THE
COSTARICA BORDER WOULD SEEM TO OFFER ROOM AND SUITABLE
CONDITIONS FOR SEVERAL 10,000 GROUPS. ISOLATED VALLEYS
WITHIN THE CHIRIQUI MOUNTAINS ALSO OFFER LIMITED SITES AT
ELEVATIONS OF 1,000 TO 2,000 FEET. THE COASTAL PLAINS ARE
SPARSELY INHABITED AND THE FOOTHILLS LARGELY UNDEVELOPED.
THE REGION IS DRY ENOUGH FOR HEALTHFUL LIVING, BUT WITH
SUFFICIENT RAIN FOR PASTURE, CEREAL CULTIVATION AND FRUIT
GROWING. ACCESS TO PORTS IS EASY AND A ROAD FROM THE CANAL
REACHES TO BEYOND DAVID.
9 SALVADOR. THIS COUNTRY PROBABLY OFFERS NO
POSSIBILITIES DUE TO DENSE POPULATION AND INTENSIVE
DEVELOPMENT. GENERAL CONSIDERATIONS.
9 HUMID LOWLANDS HAVE NOT BEEN SUGGESTED BECAUSE OF
UNSUITABLE HEALTH CONDITIONS. EACH OF THE SEVERAL COUNTRIES
COULD PROBABLY ABSORB A LIMITED NUMBER OF INDIVIDUALS
PARTICULARLY OF THE PROFESSIONAL CLASSES AND THOSE
FINANCIALLY ABLE AND PREPARED TO UNDERTAKE INDUSTRIAL OR
HORTICULTURAL ENTERPRISES. WE WOULD STRESS SUBTROPICAL
HORTICULTURE FOR COLONY ACTIVITY. AS YET UNTRIED ON LARGE
SCALE BUT EVERYWHERE SUCCESSFUL ON A SMALL SCALE. =
GEORGE M MCBRIDE 710 VIA DE LA PAZ
PACIFICPALISADES CALIF.
THE QUICKEST, SUREST AND SAFEST WAY TO SEND MONEY 15 BY TELEGRAPH OR CABLE
Regraded Uclassified
23
THE JOHNS HOPKINS UNIVERSITY
BALTIMORE, MARYLAND
OFFICE OF THE PRESIDENT
November 21, 1938
Dear Mr. Morgenthau:
fill M 46
Here is a copy of the letter which I have sent to
Warm Springs. It summarizes our conversation last night in
so far as South America is concerned.
This leaves the roast duck, the hospitality, and
the charm of your home unmentioned. It was delightful!
Sincerely yours,
Isaiah Bornan
Mr. Baruch telegraphed
today for 6 copies of
Limits of havo Eettlement"
tabe Leur to Carlton Hotel
in wash Thought you
ought to know this.
The Honorable Henry Morgenthau, Jr.
Secretary of the Treasury
15th Street and Pennsylvania Avenue
Washington, D. C.
Regraded Uclassified
24
MA
NC
BERLIN (Part Air)
A portion of this telegram
must bE closely paraphrased
Dated November 20, 1938
before being communicated
to anyone. (B)
Rec'd 9:10 a.m. 21st.
Secretary of State
Washington
641, November 20, 10 a.m.
(Gray) Number 32, FOR TREASURY FROM HEATH.
The Reich's tax revenues for ⁰ctober last were 1367
million marks, an increase of roughly 20 % over October
1937 revenues of 1143 million marks. For the first SEVEN
months of the current fiscal year tax revenues totaled 9670
million marks an increase of SOME 22% OVEr collections
of 7943 million marks during the corresponding period last
year.
With the imposition of the confiscatory and punitive
lEVY on the Jewish community of one billion marks it is
assumed that the revenue forecast of 17.2 billion marks for
the current fiscal year should bE correspondingly increased.
It is not yet possible to state what percentage of Jewish
property will have to be sacrificed to meet this lEvy.
Economics Minister Funk stated that total Jewish property
had a registered net value of SEVEN billion marks. This
Evaluation is undoubtedly high inasmuch as the registration
decree required JEWS to capitalize pensions, declare life
face
insurance policies at/
value and furniture and other
property of little sale value at the purchase price.
The
Regraded Uclassified
25
NC -2- #641 from Jerlin, November 20, 1938
The tendency was to overstate the value in view of the
severe penalties prescribed for undervaluation. Funk
admitted that of the property registered some two
billion marks had already been "Aryanised". To this loss
must bE added the destruction of Jewish property during
the recent "riots" commonly estimated at about half a
billion marks and the continuing loss due to the forced
or panic sales of businesses to Aryans and hasty realization
of property to meet the tax lEVY and living needs. The
situation is rendered more BEVETE by restrictions on Jewish
bank accounts and the injunction against sales of Jewish
owned securities by banks and the stock exchange.
ThE Reichsbank statement for the first half of November
shows a remarkable ratio of repayment of the Reichsbank
credits granted during October: 94.6% as compared with a
repayment of fresh credits of 77.7% for the first of
November, 1937. It is possible, however, that this decrease
in Reichsbank credits may have been offset by counter
activity of the Gold Discount Bank which publishes its
statement only once a month. Thus during October when the
Reichsbank decreased its bill holdings by 631 million marks
its subsidiary, the Gold Discount Bank, increased its bill
portfolio by 311 million marks. The total of Reichsbank
credits: bills checks collaterals, decreased 250 million
marks
Regraded Uclassified
26
NO -3- 641 from Berlin, November 20, 1938
marks during the second WEEK of Peptember to 7648 million
marks a figure 774 million under that of October 30.
3111s discounted the largest item of Reichsbank's
credits stood at 6775 million marks on November 15th as
compared with 7542 million marks on October 31 and 5578
million marks on October 31, 1937.
Total currency circulation decreased 253 million
marks during the second week to a total of 9253 million
marks on November 15th as compared with E, circulation of
9266 million marks in mid-October last and 6756 million
marks in mid-November 1937. The high COVER currency cir-
culation was 10154 million on September 30 last.
Financial authorities have admitted that with due allow-
ance for the annexation of Austria and Sudstenland there
has been an increase in currency circulation of 25% over
that of a year ago. This increase in currency circulation
compares with the Estimated increase of salaries and wages
during the first half of 1938 of 1.5 billion marks or 7.6%
over WACE payments of the first hulf of 1937. The institute
for Economic Research estimates the rate of increased pro-
duction of capital investment industries during the first
Eight months of this year at about 10% OVEr that of 1937
and the average of other industrial groups at about 5%.
Consumption goods industries working from Elastic demand
are Estimated to have increased their production by 7.6%
over 1937. Undoubtedly one factor in the increased
monetary
Regraded
27
NC -4- #641 from Berlin, November 20, 1938
monetary circulation is "hoarding" by ways earners not per-
mitted to Expend their increased earnings for foods and by
individuals desirous of keeping a portion of their/from fortunes
the knowledge of tax and other authorities.
The announcement yesterday of a new Reich loan of
billion marks before the final payment on the October
loan (December 5) had been made come as a general surprise
although it might have been anticipated. ThE new loan will
also be issued at 98 3/4% and bear interest at 42%.
The term of subscription will run from November 28 to January
9 and the term of payment from January 17 to February 25.
As with the October loan subscribers have the option of tak-
ing receipts for their subscription, the bonds being deposit-
Ed to their account in some central "security bank" to bE
designated.
The new loan ia announced in the financial press under
such headings as "utilization of money market surplus". It
is true that contrary to the results of previous issues
which WETE followed by a hardening of the money market the
October loan was succeeded by an unusual liquidity Evidenced
by increased issues of Gold Discount Bank single bills and
the remarkable-- 94.6--liquidation of fresh credits of the
Reichsbank during November. This condition was mainly the
result of the maturing on October 31 of several hundred
million marks of short term Treasury -"delivery
certificates" issued to Government suppliers and non-
interest
Uclassified
- 5 -
28
interest bearing bills sold on the money market. On
December 1 several hundred million more Treasury certifi-
cates will fall due as well as an unspecified amount of
4 1/2% Treasury certificates issued some years ago. Osten-
sibly "delivery certificates" and non-interest bearing
Treasury bills which have been issued in maturities of three,
six, nine and twelve months will be falling due during the
period of conversion. To a large extent, therefore, the
new loan will be a conversion of short term indebtedness.
The whole story is however not contained in the
above. The belief is that this is also & call for the
people to increase their savings in order to maintain and
increase armament and the concomitant program of the
four year plan of the Germans. The newspaper DER DEUTSCHE
VOLKSWIRT is known to be close to the Reichsbank, and
it is relatively independent in its editorial expression
even if such expression is restrained; in an editorial
in this paper the need of increased armament is openly
discussed. It stated "we must equal the increased (armament)
measures of other nations".
Stressing that the increased exertions demanded of the
German people must not be at the expense of a diminution of
the supply of consumption goods desired by the worker, it
refers to speeches by the Finance Minister and Economics
Ministry officials calling for & reduction of Government and
bureaucracy and over-organization and a decrease in non-
essential governmental activities and expenditures. The
editorial
Regraded Uclassified
29
NC -6- /641 from Berlin, November 20, 1938
Editorial points out that the new demands on the German
people must be met by better Equipment and organization,
"rationalization," of industry and approves the recent
decree cutting apprenticship from four to three years.
It clearly indicates that longer workin hours will bE
required and greater Employment of women in industry. The
necessity of increased foreign trade to pay for raw material
is emphasized. It approves recent steps for "sharper" cal-
culation of prices in Government orders and speaks
approvingly of the measures requiring municipalitiss to
invest = greater portion of their reserves in Government
loans.
In this connection it is popularly reported that the
municipalities took about one half billion marks of the
last and previous Reich loans. According to a recently
published study the total reserves of towns of more than
10,000 population were 1.4 billion marks at the End of the
1936-1937 fiscal year. Presumably these reserves have
since increased. Since for the 1936-1937 period these muni-
cipalities had an aggregate budget surplus of 351,000,000
marks. (End Gray)
GILBERT
WWC
HPD
Regraded Ucla
30
poss OFFICIAL COMMUNICATIONS TO
THE SECRETARY OF STATE
WASHINGTON, D.C.
DEPARTMENT OF STATE
M
WASHINGTON
November 21, 1938.
The Secretary of State presents his compliments
to the Honorable the Secretary of the Treasury, and
encloses for his strictly confidential information a
copy of telegram No. 1957 of November 18 transmitting
the substance of a conversation which the Charge at
Paris had with the Air Minister of France.
RE,
/ F / + P / e NNO BEST, / OHIO 51 0 18 r .o\ 104 03A1303
Regraded Uclassified
ONFIDENTIAL
31
PARAPHRASE OF TELEGRAM RECEIVED
FROM: American Embassy, Paris, France
DATE: November 18, 1938, 8 p.m.
NO.: 1957
The following is strictly confidential:
Today I had lunch with Lachambre, the Air Minister.
At the meeting of the Radioal Socialist Deputies this morn-
ing,he told me, out of about a hundred present (himself
included) eight of the deputies had voted against, and
twenty abstained on a resolution expressing confidence in
the Government to improve the country's economic situation
but omitting specific reference to the decree laws recently
promulgated. In view of the criticism of the decree laws,
Lachambre was pleasantly surprised that there was no
greater opposition on the part of the Radical Socialists.
If the Government should be overthrown next month,
Lachambre believes that a National Union Government will
come in headed either by Bonnet or Daladier, and members
of the Center and the Right will be taken in. In its
fundamentals, the financial program of such a government
would not be much different from the present one of
Reynaud. Slight modification would have to be made in
order to mollify the most vehement of the present critics
and of course Reynaud would have to 60.
Lachambre told me that the rumors about prolongation
of the life of the present Chamber were "fantastic". He
knew that no such thing was contemplated by Daladier.
Yesterday
Regraded Uclassified
32
22 I I
Yesterday the C.G.T. held National Congress meeting
at Nantee. They decided to observe the twenty-sixth of
November as a day of protest against the decrees of Daladier
and Reynaud. This organization instructed its administra-
tive committee to initiate resistance to the decrees and
even to go 80 far as to plan to cease work if necessary
to defend the social reforms.
Last Saturday the veterans organizations had given
Daladier such an ovation when he called upon them to make
voluntary sacrifices in line with the urgent need for economy
in governmental expenditures; however, yesterday this form
of support was refused to the Prime Minister on the grounds
that the decree laws cannot be expected to solve the country's
probleme, and because they are not equitable in the distri-
bution of the burden placed on the population.
The appeal for support of the "three year plan" was
renewed last night in talke before the federation of French
newspapers by the Prime Minister, the Finance Minister and
the President of France. Some of the phrases which the Prime
Minister used in his speaking illustrate the atmosphere
created by the conflict over the plan; the gist of them
was that the Prime Minister would not yield to any of the
maneuvers of the adversaries of the Government, that he
despised their threats, and that they would not be success-
ful in breaking their will nor in reducing French enthusiass
33
- 3 -
for recovery.
In the speech given by the Minister of Finance it
was pointed out that the "yawning abyse at France's feet"
had been lost sight of in the hubub which had arisen over
the taxation provisions of the plan - which problem had
been protrayed by him without stint last Saturday night.
It had also been overlooked he said that the plan is prin-
cipally one of economic recovery.
The speech given by the President was less instructive
on the purpose or details of the program, but it expressed
the fervent hope that the country and Parliament would give
the recovery program their full support. As 8. guage of the
seriousness of the present situation, the President's speech
was perhape the most interesting. The Chief of State
stepped somewhat out of role for the second time (he had
made a speech last Saturday) and made an appeal for the
particular program of a. particular Government.
The political press reports of yesterday and today
mention the innumerable rumors that are going around as
to the methods that some newspapers fear may be adopted
- and which others believe should be adopted, depending
on the point of view of each journal - for the continuance
in power of the authors of the recovery plan for the time
believed necessary to assure the program's success. It
would be useless to speculate about the relative value
Regraded Uclassified
34
- 4 -
of these rumors in view of the present confused situation.
It is highly probable that the rumors are based upon
not much more than the imagination of their authors and
the general uncertainty as to the outlook for the future.
END MESSAGE.
WILSON.
EA:LWW
Regraded Uclassified
35
STATE DEPARTMENT
M
CABLE
November 21, 1938
PARIS
FROM AMERICAN EMBASSY
#1966.
Reference is made to telegram #870 of November 19 from the
Department. I am in agreement. Cochran will sail for the United
States on November 26 on the Queen Mary.
(Sgd.) Wilson
Regraded Uclassified
36
November 21, 1938.
2:16 p.m.
Operator: Go ahead.
HMJr:
Hello.
Harry
Hopkins:
Hello Henry.
HMJr:
How are you?
H:
Fine.
HMJr:
Harry.
H:
Yes.
HMJr:
I'm calling you up to ask you whether you would inform
me where the Administration stands on this relief
situation 8.8 of today?
H:
Well, Henry, you know I can't answer that one to you off
on - over the phone as to where -
HMJr:
No.
H:
Aa to where - what my thinking 18.
HMJr:
Well, what I'm getting at is this.
H:
What conversations I've had with the Boss.
HMJr:
No, no, no. That's - Are you going to do anything
today?
H:
Am I going to do anything today?
HMJr:
Yes.
H:
No. I'm going to make some moves around my own shop but
nothing serious.
HMJr:
Well that -
H:
I'm going - I'm going, you know, I'm going - I'm making
moves today.
HMJr:
Well let me tell you what -
H:
Not major moves.
Regraded
Uclassified
37
- 2 -
HMJr:
Well let me tell you what I have in mind, I've never -
I - we had a meeting this morning of this new committee
that the President set up on fiscal and monetary.
H:
Yes.
HMJr:
And I told him about this situation, but I said that
if at this time, I'm using the word "administration"
advisedly, if we layed off & million men that this
recovery isn't far enough along but what it would
very likely upset the whole applecart.
H:
Yes.
HMJr:
And therefore we are drafting a letter to the President
recommending that he sign this National Emergency, see?
H:
Yes.
HMJr:
But I don't want to leave 8. stone unturned.
H:
Yes.
HMJr:
And if you are 80 inclined I'd like very much if you
would drop over here at five o'clock and Bee the
letter before it goes to the President.
H:
Yes. Well I will. Now, when can I 800 you?
HMJr:
When can you see me?
H:
Yes.
HMJr:
Well -
H:
I'm going to be here all week and I've got no appoint-
ments.
HMJr:
Well you can see me any time that you want to.
H:
When - 18 there any chance of you and I having dinner
together?
HMJr:
Well unfortunately -
H:
At your house.
HMJr:
Well here's the thing. We're going to Woodrings tonight,
tomorrow night we've got guests, but I'm free at lunch
tomorrow.
Uclassified
38
- 3 -
H:
When are you going for Thanksgiving.
HMJr:
Right after - around noon Wednesday,
H:
Well, can you lunch with me tomorrow?
HMJr:
Well you can lunch with me. I don't ever go out.
H:
All right, I'll come down when?
HMJr:
One o'clock.
H:
All right, and I'll be down at five this afternoon.
HMJr:
But if you'll come down at five -
H:
I'll be down.
HMJr:
Now Harry, I appeal with greatest secrecy on everybody
on this.
H:
All right. I won't say anything to anybody. I won't
talk to anybody in my shop about it.
HMJr:
I mean I've told them that I've never done anything
which was so secret because this is the President's
business.
H:
That's right.
HMJr:
And -
H:
Will there be anybody else there at five?
HMJr:
Yes.
H;
Well, I'll be discreet about what I say.
HMJr:
But the point is, I haven't - all I'm saying to them
18 never mind what happened in the last six weeks.
H:
Yes.
HMJr:
This is the situation.
H:
Yes.
HMJr:
And while I have no legal responsibility I got some sense
of what's best for the country and what's good for the
unemployed and the human being, and I'm not going to
39
- 4 -
be satisfied until I've done everything I can to get
him to sign this.
H:
Well Henry I'll be down at -
HMJr:
But as I say I have surrounded everybody with the utmost -
and I've got 8. fellow going down - my own age - going
down on the plane tonight at eight with this letter.
But I didn't want to send this without you seeing it
and having you say, "Well that's swell or it isn't".
H:
Yes.
HMJr:
See?
H:
Fine. And I'll be there at five.
HMJr:
How does it sound to you offhand.
H:
oh, fine, and I was - I was simply going to go down
there myself and - I got no chance to discuss this
the other day with him, he just gave me a public
beating which I sat and took.
HMJr:
Did he just spring that on you?
H:
Sure.
HMJr:
Well I'll be damned.
H:
But I know why he did it.
HMJr:
Well I don't.
H:
Because I had planned to have the orders issued to reduce
these people and the orders were withdrawn at his
specific request.
HMJr:
I see.
H:
80 it was all, I figured that he just decided to give me
a public beating in front of a lot of people. Whatever
the reason 18, by God, he had some reason for doing it,
and whatever the reason 18, Henry, is all right with me.
HMJr:
But why, Harry?
H:
Well, don't ask me. I can't tell you why.
Regraded Uclassified
40
- 5 -
HMJr:
Do you know?
H:
I've got an idea, but I'd rather not talk to you over
the phone.
HMJr:
Well anyway -
H:
Well I'll be in at five, Henry.
HMJr:
O.K.
H:
And it sounds all right to me, see?
HMJr:
All right.
H:
Fine. Goodbye.
Regraded Jclassified
41
REB
GRAY
London
Dated November 21, 1938
Rec'd- 2:17 P. m.
Secretary of State,
Washington.
1341, November 21, 5 P. m.
FOR TREASURY.
After Saturday's rather active day in the bullion and
foreign Exchange markets today has been very quiet with
only 87 bars sold at the fixing at 147 shillings 11-1/2
pence giving a premium of a half penny at 4.70, 52 bars
being married. The British authorities held sterling at
4.70 in the morning but receded to 4.69-1/8 this afternoon
when the dollar was bid chiefly as a result of the Bank of
France's purchases of dollars and sales of sterling the
latter at 178.69 earlier in the day and later at 178.56.
Forward rates of the franc are thought by the market also
to have been subject to control by the French authorities
and now stand at 1.1 for one month and 3-1/8 discount for
three months.
KENNEDY
KLP
RGC
Regraded Uclassified
42
PARAPHRASE OF TELEGRAM RECEIVED
FROM: American Embassy, Paris, France
DATE: November 21, 1938, 3 p.m.
NO.: 1966
Reference is made to telegram No. 870 of
November 19 from the Department. I am in agreement.
Coohran will sail for the United States on November 26
on the QUEEN MARY.
WILSON.
EA:LWW
Regraded Uclassified
43
PARAPHRASE OF TELEGRAM RECEIVED
FROM: American Embassy, Paris, France
DATE: November 21, 1938, 6 p.m.
NO.: 1968
FROM COCHRAN.
At six o'clock I had 8. talk with my friend in
the Bank of France. The net gain for the day was
1,300,000 pounds, although the fund yielded & little
foreign exchange in late trading as a result of strike
stories. Better market for forwards, General improve-
ment in French rentes and shares. I understand that
$6,000,000 was yielded by the British control, and that
the failure of the pound to improve after completion of
the Anglo-American trade agreement has caused gloom in
London financial circles.
Tomorrow the Prime Minister and Reynaud are
scheduled to go before the Finance Committee of the
Chamber to present their budget plans for 1939. Today
there is improved market and press reaction because of
the expressed determination of the above two officials
to aee their program through.
END SECTION ONE.
WILSON.
EA:LWW
44
REB
GRAY
Paris
Dated November 21, 1938
Rec'd 3:39 P. m.
Secretary of State,
Washington.
1968, November 21, 6 p. m. (SECTION TWO)
In his weekly Editorial financial Editor Jenny of
LE TEMPS today concluded a study of Reynaud's as follows:
"What do the opponents propose to substitute for the
sacrifices demanded of the taxpayers-consumers? Exchange
control? That is not serious. Monetary control does not
at all modify the Essentials of the problem; remedies
nothing. It masks for a while the consequences of inflation
without suppressing them. It can postpone the catastrophs.
It can prevent it. In order that it may bE avoided it is
indispensable that the sacrifice demanded of EVEryone bE
accepted and that the Government know how, if it must, to
brave for some time an unpopularity which is to bE Expected.
Bank of France today invoiced to Federal RESErVE Bank,
NEW York for account of Bank of England 477,000,000 francs
gold bars CHAMPLAIN.
Press
Regraded Uclassified
45
REB
2-#1968, From Paris,Nov.21,6p.m.
(SEC. Two)
Press reports from Havre rifling by dock workers of
cases of silver coins in a Valencia government shipment to
NEW York PRESIDENT ROOSEVELT.
(END OF MESSAGE)
WILSON
NPL
Regraded Uclassified
COPY
Novamber 21st, 1938
My dear Mr. President:
The map which I promised to send you in answer to your
second inquiry was delivered to Secretary Morganthau at his home
in Washington last evening and he and I spent the evening examin-
ing it and other maps and documents, He will write you about them.
My purpose in writing this letter is to summarise the results of an
investion of Forthern South America. You will find detailed -
maries region by region pasted on the map itself.
The two critical contours on the sap are the 3,000 foot
contour and the 8,000 foot contour. Below the first the tropical
conditions are sovere; under 2,000 feat and between 2,000 and 3,000
feet they are still difficult for European colonists. Any site be-
low 3,000 feet would offer special technical difficulties in the
field of health and outdoor labor. Also, there would be required
forms of tropical agriculture, which are both specialized and dif-
ficult for European labor. Above 3,000 feet the climate is dis-
tinctly better, horticulture is possible, subsistence farming is
practicable and it is possible for the European to become adjusted
to both elevation nd climate. Above 8,000 feet pulmonary and heart
troubles increase rapidly. Eighty percent of the population of high-
land Bolivia and Peru die of pulmonary diseases, mostly preymonia,
If colonists were young they could stand & greater elevation. Even
8,000 feet 18 extress for people beyond the age of 50, as a rule.
The net result of an inspection of all these limiting con-
ditions 13 that Northern South America offers no place for colonise-
tion, on a. large ecale, of people such as NO have in mind. This will
be cleared if the summaries on the map are read in connection with
the following text.
I NORTHERN SOUTH AMERICA
1 - The Guiana Highlands
The Guiana Highlands are out of the picture. The land is
oither rough or swampy, the distances to the Orinoco or other streams
is great, road construction is difficult and expensive and the insect
inhabitants are both numerous and varied. It would be 6 major task of
reclamation and land modification to make the region habitable and the
cost would be excessive. In enterprises of this sort the physically
possible and the economically profitable would have to be kept in bel-
ance. It would be like a city at the South Pole. Divilization could
maintain it, but the cost would be prohibitive.
2 - Venesuela
I described the llanos country in MI earlier letter. & word
Regraded Uclassified
President Franklin D. Receivelt - 2
COPY
here as to the western border of the plains country. Irrigation 10 11040-
sary and this requires considerable capital to begin with. Irrigated areas
will produce products which must be handled expertly if they are to find an
outside market; and then cobes the difficulty of transport to the market.
If there were a tract of favorable climate and terrain that would accomodate
100,000 people, transport might be provided over metalled roads to the coast,
but no such tract is svailable. The areas are scattered. They are local
alluvial deposits. I will spend no more time on them since from every stand-
point they fail to provide the necessary conditions for tolerable living.
3 - Highland Colombia
There are 1 great many local tracts in Highland Colombia which could
sustain European inhabitants in comfort and prosperity. The trouble 10 that
they are scattered and each would require & special fiold survey to determine
its capacity and the scale of the facilities that would be required to provide
an outlet for colonists. As you seo from the map, the highland areas available
between 3,000 and 8,000 feet are marginal to a higher plateau. The higher parts
of Colombia are already occupied and no displacement of the relatively dense
highland population is possible. This means a survey valley by valley and region
by region and will take both time and money, In the end, groups of from 500 to
5,000 people would be accomodated. This would all add up to . minor item com
sidering the total population to be relieved.
II CENTRAL AMERICA
A protege of ain for some years, Dr. McBride, now of the University
of California at Los Angeles, has just returned from a six months' field study
of land tenure and land use in Central America. Two of his associates have
also studied the region within the past year. At my telegraphic request they
have sent me a 1,000 word summary of colonization possibilities in Central
America. Secretary Morganthau will send you a copy of this sumary. I left
my only copy with him last night to be forwarded to you, together with a cover-
ing letter from him.
The sumary adds up in brief to this that only one country has
major possibilities and that is Costa Rica. I should estimate a fairly 10-
mediate capacity for 50,000 people and possibly a capacity for 100,000 people.
The total population of Costa Rica is about 500,000. The available land is
located on the vestern and relatively dry side of the Cordillers. All of the
sastern slopes of Central America are heavily wooded and the plains near the
coast are jundle-covered, in response to excessive rainfall. It is only west
of the mountains or in drier pockets in the mountains that the white race has
established itself on an important scale.
From the standpoint of health, marketable production, transport, group
settlement, and the 11za, Costa Rica is unrivalled in Latin America.
Ш BRAZIL
1 - Wastern Sao Paulo
Here is & large pioneer zone in process of rapid development. I
doubt if Branil vill permit large subors of foreign colonists to enter this
Regraded
THE
President Franklin D. Roosevel
COPY
except
SOCA. Her own people need it and their products are of little value for
subsistence, outside of coffee and Brasil already has an embarrassing-large
quantity of coffee. The political aspects of this settlement 4706 over-
weigh all other considerations and I need not trouble you with details until
these political aspects are cleared up.
2 - Northeastern Brazil
In view of the experience of come of the colonists in dry land
countries at the Eastern and of the Mediterranean, it is worth while to 000>>
sider the possibility that the Brasilian Covernment would extend a walcome to
such colonists who may help Brasil in reclamation projects is the states of
Ceará, Parahyba and Rio Grande Do Morts, This area suffers from recurrent
droughts. It is highly productive when irrigated. It is that part of Drazil
which corresponds with our dry West. They have borrowed our engineers and
our ideas extensively and have made progress. The advantages of settlement
here might be summed up in the following terms fair sise group settlement,
controlled health conditions, nearness to the sea, settlement based on capital
economically expéried on technical projects whose character is well known.
The low latitude (4 degrees to 8 degrees 8) seens to be & drawback, but there
is some elevation above the sea and the capital expenditures would sustain Low
grade labor available elsewhere in Brasil.
IV BOLIVIA - PARAGUAY
1 - Bolivis
There is room for perhaps 50,000 people along the mountain border of
Bolivia facing the Gran Chaco. This would require & brief field survey. for
that the boundary line has been settled, development will proceed rapidly.
Capital is greatly wanted in Bolivia. The government would probably welcome
such & settlement. While the region is within the tropics, its Latitude is
about 18 to 22 degrees and the elevation sufficient to make it tolerable. Be
doubt there will soon be & good outlet to the projected new port on the Paragany
River. The greater part of the Gran Chaco is not suited for settlement under
present conditions. It is either too dry or flooded very much, as in the case
of the llanos of Venesuela.
2 - Paraguay
There are possibilities for settlement of perhaps 25,000 people in Para-
guay, looking ahead for ten years. The cultural level is low. The colonists
would have to bring their culture with then. This requires group settlement
and outlets to the Paraguay River. It is no paradise, but space can be forms
for 4 quite limited number in relatively small groups. It is not a. recommended
area.
I SOUTHERN CHILE
There is only OBS area in Chile that is still capable of absorbing
immigrants. It is the province of is Fronters. Only those colonists who ATD
strong physically should attempt to settle here. The type of settlement is
like that in Michigan and Ohio in pioner days. The hos and axe would be
wielded. Mixed farming 1a the rule. There is as excess of rain during half
Regraded
49
THE PRESIDENT
THE JOHNS HOPKINS UNIVERSITY
BALTIMORE MARYLAND
President Franklin D. Ressevelt - 4
COPY
Regraded Uclassified
the year, but the health of the colonists needs good; however, the
Chileans themselves need the land. I doubt if it is feasible to in-
duce them to open the door to more than 10,000 people.
II AFRICA
My time being limited, I have asked for an assistant, who will
join as on Wednesday morning at nine o'clock and compile similar -
maries of settlement conditions in the former German colonies of Africa
and elsewhere on that continent, as well as in South Eastern Anis. With-
in two weeks at the latest these summaries will be ready, together with
appropriate saps. If it is agreeable to you, I will forward the through
Mr. Morgantham, since he will be more closely informed of your where-
abouts.
It is an exciting search. May I say that it has given m great
pleasure to supply the information that you desire.
Sincerely yours,
Isaiah Bowman
President Franklin Do Roosevelt,
The White House,
Washington, D. C.
3
50
File 10.mgo
Regraded Uclassified
Report No. 10-38
20 November, 1938
STRICTLY CONFIDENTIAL
THE CONVERSATIONS AT CHANGSHA BETWEEN THE
BRITISH AMBASSADOR AND CHIANG KAI-SHEK
1. The recent talks nt Changaha on November 4th and 6th
between the British Ambassador and Chinng Kai-shek were not,
AS had been generally rumored in the press, the medium for the
former to convey to the latter peace terms from the Japaness.
The shoe WAS, in fact, quite on the other foot. Chiang Kai-shek
did most of the talking, as in indicated in the Aide Memoire
of their first conversation, n verbatin copy of which 18 appended
to this report.
2. Although I had felt that Chiang was still adamant on the
question of continuing resistance and knew in advance that Sir
Archibald's visit was the result of nn invitation which the Gener-
allasimo had extended to him during the course of their last meet-
ing at Hankow Into in July, I myself was led to believe by the
persistent reports coming over the radio news broadcasts just
prior to his arrival at Changeha that he might be the purveyor of
terms. It WRB obvious that if Japan could not arrange terms After
the almost simultaneous capture of Hankow and Centon, there were
no key points or centere in the field ahead of them the onpture of
which could be used either to bring pressure on the Chinese or
which could be publicised in Japan AS the "final victory" of the
war. I was led to the further suspicion of possible peace efforts
by the Ambassador, as his entourage approached Changeha from
Kunting, by secretive hints from my friend, the Commanding Officer
of HVS Bandpiper", that he had received very important desptnches
for H.X. which contained amazingly easy peace proposals. I gather-
ed that either the British Embassy in Shanghai or Tokyo was forward-
ing these, the general nature of which included A ninety nine year
lease on Manchoukuo, demilitarization of China north of the Yellow
River, complete withdrawal of Japanese troops to the const (with
certain conditions) and agreement to negotiate with the Kuomintang
conditional upon certain changes in personnel and policy.
3. I later discussed these points with Sir Archibald direct.
Re laughed and said they were what his friend Mr. Tani (the Japanese
Minister nt Large in Shanghai) had frequently spoken to him about.
When he had asked Mr. Tani, however, if he might discuss these terms
with the Generalissimo and present them no n formal proposal, Mr.
Tani had benten a hasty retreat, saying they were only hie own ideas
and not officially approved. (obviously lacking the Army's con-
currence)
+. The British Ambassador arrived at Changeha on the evening
of November 3rd accompanied only by & young private secretary and
his new Military Attnohe, Lt. Col. C, N. Spear. At the invitation
of the Captain of HM3 "Sandpiper", I was among those who not him.
Mr. Donald had arrived that afternoon from Nan Yush (Reng Than),
where the Generalissimo was staying, to arrange the talks. The
Generalissimo and Madame Chiang onse up the came night and went to
the private villa of the Governor of Runan on the outskirts of the
city. Chiang Eni-shek had just returned from a trip to Manchang by
car where he had gone for a military conference. (Re and his party
had flown from Hankow to Hengyang when they evacuated on the night
of October 24th and he want to Nanchang moon afterwards.) Sir
Archibald expressed pleasure at seeing me when he arrived and
immodintely inquired in Mr. Donald's presence If we might have a
chat while he was there. Mr. Donald had arranged for him to lunch
with the Generalissimo on the following day, November 4th, and
to have his first talk with the Generalissimo in the course of the
afternoon. 3ir Archibald thereupon suggested that I come the day
following.
Regraded Uclassified
-2-
-2
5. I met Mr. Donald the next morning while he was waiting
to escort the Ambassador to lunch. He discussed in general the
failure of the British to live up to their commitments as &
member of the League of Nations and help China; their silence
over the onpture of Canton and the portents of that action to
Hongkong: and asserted that it was idle to criticize the Chinese
methods of fighting the war. He said they were doing it their
own way because they are Chinese, but that what England and the
U.S.A. had to decide WAS whether they wished to see China & under
and with that event lose their prestige and potential trade in
China, or preserve these by helping China now. He was convinced
that if Great Britain and nothing about Canton, her silent no-
quiesence would have serious repersussions on her prestige alse-
where, aspecially in India.
6. I saw Sir Archibald the following noon, November 5th,
just before lunch, but any opportunity to spenk with him privately
about his talk the day before was forestalled by the entry of Lt.
Col. Spear and the host. He therefore only remarked in general
about what had transpired saying that Chiang Kat-chek had asked
him some very embarrassing questions na to what London WAS Moing
to no about Centon. Air raid alarms prevented me from seeing Mr.
Donald this date, the foreign residences being on an island in
the river and the Chinese soldiers Along the banks having the dis-
RCT nhle habit of taking pot shots at anything which noved during
non air alarm. (If one could have been sure they were aiming nt him,
it would not have mattered, but the danger lay in the stray whots.)
7. I met Mr. Donald the following morning, November 6th, by
crossing the river before breakfast to heat the alarms. He re-
marked, however, that my inability to cross on the previous day
had not mattered as he had been busy All morning writing the Aide
Manoire of the convernations batween the Ambassador and the General-
issimo of the day before. He asked if Y had seen the Ambassador
and if he had told me about his talk, When I replied that the Am-
bassador had mentioned the general tone of his talk, but had been
precluded by other guests from discussing it, Mr. Donald dilated
n bit on the fact that the Generalissimo had bluntly asked London
what they were going to do. Mr. Donald discoursed again on the
possible results to British trade and influence if they failed to
not and then advised me to 600 31r Archibald again and ascertain
if he would give me the full details of the Aide Memoire. He
characterized it na n very important document which he felt washington
should R180 see, but enid he did not feel free to reveal it without
permission na my Ambassador would naturally resent any nuch liberty
If he vere similarly placed. I informed him that I was to have
lunch that noon with the Ambassador and would endervor to obtain n
chnt with him Inter when I falt reasonably mire he would grant the
necessary permission.
8. Mr. Donald then informed no that if the democracies fail
China nt this time, she obviously would have to turn elsewhere and
that the question of her policy for the coming year would be the
chief point on the agenda at the forthooming meeting of the Central
Executive Committee of the Kuomintang which would take place in
of A turn toward Russia and asked if during the intervening period
Chungking early in December. I inquired if there were any chance
after we had left Hankow nt the beginning of August until our re-
turn just before the fall of the city the Russians had presented
any quid pro quo to the Generalissimo in return for increased aid
from them. (Both Mr. Donald and Madame Chiang had repeatedly denied
to me in the past that this had ever occurred, saying that China
had paid for all of the help she had received from Hossow.) He
replied that the Passians now had something over one hundred planes
at Lanchow and that they had approached the Generalissimo shortly
before the decision mg made to leave Mankow with the proposal that
Regraded Uclassified
-3-
53
they would make not only those, but As many nore available to him
if he would agree to continue resistance against Japan, Chiang had
enorted and replied that he intended to continue resistance whether
they helped or not. (It deema pertinent to remark here, AS I have
stated previously, that Chinng Kal-shek has been consistent from
the very beginning in this respect and in his policy to carry on the
war to a finish. He has taken the point of view that his cause is
gues one and that sinter democracies could not fail ultimately to
come to China's assistance. He has spurned all suggestions of help
with conditions attached - vis: the Britich suggestion last Spring
that be remove Dr. Kung.)
0. )tr. Donald then stated that if China turned away from the
democracies he thought it would be toward Geruany and the totali-
tarian states; that they had already given far more material aid
to Chinn through their barter agreement and military advisors than
any other country and that the barter system not only had great
potentiality in the post-war reconstruction of China, especially
since China would have no money, but that the Germans had proved
themselves peculiarly adept at doing business with the Chinese.
I inquired how this could be reconciled with the Berlin-Tokyo agree-
ment and where China would stand vis-a-vie Japan in such an event.
He then revealed one of the most important points in the Aide Memoire,
namely, that the Generalissimo had always known and now had especially
coon reason to believe that he could get very easy pence terms from
Japan anytime he would agree to the exclusion of the British from
China. He said he had already advised Chiang, however, that if it
came to that point, he should make terms through Berlin rather than
directly with Japan. He reiterated his belief that n German-Japanese
economic alliance would have n. genuine chance of success in develop-
ing China after the war. (I had already discussed with Mr. Regers
in Hongkong sometime ngo the possibilities of An extension of the
German barter system on n grand scale to China, but from the point
of view of weaning Germany away from Japan and effecting nome kind
of understanding with England, France and other states. He had #X-
pressed serious concern over the potentiality of this weapon of
Hitler's, saying that he WAS intimately requirinted with Dr. Johaot
and respected his ability. It is B question worthy of serious thought,
particularly if it includes Japan and excludes the rest of us.
10. I then went to lunch with the British Ambassador and
immediately afterward neked If I might have n word alons. He readily
namented and took me to his badroom where he walked up and down and
talked -ithout restraint for over AN hour. I recorded the following
Memorandum of this conversation immediately afterward:-
11. I ovened the converention by recalling to him what he had
told me the day before of Chiang Kai-shek having faced him with the
fait accompli of Canton; mentioned a conversation I had had with
Rohere over the possibility of weaning Germany away from Japan in
nome cort of joint economic agreement with other nations; of the
Intent possibilities in the barter system; of the belief held by
Donald and Captain Stennes that Germany might nosist Japan in China
by this means; and inquired what he thought of the possibility of
China turning away from the democracies completely and renching an
understanding with the totalitarian states.
12. 8ir Archibald said that he too had been giving serious
thought to this question. He and he had just been engaged all
morning in preparing & draft message to London. He said that in
his conversation the day previous with Chinng Kai-shek, he had
nsked Chiang frankly for A statement of his military position and
his possibilities for continuing resistance, telling Chiang it me
much more desirable to get it from him direct than to have to guess
at it. The Generalissimo replied that he now had sixty divisions
Regraded Uclassified
-4-
north of the river, sixty south thereof and A like number tn recerve.
(The Ambassador asked me what strength these would represent and
seemed surprised when I told him that they averaged five to might
thousand effectives before going into the line and the figures given
undoubtedly included many units which by now were mere skeletons.)
Chieng had stated that these would soon be reorganized for notive
mustrilla warfare nn/ that his policy would be to present to the
Japanese n constant threat of attack while continuing general resist-
nnce, always giving way where necessary to avoid too severe losses
and ultimately to choose his own ground for battle. The Generalissimo
had said he had supplies for more than n year yet nt the 'present
state of wastage' and expected to continue his program of resistance
unabated.
13. The Ambassador said that Chinng had spoken with great
frankness and with considerable agitation on his position via-a-vis
Great Britain. Re stated that he had held Ohina together nil these
months on the plen that aid would be forthooming eventually from
the mocrátio countries, notably Great Britain, and bluntly naked
for FL showdown and B simple "Yes" or "No" on the question. Re put
it up to the Ambassador that if China were not going to obtain nid
from Great Britain and the U.S.A she obviously would be faced with
turning elsewhere and naked Clerk-Kerr what he would do if he were
similarly placed. The Ambanandor told me he obviously had to agree.
14, Bir Archibeld said he had then asked Madame Chiang, who
"YAN translating, if the Generalissimo would not come out frankly
with what was in his heart. Madame Chinng inquired If he really
wanted the truth and the Ambassador replied that they would be much
better off to have it out then And there. Chiang Kai-shek became
visibly excited at the question and said that Great Aritain might
no well understand that they were at the parting of the ways. If
Great Britain chose to help China, she would have China forever;
If are rejected this final appeal then China would turn completely
away from Great Britain and never have anything more to do with
her: that he himself would never consult Clark Kerr on 8 single
muention. The Generalissimo added that the Chinese have long
memories and that if Great Britain forsook China at this time, they
would never forget 1t and would make then pay for it ultimately.
15. The Ambassador said that the problem was a very serious
one and that he was at A loss AS to how bent to cope with it. He
recalled to me his previous efforts nt obtaining B loan for China
to support the currency and said he had gotten his Foreign Office
Trensury where he had been blocked by Bir John Simon. He remarked
completely with him on the question, but had been unable to get the
that I no doubt knew the latter's attitude toward Japan. He said
that Sir John lived in absolute fear of Japan and une constantly
who constantly sent home despatches about the power of Japan. Sir
encouraged in this by his colleague in Tokyo (Sir Robert Craigiel
Archibald said that he and Craigie differed absolutely on the
question of the effect of the present war upon Japan; that he felt
the war WAB & tremendous strain on Japan which sooner or later must
produce n. Reneral breakdown (he sald he felt this might come with-
in another six to 02/ght months time) while Ornigie kopt insist-
ing that Japan was in no such danger and had not yet falt the strain
of the war to any extent. Clark Kerr said that he thought our rep-
resentatives in Japan lived too cloistered An existence to know the
true state of nff irs there.
16. Sir Archibald remarked that the loan involved was a
relatively small amount and that he was now engaged in drafting 6
Kni-shek had mentioned the fact that if Great Britain could only
despatch to try and re-open the question. He said that Chiang
give him something tangible to show the country such as & loan to
support the currency he could satisfy them. Clark Kerr was not
sanguine as to the prospects of A. loan, however. He renarked that
T. V. Boong had told him during a recent conversation in Hongkong
Regraded Uclassified
55
-5-
that China was endenvoring to establish n stabilization fund
of nix million pounds sterling to which the Chinese banks
would contribute helf and had asked if the British banks would
contribute the balance. (Rogere conceived this idea in Hongkong in
first approached the Hongkong and Shanghai Banking Corporation
September while I WRIT there.) The Ambassador said that he had
ample security for their depositors and bondholders. Mm had then
who, while favorably inclined, had refused because there WAS no
referred the matter to the Bank of England from whom he had not
yet otten an answer. Re remarked that he had quite understood
the Hongkong and Shanghai Bank's position, but that the Bank of
an they had done in Austria in 1982 where they had gotten away with
Ingland could afford to be sentimental and take a chance occasionally
it. Re stated that he had proposed the original loan to China AS
the first stop of a long-view policy with the second step to be
telum next year if the situation were still favorable: that if it
proved otherwise it would always be possible to step acide and that
the loan itself would always be emply justified AS an investment
in good-will.
17. The Ambrasador then told as the following in strict con-
(1)ence. He said that last July thile he who having dinner one night
with the Chiang Kai-sheke along with Mall Patch and others of his
Hission, Madame asked him to step outside and speak to the Generalissim
"lonn for a minute, She marned him to listen carefully to what the
Generalissimo said na he had rehearsed it and that she had never
before known him to make such n statement to A foreigner.
18. Chaing Kni-shek had commended (speaking in short sen-
Lended, whereas he usually 10 hard to interpret because of his
length) by saying that he had known several British Ambassadors.
Me spoke well of Lampson, whom he had liked, Cadagan he had also
liked withough he found him lean sympathetic and lacking in
imagination. Knatohbull-Hugesson he had not cared for 80 much.
But no. Clark Kerr, the Generaliasimo had found by far the most
understanding of them all, Chiang Kai-shek therefore desired to
know If Clark Kerr would be willing at times to nut aside his
official renk and advise him on matters M he might request.
Clark Kerr en16 he himself uttered a lot of depresatory sputter-
inc during this effusive outburst by the Generalissimo and assured
him he would be most glad to comply with the request. An they
walked out Madame Chinng again impressed upon him how absolutely
unique and unusual this action had been on the part of her husband.
19. A few days Inter the Genernlissimo invited him to oall
nnn, referring to this incident, said he would like to make his
first pequest. He thereupon asked Clark Kerr if the latter thought
the Chinese Government needed reorganizing and, if no, what would
be suggest. The Ambassador said he turned to Madame Channe and
naked if he really could reply frankly. She urged him to do 80.
He then told Chiang Kni-shek that he thought reorganization very
amrtously needed. Re and if he were Chiang Kai-shek his first
move wild be to call all members of the family to Hankow, in-
cluded Badame Phin Yet-sen, and to bring the Young Marshal out of
retirement. He would then line them up and present a solld front
to the Japanese ('have all of them twenk their noses nt the
have M drastic result in Japan. He recommended that Dr. Kung be
Japanese', as he expressed it). He said he thought this would
retained no President of the Executive Yuan (remarking aside to
me that he are this to save Kung's face, but placed him where he
could do no harm). He suggested that Madame Sun be made Minister
of Cooperatives or something similar (telling me he purposely
included her to take oare of the Communist element) and strongly
recommended Madame Ching as Minister of Foreign Affairs. (Although
Regraded Uclassified
88
-6-
the Coregoing nounds semi-jocular, he related it in all
anriounness.)
20. He then went on to recommend to the Generalissimo
that De reorganize the entire Government along the lines of the
membership of the People's Political Convention (which he anid he
thought had been very well chosen) and that he pointed out to
Chinne Kaishek the need for placing men according to ability and
qualification rather than giving All of the plume to former com-
redea and old cronies. The Ambassador said his suggestions met
with a chilly response and obviously 01 / not meet with the ap-
nroval of the Generalissimo who remarked that if Madame Sun came
to Hankow she would only be n mouthpiece for the Communists. The
Ambasendor said he had talked with Madame fun in Hongkong; that
he liked her best of the whole family: and that she had expressed
her "ssire to go to Hankow if the Generaliscimo would only invite
her.
1. The Ambansador promised to show me the despatch he was
trafting to the Foreign office concerning the Alle Memoire and
readily assented to my request to be permitted to read the Aide
anoire. HIP copy was nt the moment out on the sunboat. Re
neked me to return in n day or two to see the despatch, remarking
that he actually had no business doing this. He and he had re-
cently proposed that the Aritish, French and U. 3. Governments
should make separate but ne nearly identional ns possible declara-
tions affirming their support of China. The French, he stated,
the indicated their willingness to do 80, but the proposal was
fromed on and killed by the U.S.A. He inquired who our present
counsellor of Embasey in London was and said he understood this
officer had been instrumental in it. The Ambassador termed the
attitude of his own government toward the recent situation "con-
temptible". He said he un erstood the general limitations which
restrained the U.S.A. from taking direct action, but inquired if
I know whether this were further constricted or aggravated by
any particular individuals in Washington. I denied any such
knowledge. The Ambassador and his party had dinner with the
Conerolissimo that same ovening, but as the party was fairly
large. nothing further transpired.
22. The following morning, November 7th, I met Mr. Donald
no he was going for n. talk with the Ambasendor. When I told him
T had received permission to see the Aide Memoire, he pulled his
copy out of his pocket and loaned it to me while he went to keep
his engagement. He likewise conveyed to me An invitation from
l'adama Chiang to come to lunch the following day. I returned to
my Quarters nt once and made the attached copy of the Aide Vemoire.
23. Lunch the next day WAS A simple family affair served on
n oned table with only Mr. Donald in addition to the Chiangs.
Madrine Chiang told me before lunoh that the Generaliscimo had
been told that I was acquainted with what he had said to the
British Ambassador. The Generalissimo appeared looking quite
fresh and showing no signe of the strain he had exhibited during
the Intter days nt Mankow. I have seen him numerous timen in the
past so there were no formalities between us.
14. I let him open the convernation and he started by nsking
me when the new U. 5. battleships would be completed and If they
would be larger and more numerous than those being buils by Japm.
He appeared elightly surprised and disappointed when I told him
they probably would not be Inunched until 1942 or 1943. (I had
to guess at this na I have been out off from the news A good deal
Regraded Uclassified
-7-
recently, but did not want to give him any ancouragement on this
score.) I told him I are not know what Japan's building program
15, but that I doubted if they could afford to compate with us.
He then asked how much longer President Roosevelt had to serve
and agemed to brighten when I told him two years. Re asked if
the President could be re-elected and nodded pleasantly when I
told him there was no legal bar to this. He inquired if I thought
public opinion against Japan WAS growing in the U.S.A. and nodded
understandingly when I told him that I thought it was, but added
that its development was gradual and that the American public
naturally were more interested in their own affairs and were primar-
11y desirous of peace.
25. I then repeated briefly what Clark Kerr had told the of
the Generalissimo's military program and inquired if this were
essentially correct. He agreed except to amend the part about
sixty divisions north of the river and sixty more south thereof.
Me satd that was roughly the present distribution, but that he pro-
posed to une sixty east of the two railyny lines, sixty to the
went thereof and the balance in reserve under reorganization. He
explained that n great many of these divisions had been in the
field for several months and that Home were now reduced to the
strength of only one company. These had to be pulled out for reat
and recrganization while others had to be brought up. Other than
the mention of the railway lines, he did not mention & front as such,
but merely ascerted that he intended to keep the Japanese under the
constant threat of attack in all areas. He spoke of the guerrilla
taction which had been carried out all of these months and said the
Chincee would depend on these rather than sacrifice their strength
in trying to hold any particular point. He appeared to me to be
very confident in this respect and I believe he is imbued with the
excerience he had in fighting the Communists for years.
26. I had expected the Generalissimo to nak me questions about
what we were going to do to help him and when he failed to do no,
T referred to what he had said to the British Ambassador and in-
cuired if I were to infer that this applied with equal force to the
U.S.A. He will called awny from the table just as I finished putting
the question, but na he rose to leave he replied that he thought that
and better wait until he could discuss it directly with my Ambassador.
97. I walked for nn hour after lunch in the garden with Vadame
Chiang and Mr. Donald. I asked Madame Chiang for an explanation
of the Canton debacle which would explain or refute the assumption
of the general public that there had been a "sell-out". She denied
vigorously that there had been any bribery. She referred me to the
Generalissimo's public statement of October 30th and added that
Yu Han-mou had failed to make the proper disposition of his troops
because his staff officers and troop lenders were inferior. The
mentioned that a statement in regard to this had been included in
the Generalissimo's public announcement, but Mr. Donald interrupted
to say that "we" (presumably he and Hollington Tong) had out out
that part. She then went on to say that this plus the fact that
the British had failed to intervene had produced the present
situation, but added that they were now fighting to recover the
lost ground and said the Generaliscimo had had a telegram just the
previous evening that Sanshui had been re-captured. She denied that
the Japanese had made any progress along the railway north of Canton.
The stated that the Generalissimo was receiving hundreds of telegrame
from overseas Chinese demanding that Ohina continue to resist Japan
and calling for the punishment of Yu Han-mou and Wes Teh-chen. The
614 not, however, enlarge on the latter point.
Regraded Uclassified
20. I naked point-blank how the Generalissimo could adopt
the alternative he had mentioned to the British Ambassador of
making sany terms with Japan if he would completely renounce the
British. I pointed to the widespread feeling against Japan and
the fact that the Japanese army exists As a physical enemy and
invader. The 111 not blink an eye, but replied simply that she
thought the people would do whatever the Generalissimo told them
was best when the time crume. I then referred to the 1924-1930 ere
when the anti-foreign feeling was so high; contrasted it with
recent months when the people had been 80 friendly to foretgners:
and maked If officials would take the lead in turning the people
against Great Britain in order to make possible a peace trenty with
Japan. I added that the comparison of the two periods had led me
to believe that public opinion in China could be influenced vary
easily by officials. She dodged the question by saying that she
and the Generalissimo had worked very hard for a long time to bring
about R. friendly feeling toward foreigners. I nsked again About
the questions which had been presented to the British Ambassador
and inquired if they are not apply with equal force to the U.S.A.
She reiterated that any actual statement on the question should
nenit n. meeting between the Ceneralissimo and my Ambassador, but
and that we "might well consider the questions asked Great Britain
MB the handwriting on the wall".
29. I saw the British Ambannador again that Afternoon for
another long talk, Re asked If I had seen the Aide Hemotre. Then
I told kin I had, he stated be had radiond all of it to London ex-
cept the reference to Hninan Island which he thought WAS super-
fluous and weakened the argument. He said he d1' not desire to give
London any point on which to quibble. He apolagized for not being
able to show me his despatch which he said had just gone to the
whip to be coded, but told me it followed the lines of what we had
discussed the previous time. He handed me from his table another
Mespatch which he had just drafted in which he had outlined briefly
the Generalissimo's general attitude and determination to continue
resistance.
m. When I referred to the points in the Aide Vemoire AS an
"Ultimatum" he picked me up immediately. He emphasized that there
had been no questions of nn ultimatum on the part of Chiang Kni-shek
during their conversation and that he himself, after reading the
Aide Venoire, had sent n. accond telegram to London to emphasize this.
He and that Chinng had put the questions simply AA statements of
fact to which he desired an immediate answer: that Chinng had stated
that he had always desired friendly relations with Great Britain
and up to the present had been confident that Great Britain would
help China, but that the time had arrived when he had to have some-
thing tangible to show the people, if it were only a loan to support
the currency. when Chiang had stated that he had 'several other
courses open' if London failed him, the Ambassador had naked if
Russia were one of these. Chian had silently assented, but had
offered no further information on this point. Str Archibald seeme
surprised when I told him that both Madame Chiang and Donald had
fically denied on several occasions that the Russians had ever prs-
sented n quid pro quo to the Generalissimo. I mentioned the recent
case of the planes nt Lanchow and he said that Donald had also told
him that.
31. The Ambassador said that he was nt & loss to understand
his country's attitude; that he could not understand why they
fear Japan, especially now when Japan is obviously too workened
even to think of fighting any other country. Re said that prior
to assuming this post he had naked in the Foreign Office If they
could give him any directive as to the policy they wished to pursus
out here. He was told that he would have to work it out largely
for himself, but that in general they thought the Chinese and
Japanane should fight it out among themselves. Re again referred
to their present position AD "contemptible" said frankly he did
Regraded Uclassified
-9-
not know has to solve the problem.
3% T had made plans to leave Changisha at once and get to
Chungicing no soon AB possible with my information. The Ambassador
had already pursuaded the Chinese to send him on to the coast via
Nanchang to Foochow. I accompanied him from the above interview
to the cunboat where he was greeted with & message from his rep-
recentative in Chungking urging him to come here to avoid offend-
inf: the government officials. The Ambassador changed his plans on
the spot and, turning to me, inquired if I would like to join his
caravan. I accepted because it afforded me an opportunity for
further conversation and likewise provided company through the
bandit region of eastern Kweichow which people had been advising
me to avoid.
33. When T went to the local airport to see him off 0.8 fin
left by private plans for Hongkong on the afternoon of November
19th, The told ne he had been receiving urgent messages from Sir
Robert Craigie asking for permission to show the Aide Memoire to
his American colleague. Re said Sir. Robert also had recently
changed his tune very dioddly with regard to Japan and that he hoped
to draft A meanage on the plane enroute to Hongkong to ket off to
London from there and take advantage of this change of heart while
it insted.
34, M r. Donald informed me just before I left Changaha that
they had Accided to cable the Aide Memoire to Dr. Hu 3hin in
Washington, but that they had added an injunction that he was not
to show it to anyone until he received permission. Mr. Donald said
they had done this to permit me to reach Chunghing with it first.
35, I have presented the foregoing in rather exhaustive de-
tail with E. double purpose, (1) I desired to give na accurate AE
possible an account of what actually transpired and was said in
order that it could be evaluated in its true perspective, and (2)
to bring out my belief that the information was not "oooked up"
or "planted" on me by either the British or Chinese. I merely
happened to be on the spot when the talks took place and to have
had the advantage of prior intimacy with both parties plus nn in-
formal status which permitted them to talk freely to me.
36. Conclusions
After my arrival in Chungking with the foregoing in-
formation our Ambassador requested that I submit to him a Memo-
randum containing my reactions and opinions concerning the present
situation in the 11ght of what I had experienced at Changeha. I
appond hereto as Enclosure "A" n 00py of this memorandum as my
conclusions to this report.
Regraded Uclassified
CONFIDENTIAL
CO
OFFICE OF THE NAVAL ATTACHE
AMERICAN EMBASSY
CHUNGKING
24 November, 1938.
MEMORANDUM FOR THE AMBASSADOR
Subject: The Conference at Changeha Between the
Generalissimo and the British Ambassador
and the Interest of the United States in
the Situation Resulting Therefrom.
1. Upon first reading the Aide Memoire and taling with
Vr. Donald and Madame Chiang thereafter, I gained the impression
that Chiang Kni-shek had presented the British with an ultimatum
and I so referred to it, as noted in my report, in my second
conversation with Sir Archibald. The document containe both the
time element in its request for an immediate "Yes" or "No" reply
from London and what on first glance appears to be an implied
threat in its assertion of there being alternative courses of
action if the British fail. In the light of the British Ambassador's
subsequent explanation and of further consideration of the situation,
however, I believe that Chiang Kai-shek nerely confronted the British
with a cold assertion of fact and the simple statement that if they
do not come to China's aid, China must perforce seek assistance
alsewhere.
2. The situation 1a unquestionably very serious and must be
so denlt with. It presents a difficult problem and certainly one
not to be brushed naide with a light wave of the hand or n vague hope
that 'all will come out all right in the and'. It 10 true that at
the moment we are not AB much "on the spot" An the British, for
we are not n member of the League of Nations, we have made tangible
efforts at granting some kind of financial masistance to China
through the purchase of their silver and the recent negotiations
with the R. P. Chen Mission, and our note to Japan of October 6th
has been very favorably received by the Chinese. The British are
committed to specific courses of action which they are not implement-
ing: they have hinted at loans they are not producing: and they are
maintaining e. strange silence toward the preempting by Japan of
large commercial interests through which they onee dominated the
trade of the Par East. More than this, they have actually negotiated
with the Japanese on at least two occasions; the Customs Agreement
and the British American (Yee Tecong) tobacco interests.
3. But in the sense that we are the leading democracy of the
world and stand for announced principles which have been contra-
renad right and left ever since the invasion of Manchuria in 1931;
that It has been possible for Jaman to obtain important war materials
from us; that we have a large cultural stake in China which is in
danger of being swept away, we too are "on the spot". It in my
firm belief, therefore, that if Chine turns against Great Aritain,
we shall ultimately share the anna fate unless we produce more
tangible assistance to China, and do it in the next future.
Regraded Uclassified
-%-
C1
4. The problem of the moment can be stated very simply:
China is fighting for her life, for her independence AS n. nation.
Japan has declared her purpose on more than one coonsion of
dominating not only China, but the whole of the Par East: of
creating an "Asia for the Asiatios".
5, That do TR want, China or Japan?
5. The situation of the moment, as I see it, 1a AB follows:
China has been fighting a losting battle for sixteen months, confi-
dent that sooner or later the democracies must come to her neais-
twnos. The failure of the British even to make a statement, much
less this any action when Japan occupied Canton and out off Hong-
kong, GAME RS A oruel blow and rude awakening to the Chiness. They
have therefore naked the British, 'Are you going to help us or not?
Are you even going to stand up for your own interests? If not, we
must know it now and adopt some other policy.' China has now
reached the point where ahe 18 almost completely out off from supplies
and has only enough remaining to carry on the fight a few months
longer. She cannot wnit until the moment of total exhaustion comes
to make her decision.
7, our problem has to be analyzed from the two angles AB
stated. Do we want n strong, stable, peaceful and independent Chine,
or do - want An Asia dominated by Japan?
8. The Japanese program is clearly one of driving us and our
institutions out of Asia. Any attempt to minimize this, to regard
1% ae temporary, to apologize for it, to seek hope in the fact that
n. vortion of the Japanese people may have been unsympathetic with
this war or to argue that our trade with Japan has been far more
valuable to us than our trade with China is short-sighted and
evenive to any the least. Let the ultimate goal of the Japanese be
clearly understood from the first, for it 10 cold and simple fact,
regardless of what friends of Japen may argue.
9. That the Japanese army my utilize the ald of the Germans
or other totalitarian states for A time during the process of
achieving this domination constitutes no saving olause for us. Any
benefit which either we or the British may derive through the
Japanese in the post-war economic rehabilitation period of the
present conflict, even if they emerge only semi-victorious, will
be temporary exactly in proportion to the degree of their victory
and the period of time it takes them to reach the point where they
feel strong enough to kick ue out. Any attempt to assume greater
hope than this 18 totally unwarranted in the face of what has al-
rendy transpired. They are arrogant, truculent and their promises
to us are wholly unreliable. No statement that they make to us
in worth the paper upon which it 18 written or the breath required
to utter it unless it be one of those not tofrequent occasions when
they let alip their real purpose. Anyone who may think his future
in anfo in their hands 10 taking n. very long chance.
10. The extent of the victory which they may nohieve from
their present venture 16 problematical. I have felt from the out-
net of this war, as I have stated in previous reports, that they
were walking into a awamp: that there are not enough Japanese in
Japan to patrol and police this vast country with its millions
of people; and that eventually the Chiness will suffoonts them
or rise and massacre them AS they did the Manchus after 250 years
under their rule. But the long point of view offers little solace
and no solution to our own immediate problem.
Regraded Uclassified
22
11. It has recently been suggested by a competent
authority on Japan that the Japanese do not intend to attempt
the "pecification" of all China: that they propose to eit down
on what they have, open and maintain the lines of communiontion,
establish trading outposts AS one would do in darkest Africa; and
let the Chinese "stew in their own joice" back in the interior.
It 10 this lesser goal, with the possibilities presented If the
Inconeze obtain the cooperation of the Germans and their barter
eyetem, which gives food for thought and 18 a problem worthy of
serious consideration. What its possibilities are ve do not know,
But what we do know 18 that it will exclude u.e and slam our "Open
Door" In our face.
12. Let it not be forgotten also that the present attempt
At conquest on the mainland of Acia 18 the Japanese Army program
and that the Japanese Nevy still has to be heard from, They have
had vary little part in this war to date. The Nevy program has
long been known to advocate expansion toward the South Reas. China
11, in reality, A great big farm and does not possess anything
like the wealth of undeveloped resources that many writers have
claimed. Rut to the south lie the Malay Peninsula and the mutch
Sant Indies with their known wealth of rubber, tin, 011 and other
resources. Will Japan ignore these if she succeeds in China?
13. In our present efforts to establish reciprocal trade
agreements with free nations throughout the world, which my lend
eventually to unrestricted trade among democratic nations, we have
our most potent weapon for an ultimate solution. But again this
11 not P. solution for the present crisin. Should no, can - nit
1117 h and mtch the world's next biggest democracy and one of
the most potential areas for the extension of this policy 00-
opted and stifled by Japan and her allies and closed to our commerce
simply because that nation 18 ntill too cumbersome and looking in
munitions and supplies to take care of itself?
14. Thus for ve have given the Chinese almost nothing but
moral support in this war while affording the Japanese the materials
for war. That - have done this latter not intentionally but mere-
ly in nurmanos of our own "open door" policy to any purchaser who
has the money with which to buy 10 not n. satisfactory reason con-
affering the recult it in producing for us in Asia and the prospects
for the coor which we hope to keep open there.
15, The second angle of the problem 18 the Chinese side. In
my nuestions to Madame Chinng I indicated my apprehension that the
Chinese might be aroused against un by inflammatory speeches in
order to pave the way for peace with Japan. But it hrs since been
suggested to me, and it in very plausible, that if we continue our
policy of non-interferenee and fail to supply them with tahgible
evidence of our good will, they may automatically turn against us.
There in no reason why they shouldn't. They Are n nation fighting
for their life and, AR the British have been told, if the democration
do not help them, they naturally must turn to thone the will.
16. An X stated in n. recent despatch, I believe this feeling
would engily arise and would be very cirricult to combat. I lived
in China during the period of intenne anti-foreign feeling from
1924 onward, when whole cities burst into flames of hatred overnight
and illiterate coolies mouthed alogana against the foreigner; when
every Chinese eye had n. baleful mint in it AS n foreigner passed:
and when laborers, dook workers, factory employees and servants
staged "go-slow" strikes, "nit-down" strikes and outright strikes
accompanied by the most fantastic demande long before the C.T.O.
over thought of these devices.
Regraded Uclassified
C3
17. T have been very favorably impressed during recent
generally friendly attitude displayed toward us. It 10 true
yours, unA empecially during the one just passed, with the
that since the outbreak of the present war foreigners living
in China have been on common ground with the Chinese in hating
the Japanese and that this has greatly enhanced the feeling of
friendliness on the part of the Chinese toward foreigners. But
T have hann apprehensive for a long time that the day might some
when they eight turn up with the cry that we had failed them, for
the Chinese are past masters in the art of alibi and will never
movent the blame for the loss of the war themselves. Individ-
unlly they have never wanted the war from its very beginning.
They are n pence-loving people and they have constantly hoped
that someone also would come along and fight it for them. HAd
this third party appeared, they would have tossed him the haby
forthwith and let him carry 10. The Chinese aviators have al-
ready demonstrated this on several occasions, both with the
Russtans and the "Foreign Legion" 14th Squadron. But the Chinese
had to right this war alone in order to achieve any degree of
unity and they have already derived imessurable benefit from it
In this respect.
15. I remarked in my report No. 1-3/1 1nst January that I
thought An 1deal result for this vor would be for it to & on long
enough to burn the corruption and venality out of Chinese official
1150 and nt the name time to brenk the hold of the Japanese army
on libe national life of Japon. That the Chinese and Janeness
should clint it out between themselves has unquestionably benn the
point of view of many people and this has been correct up to N
onint. inst 00 one who has been in the thick of the war almost
Irrm itn beginning and who has travelled rather extensively through
the country in recent months, it 10 my considered opinion that we have
recebed the point where we no longer can leave the outcome to chance.
Some monle may sit back and may complacently that the Chinese will
never the able to do without the U.S.A. either economically or polit-
ically, but personally I An not BO nure.
111. Furthermore I believe that if feeling starts acainst us
15 one be fanned into flames very quickly by "soap box" orators
and radio broadcasters on the charge that we let them down. The
cry may start against the British who are far more culpable and
vulnerable than we for we made no promises and we are not n. League
Member. our position and our reasons for not helping have been
perfectly clear to un; they have been nothing like that clear to
the Chinese. And if A hue and cry should start against the British,
there would he little differentinting done by the Chinese mannes
between British and Americans. It may be paid that the British
were specific targets in Shanghai, Canton and Hongkong an 1925 and
1926 and that we did not suffer as much in comparison, but those
1020 specific areas where the target could be identified. Such
was not the case in other parts of China, as residents of Changaha,
for example, will tentify, and such will not be the once this time
If it comes.
20. I have emphasized the potential turn of feeling against
have to bring out one point: that irrespective of the outcome of
this war, the recent conferences at Changeha impressed no particular-
1y with one fact -- namely that we are faced with the immediate
question of retaining China's good will. Whether the war ends in
n. stalemate with neither side winning, or Japan wine, or China com-
promises with Japan, we have this question to answer now, We have
154 years of cultural effort behind us in China. Almost every
other member of the present government to American educated. Dut
our pupils are the ones who vill be most disappointed, and in many
Regraded Uclassified
24
OASES disillusioned, If we fail them now.
21. The main question, however, still in: Do we want a
strong and independent China, or one dominated by Japan? The
immediate problem is, will we not to preserve China's good will
while ve still retain it? The answer to the latter will largely
constitute the answer to the former. It hardly needa saying
that if Japan achieves any marked degree of success in this ven-
ture, ve shall have to build A havy several times no large na
the one we now contemplate. The best insurance we orn obtain
for Dence and for the futther development of our trade program
10 as strong, independent, penceful And friendly China together
with a chastened, not FL ruined Japan. The only hope of achieving
that, I believe, is to retain the good will of the Chinese before
it 18 too late.
22. The present Government of China, despite its many short-
cominge, 16 the only one in recent years that has ever done any-
thing for the people. It has represented that which we regard
no rational and that with which we have some chance of doing
business along ti:e lines we desire and in accordance with the
principles for which we stand. It was achieving steady progress
in the development of China before this war commenced. There is
bound to be chaos and disorder for A time after this war, whoever
wins, Let there be no mistake about that. But the support of
Chinng Kai-shek and his government offers by far the most hope for
11. solution of this chaon and n return to normalcy in the minimum
possible time.
23. It is not A question of the Luomintang versus the Eighth
Route Army and which set of principles should guide the govern-
ment of China. That is something for the Chinese to work out for
imselves after the Japanese have been pulled off of their backs.
In that respect our interest again lies in maintaining the friend-
ship of the Chinese and in influencing them thereby to adopt
orderly processes of government in harmony with those for which
we stand. It need only be remarked in passing that the no-called
Communist Farty continue to support the Central Government with
apparent sincerity; that they have again refrained at the recent
People's Politioal Convention from endorsing any resolution
critical of the Government; that they #till profess unbending
opposition to Japan (which 10 probably the best assurance available
to any who may fear n sudden Chinese compromise with Japan): and
that they show signa of developing into 6. democratic or porular
party rather than communists as we think of the term. If this trend
continues, they will provide China after the war with the healthy
political opposition which any democracy needs and thereby fores
the elimination of the undosirable and corrupt alements in the
Kuomintang.
24. There are many people in the U.S.A., and among them
some officials, who appear to think that there 10 no ground no-
tween war and full retreat. It has been my conviction for a
long time that there is a very wide stretch in there and that in
it lies the means to peace through firmnes and dignity. We have
got to do more than voioe our principles and write notes about
them. Te have got to insist step by step that they be recognized
and respected. In n. world which is relying on force we cannot
possibly hope to survive by lip nervice to altruism. We must
utilize our tremendous potentiality, both economically and finan-
oially in support of the principles for which we stand.
Regraded Uclassified
05
25, Nor can this be accomplished through a polloy of
indirection. It must be A studied program in which pressure
1ª applied step by step with the *111 to fight If necessary na
the last move. This is the point that our people must come to
realize -- that we cannot run away from war or leave it until
come VA/118 future date when we might be invaded. When the time
arrives, if it ever does, that any foreign power or combination
thereof feels strong enough to attempt to invade the U.S.A., it
will probably be too late for 118 to resint offectively. But
the United States can be invaded in more ways than by AN army.
The influx of chesp Japanese products in recent years and its
harmful effect on our labor situation WAS a case in point,
"B. I have entched the Jananese ever wince they invaded
Manchuria in 1931. They have proceeded sten by step - phase by
chare - looking back over their shoulders at us after each move.
Then 76 failed to do more than protest, they proceeded with the
next nove and have grown increasingly bolder. I AM convinced
they can be stopped by firmess, by a progressive program of
prossure, backed by the will to fight if necessary R8 R last "A-
mort. It will be this realization by them of that determination
on our part which will stop them.
29. There are many ways and means to apply this pressure.
" have already intimated retaliation in kind in our note of
October 6th. It 18 to be hoped that we take steps to implement
It, For impodiate use there in the elastic tariff scale and I
believe its use thoroughly justified immediately in respect to
situations much All now exist nt Teingtao and other North China
ports in the manipulation by the Japanese of their Federated
Bank currency in discrimination against our merchants. Further
end more dractic steps will have to be authorized by legislation
and our every move should be directed toward obtaining what 78
need in this respect.
28. Ours 10 no longer FA, question of mulling the British
chestnute out of the fire. The time has come when we must not
to give our own, for they are already scorching. If we have
theirs for them in the process, that will be their good fortune -
and possibly not such an unfortunate result for un at that!
Respectfully muhmitted,
J. X. Vollugh
Captain, U. 3.4.0.
Assistant Navn) Attache.
Regraded Uclassified
CONFIDENTIAL
AIDE VINOIRE OF CONVERSATION BETWEEN THE GENERALISSIMO
AND SIR ARCHIBALD CLARK KERR ON NOVEMBER FOURTH, 1938.
(Verbatim Copy)
{Enclosure a to Report No. 10-38, dated 20 Nov. 1930)
The Japanese occupied Canton with two motives in mind,
The first 18 the effect of auch occupation upon China, and the
second 1a the effect upon Great Britain. To strike at China
is of secondary importance while to strike at Great Britain
18 of major importance. By occupying Canton, Japan only outs
the Canton-Hankow Railway and blockades the waterways impeding
transportation and stopping supplies of munitions. Canton, too,
18 an important base for national resistance, and Japan hopes
by its occupation to break down the morale of the Chinese people.
However, the cost of landing and maintaining her forces there
will not be compensated by the above results alone. But in
striking n. death blow at Britain's historical prestige and
traditional morale, ahe immessurably enhances her own position
and value. The present blow to Great Britain 10 not as great
in effect AS it will be in the future. Japen hopes that just
RB Britain's power and prestige suffer in South China, here will
rise proportionately in the eyes of the Chinese and all Asintic
peoples,
Thue she hopes to occupy completely the historical place
formerly enjoyed by Great Britain during the last hundred years
Ad the dominant factor in Far Centern affairs.
By the successful occupation of Canton, Japan hopes that
the old reliance of China upon Great Britain will now be abandon-
of in favor of Japan. Japan thinks that if she can break down
British influence in South China she can break it down elsewhere.
And the British Government and people may well ponder what the
answer will be.
What I want to know is, "What will be Great Britain's Far
Eastern policy in view of this latest nove on Japan's part?"
will Great Britain view the occupation of Canton in the
anme 11ght no she viewed the occupation of Unnchuria, North China
and Shargha1?
Moreover, what will Grant Britain do in view of this latest
development?
I would like to have n definite answer to this question.
In view of the fact that Great Britain's interests and
prestige are threatened, will she quietly accept this fait
accompli or will she demonstrate in no unmistakable terms her
Deal intentions unequivocally, to safeguard her sconomic and
political interests in the Far East, and, above all, to follow
her historical policy of unholding high principles to which she
has committed herself, or will are abandon these principles and
sacrifice her standing?
Ohina has been fighting lone-handedly for the past sixteen
months. We have looked to Great Britain and hoped for help,
but up to the present we have received nothing tangible. We
appreciate that we secured munitions through Hong Kong, and upon
R mutually advantageous basis, but that avenue has now been closed.
Regraded Uclassified
-20
07
As long 88 South China was not attacked, we made allowances
for Britain's hesitancy to extend practical aid to us, but now
that Japan has out off British trade there 10 no reason why
Britain should henitate to extend help to us.
As time gone on, our people and the Chinese army will
become more and more disappointed in view of the absolute laok of
concrete and tangible evidence of British support. And that is
something which the Chinese doverment will be constrained to
take into account.
I would, therefore, like to know whether Great Britain will
adhere to her obligations as a member of the League of Nations,
live NO to her historical and traditional standards, and extend
economic or some other practical help to China?
I would like to have this answered in a definite "Yes" or
"No".
For the past sixteen months we have been hearing n lot of
discussion about loans, and we have been nut off from time to
time with excuses that loans were impossible because of Parliamen-
tary complications. But the whole world witnessed the granting
almost overnight to Czechoslovnkia of & 10an similar in nature to
that asked for by China.
Now the moment has come when we must have definite knowledge
of Great Britain's intentions.
If Great Aritain turns her back alike upon us and her princi-
plas, then I shall never bring up this question again. Nor shall
I ever mention anything concerning Great Britain's Far Eastern
policy. Nor shall I consult Great Britain AS to China's future
policy or attitude, or anything concerning the Far East.
I can hardly believe, however, that an Empire which produced
such statesmen AS Disraeli and Gladstone could fail to see the
significance of the repercussions of the occupation of Canton, and
the inactivity of Great Britain upon her future in the whole of
Asia.
This is the life and death turning point in British Far
Eastern policy. Whether Britain extends aid to us or not - the
British Government should realize that Ohina today 1s unified AS
never before, and that W are determined to carry on prolonged
resistance. Japan is unquestionably striving to have peace, on
her from Asiatic affairs, Japan would be willing to concede the
terme, however, not beneficial to Great Britain, and thus excluding
gains she has acquired since hostilities began. If that question
comes up, what 1s China's answer going to be?
If Japan wins the war, the old and outstanding interests of
Great Britain in China will be finished.
We must know what Great Britain's answer in to be, because
upon it depends the future policy of the Chinese Government. There
are several roads open to us.
One thing that must be kept in view is that Japan, having
occupied Canton, will probably occupy Hainan Island. what much
& move will protend to Hong Kong onn be left to the imagination.
In view of the importance of the questions raised in this
conversation, will you kindly communioste immediately with the
British Government and let BE have n reply?
Regraded Uclassified
28
Wovember 21, 1938
My dear Mr. President:
Sunday night, at my house, I had a most
interesting discussion with Dr. Isaiah Bowman on
colonies.
Dr. Bowman secured for me the information
contained in the attached telegram. You will
note that the only country in Central America which
offers possibilities for colonization is Costa Rica.
I am securing maps of Costa Rica and as soon as I
have them I will send them down to you. I would
also like to remind you that it 1s Costa Rica that
Mr. Zemurray, of the United Fruit, informed you
(and Jeff Coolidge informed me) 18 in need of
$5,000,000 to out them on their feet financially.
Dr. Borman left with me a map which he has
prepared, at your request, covering the countries
south of the Rio Orinoco. I am forwarding it to
you.
He is also going to give me a memorandum on
possible locations for colonization in South Amerion.
At my suggestion, he has retained an assistant
who is an expert on the colonies in South Africa and
as soon as he has A report I will advise you.
Have you any suggestions as to how we should
proceed in regard to Costa Ricai
Yours sincerely,
The President,
Warm Springs, Georgia.
Regraded Uclassified
89
November 21, 1938
My dear Mr. President:
Sunday night, at my house, I had & most
interesting discussion with Dr. Isaiah Bowman on
colonies.
Dr. Bowman secured for me the information
contained in the attached telegram. You will
note that the only country in Central America which
offers possibilities for colonization 1a Costa Rica.
I am securing maps of Costa Rion and as soon as I
have then I will send them down to you. I would
also like to remind you that it is Costa Rion that
Mr. Zemurray, of the United Fruit, informed you
(and Jeff Coolidge informed me) 18 in need of
$5,000,000 to put them on their feet financially.
Dr. Bowman left with me & map which he has
prepared, at your request, covering the countries
south of the Rio Orinooo. I AM forwarding it to
you.
He in also going to give me a memorandus on
possible locations for colonization in South America.
At my suggestion, he has retained an assistant
who is an expert on the colonies in South Africa and
as soon as he has a report I will advise you.
Have you any suggestions as to how we should
proceed in regard to Costa Rion?
Yours sincerely,
The President,
Warm Springs, Georgia.
Regraded Uclassified
70
November 21, 1938
4y dear Mr. President:
Sunday night, at my house, I had a most
interesting discussion with Dr. Isaiah Bowman on
colonies.
Dr. Bowman secured for me the information
contained in the attached telegram. You will
note that the only country in Central America which
offers possibilities for colonization is Costs Rica.
I am securing maps of Costa Rioa and as soon as I
have them I will send them down to you. I would
also like to remind you that it 18 Costa Rica that
Mr. Zemurray, of the United Fruit, informed you
(and Jeff Coolidge informed me) 18 in need of
$5,000,000 to put them on their feet financially.
Dr. Bowman left with me a map which he has
prepared, at your request, covering the countries
south of the Rio Orinooo. I Am forwarding it to
you.
He is also going to give me a memorandum on
possible locations for colonization in South America.
At my suggestion, he has retained an assistant
who 1s an excert on the colonies in South Africa and
as soon ns he has a report I will advise you.
Have you any suggestions as to how we should
proceed in regard to Costs Rion?
Yours sincerely,
The President,
Warm Springs, Georgia.
Regraded Uclassified
71
COPY
WESTERN UNION
CA14 811 NL COLLECT 7 EXTRA 1/141 - SANTAMONICA CALIF 19
DR ISAIAH BOWMAN
OAK PL BALTO
THE FOLLOWING STATEMENT PREPARED AFTER CONSULTATION WITH MY
COLLEAGUES DOCTORS FIT2GIBON POLITICAL SCIENCE AND BUSSEY
HISTORY SOTH OF WHOM SPENT RECENT MONTHS IN CENTRAL AMERICA.
THIS SUMMARIZES OPPORTUNITIES FOR AGRICULTURAL COLONIES.
INDUSTRIAL AND COMMERCIAL OPENINGS FOR LIMITED NUMBER MIGHT
BE EXPECTED IN TIME. WAGES FOR AGRICULTURAL AND INDUSTRIAL
LABOR EXTREMELY LOW IN ALL SECTIONS. ROAD SYSTEMS BRING
ACTIVELY EXTENDED IN MOST COUNTRIES AND AIR SERVICE MAKES
MANY REGIONS NEWLY ACCESSABLE.
COSTARICA OFFERE BEST POSSIBILITIES FOR several
10,000 GROUPS. COUNTRY DEMOCRATIC AND SYMPATHETIC TOWARD
IMMIGRATION. UPPER HIR OF MESETA CENTRAL AND UPPER SLOPES
BEYOND THAT RIM CONTAIN FERTILE VOLCANIC SOIL WELL DRAINED
BABILY CLEARED AT ELEVAT ION or 3,000 to 6,000 FEET. WHILE
LOWER ELEVATIONS OF MESETA ARE THICKLY PEOPLED HIGHER
ELEVATIONS ARE SPARSELY INHABITED. DISTANCE TO MARKET NOT
GREAT OVER FAIR ROADS RAPIDLY BEING IMPROVED. CLIMATE
EXCELLENT. WESTWARD SLOPE TOWARD NICARAGUA ALSO SPARSELY
Regraded Uclassified
72
- 2 -
CALS 2/160
INHABITED AND ABOVE 3,000 FEET OFFERS POSSIBILITINS
PARTICULARLY ABOUT HEADWATERS OF SANCARLOS AND ON PACIFICWARD
SLOPE. PENINSULA OF NICOYA ALSO OFFERS POSSIBILITIES IS DOES
MATHER ROUGH MOUNTAIN TERRAIN OF TALAMANCA CORDILLERA. MOST
OF REGIONS MENT IONED ARE SUITABLE FOR CEREALS BEANS AND FRUITS
FOR SUBSISTANCE AGRICULTURE AND COFFEE FOR EXPORT. THIS
COUNTRY PARTICULARLY ATTRACTIVE BECAUSE POPULATION IS MOSTLY
BRITE.
HONDURAS. MOST OF AIGHLAND 3,000 TO 5,000 PEET
ELEVATION CONTAINS SPARSE POPULATION. THE SOIL IS GOOD THE
RAIN VARIES FROM 30 - 50 INCHES RESULTING IN A GOOD GROWTH
OF VEGETATION ND EXCELLENT FORESTS OVER MUCH OF THE AREA.
LONG DHY SEASON FROM NOVEMBER TO APRIL OFFERS A PROBLEM AND
HAE HELPED TO 5 A&P AGRICULTURAL DEVELOPMENT DOWN BUT SHOULD
NOT PREVENT EXTENSIVE PROFITABLE GRAIN FARMING IF ROADE ARE
CONSTRUCTED AB outLets TO MARKET THOUGH INTENSIVE AGRICULTURE
MAY NEVER BE POSSIBLE. A MUCH LARGER ANIMAL POPULATION
SHOULD DE POSSIBLE ALSO WITH Intelligent MEASURES AGAINST
TICKS WHICH NOW CONSTITUTE A SERIOUS HANDICAP.
Regraded Uclassified
73
- 3 -
CA14 3/160
MINING TOO OFFERS GOOD POSSIBILITIES KNOWN DEPOSITS OF GOLD
AND SILVER BEING NUMEROUS. These AREAS ARE SUITABLE FOR
PIONEER settlements AND WITH FURTHER EXTENSION OF ROADS AND
RAILROADS SHOULD SUPPORT MANY 10,000 GROUPS. PINE LUMBERING
INDUSTRY ALSO PROMISING. ATTITUDE OF GOVERNMENT TOWARD
IMMIGRATION DOUBTFUL.
NICARAGUA. OPLANDS FROM MATACALPA TO OPPER SEGOVIA
REGION SPARSELY INHABITED BUT CAPABLE OF SUSTAINING TWO OR
THREE 10,000 GROUPS BY SUBSISTANCE AGRICULTURE, TROPICAL AND
SUBTROPICAL HORTICULTOME, AND COFFEE PRODUCING FOR EXPORT
IF MARKET EXISTS. ROADS FROM MANAGUA AND TO ATLANTIC COAST
FIVERS HEING IMPROVED.
GUATEMALA. TWO REGIONE OFFER GOOD PROSPECTS.
HIGHLANDS OF ALTA VERA PAZ 3,000 to 4,000 FEET elevation
HAVE HEALTHFUL CLIMATE, RICH SOIL, ABUNDANT VEGETATION;
HEAVY BAINS, BUT WITH GOOD DRAINAGS DUE TO UNDERLYING
LIMESTONE. AOAD SYSTEM UNDER CONSTRUCTION; RAILWAY AND RIVER
ACTLET TO LIVINGSTON; AIR LINE TO GUATEMALA CITY. ANOTHER
BEGION IS BIGHER PART OF WESTERN END PACIFIC COASTAL PLAIN
MADI AND WEST FROM COATEPEQUE AND ALONG FOOT OF VOLCANIC RANGE
Regraded Uclassified
74
4
CA14 4/178
EASTWARD FROM THERE. THIS IS PIEDMONT SLOPE ABOUT 1,000 FEET
RIGHER THAN HEIGHBORING UNITED PRCIT COMPANY BANANA REGION,
WELL DRAINED VOLCANIC SOIL SUFFICIENT RAINFALL AND EXCELLENT
WATER SUPPLY. SOME DANGER OF MALARIA. GOOD FOR CATTLE, SUGAR
CANE, CORN, BEANS, TROPICAL AND SUBTROPICAL FRUITS. ROADS
LK.D TO GUATEMALAN SIGHLANDS AND RAILROADS TO PORTS OF 0C0S
AND CHAMPERICO. PRESUMABLY THE PETEN REGION THOUGH ONCE
OCCUPIED BY POPULOUS MAYAN CITIES IS IMPOSSIBLE NOW UNLESS
all EXTENSIVE PROGRAM OF MALARIA RADICATION COULD BE CARRIED
OUT. THE TWO RECOMMENDED GUATEMALAN REGIONS ALREADY CONTAIN
MANY GERMAN FINCAS, MAINLY COFFEE FARMS, ALSO SOME INFLUENTIAL
ENGLISH AND AMERICAN FARM OWNERS. SUBTROPICAL HORTICULTURE
AS YET UNEXPLOITED BUT PROMISING. GOVERNMENT LIKELY TO FAVOR
IMMIGRANTS, BUT SOME FOREIGN LAND OWNERS LIKELY TO OPPOSE.
IN BOTH RECIONS IMMIGRANTS MIGHT BETTER BE SCATTERED THAN
CONCENTRATED IN COMPACT COLONIES. AVAILABLE LANDS OCCUR IN
LIMITED TRACTS.
BRITISH HONDURAS. (BELICE) INTERIOR HILL COUNTRY
OF THE SOUTH WOULD SEEM TO OFFER OFFER PLACE FOR MANY SETTLERS IN
COUNTRY BETTER THAN IN BELICE WHERE OVER 1,000 WHITES ALREADY
LIVE. THIS WOULD STRENGTHEN BRITAIN'S HOLD ON THE TERRITORY
Regraded Uclassified
75
- 5 -
CA14 5/172
PANAMA. THE PACIFIC SLOPE WESTWARD FROM THE CANAD TO THE
COSTARICA BORDER WOULD SEEM TO OFFER ROOM AND SUITABLE
CONDITIONS FOR SEVERAL 10,000 GROUPS. ISOLATED VALLEYS
WITHIN THE CHIRIQUI MOUNTAINS ALSO OFFER LIMITED SITES AT
slevations OF 1,000 to 2,000 FEET. THE COASTAL PLAINS ARE
SPARSELY INHABITED AND THE FOOTHILLS LARGELY UNDEVELOPED.
THE REGION IS DRY ENOUGH FOR healthful LIVING, BUT WITH
SUFFICIENT RAIN FOR PASTURE, CEREAL CULTIVATION AND FRUIT
GROWING. ACCESS TO PORTS IS EASY AND A ROAD FROM THE CANAL
REACHES TO BEYOND DAVID.
SALVADOR. THIS COUNTRY PROBABLY OFFERS NO
POSSIBILITING DUE TO DENSE POPULATION AND INTENSIVE
DEVELOPMENT. GENERAL CONSIDERATIONS.
HUMID LOWLANDS HAVE NOT BEEN SUGGESTED BECAUSE OF
UNSUITABLE REALTH CONDITIONS. EACH OF THE SEVERAL COUNTRIES
COULD PROBABLY ABSORB A LIMITED NUMBER OF INDIVIDUALS
PARTICULARLY OF THE Professional CLASSES AND THOSE
FINANCIALLY ABLE AND PREPARED TO UNDERTAKE INDUSTRIAL OR
:orticultural INTERPRISES. WE WOULD STRESS SUBTROPICAL
HORTICULTURE FOR COLONY ACTIVITY, AB YET UNTRIED ON LARGE
SCALE BUT everythere SUCCESSFUL ON A SMALL SCALE.
GEORGE M MCBRIDE 710 VIA DE LA PAZ
PACIFIC PALISADES CALIF.
Regraded Uclassified
76
COPY
WESTERN UNION
CA14 811 NL COLLECT 7 EXTRA 1/141 - SANTAMONICA CALIF 19
DR ISAIAH BOWMAN
OAK PL BALTO
THE FOLLOWING STATEMENT PREPARED AFTER CONSULTATION WITH MY
COLLEAGUES DOCTORS FIT2GIBON POLITICAL SCIENCE AND HUSSEY
HISTORY BOTH OF WHOM SPENT RECENT MONTHS IN CENTRAL AMERICA.
THIS SUMMARIZES OPPORTUNITIES FOR AGRICULTURAL COLONIES.
INDUSTRIAL AND COMMERCIAL OPENINGS FOR LIMITED NUMBER MIGHT
BE EXPECTED IN TIME. WAGES FOR AGRICULTURAL AND INDUSTRIAL
LABOR EXTREMELY LOW IN ALL SECTIONS. ROAD SYSTEMS BEING
ACTIVELY EXTENDED IN MOST COUNTRIES AND AIR SERVICE MAKES
MANY REGIONS NEWLY ACCESSABLE.
COSTARICA OFFERS BEST POSSIBILITIES FOR SEVERAL
10,000 GROUPS. COUNTRY DEMOCRATIC AND SYMPATHETIC TOWARD
IMMIGRATION. UPPER RIM OF MESETA CENTRAL AND UPPER SLOPES
BEYOND THAT RIM CONTAIN FERTILE VOLCAN IC SOIL WELL DRAINED
BASILY CLEARED AT ELEVAT ION OF 3,000 to 6,000 FEET. WHILE
LOWER ELEVATIONS OF MESETA ARE THICKLY PEOPLED HIGHER
ELEVATIONS ARE SPARSELY INHABITED. DISTANCE TO MARKET NOT
GREAT OVER FAIR ROADS RAPIDLY BEING IMPROVED. CLIMATE
EXCELLENT. WESTWARD SLOPE TOWARD NICARAGUA ALSO SPARSELY
Regraded Uclassified
77
- 2 -
CAL4 2/160
INHABITED AND ABOVE 3,000 FEET OFFERS POSSIBILITIES
PARTICULARLY ABOUT HEADWATERS OF SANCARLOS AND ON PACIFICWARD
SLOPE. PENINSULA OF NICOYA ALSO OFFERS POSSIBILITIES AS DOES
RATHER ROUGH MOUNTAIN TERRAIN OF TALAMANCA CORDILLERA. MOST
OF REGIONS MENT IONED ARE SUITABLE FOR CEREALS BEANS AND FRUITS
FOR SUBSISTANCE AGRICULTURE AND COFFEE FOR EXPORT. THIS
COUNTRY PARTICULARLY ATTRACTIVE BECAUSE POPULATION IS MOSTLY
WHITE.
HONDURAS. MOST OF HIGHLAND 3,000 TO 5,000 FEET
ELEVATION CONTAINS SPARSE POPULATION. THE SOIL IS GOOD THE
RAIN VARIES FROM 30 - 50 INCHES RESULTING IN A GOOD GROWTH
OF VEGETATION AND EXCELLENT FORESTS OVER MUCH OF THE AREA.
LONG DRY SEASON FROM NOVEMBER TO APRIL OFFERS & PROBLEM AND
HAE HELPED TO KEEP AGRICULTURAL DEVELOPMENT DOWN BUT SHOULD
NOT PREVENT EXTENSIVE PROFITABLE GRAIN FARMING IF HOADS ARE
CONSTRUCTED AE outlets TO MARKET THOUGH INTENSIVE AGRICULTURE
MAY NEVER BE POSSIBLE. A MUCH LARGER ANIMAL POPULATION
SHOULD BE POSSIBLE ALSO WITH INTELLIGENT MEASURES AGAINST
TICKS WHICH NOW CONSTITUTE A SERIOUS HANDICAP.
Regraded Uclassified
78
- 3 -
CA14 3/160
MINING TOO OFFERS GOOD possibilities KNOWN DEPOSITS OF GOLD
AND SILVER BEING NUMEROUS. THESE AREAS ARE SUITABLE FOR
PIONEER SETTLEMENTS AND WITH FURTHER EXTENSION OF ROADS AND
RAILROADS SHOULD SUPPORT MANY 10,000 GROUPS. PINE LUMBERING
INDUSTRY ALSO PROMISING. ATTITUDE OF GOVERNMENT TOWARD
IMMIGRATION DOUBTFUL.
NICARAGUA. UPLANDS FROM MATAGALPA TO UPPER SEGOVIA
REGION SPARSELY INHABITED BUT CAPABLE OF SUSTAINING TWO OR
THREE 10,000 GROUPS BY SUBSISTANCE AGRICULTURE, TROPICAL AND
SUBTROPICAL HORTICULTURE, AND COFFEE PRODUCING FOR EXPORT
IF MARKET EXISTS. ROADS FROM MANAGUA AND TO ATLANT IC COAST
AIVERS BEING IMPROVED.
GUATEMALA. TWO REGIONS OFFER COOD PROSPECTS.
HIGHLANDS OF ALTA VERA PAZ 3,000 to 4,000 FEET ELEVATION
HAVE HEALTHFUL CLIMATE, RICH SOIL, ABUNDANT VEGETATION;
HEAVY RAINS, BUT WITH GOOD DRAINAGE DUE TO UNDERLYING
LIMESTONE. ROAD SYSTEM UNDER CONSTRUCTION; RAILWAY AND RIVER
OUTLET TO LIVINGSTON; AIR LINE TO GUATEMALA CITY. ANOTHER
BEGION IS HIGHER PART OF WESTERN END PACIFIC COASTAL PLAIN
BAST AND WEST FROM COATEPEQUE AND ALONG FOOT OF VOLCANIC RANGE
Regraded Uclassified
79
- 4 -
CA14 4/178
EASTWARD FROM THERE. THIS IS PIEDMONT SLOPE ABOUT 1,000 FRET
HIGHER THAN NEIGHBORING UNITED FRUIT COMPANY BANANA REGION,
WELL DRAINED VOLCANIC SOIL SUFFICIENT RAINFALL AND EXCELLENT
WATER SUPPLY. SOME DANGER OF MALARIA. GOOD FOR CATTLE, SUGAR
CANE, CORN, beans, TROPICAL AND SUBTROPICAL FRUITS. ROADS
Land TO GUATEMALAN BIGHLANDS AND RAILROADS TO PORTS OF OCOS
AND CHAMPERICO. PRESUMABLY THE PETEN REGION THOUGH ONCE
OCCUPIED BY POPULOUS MAXAN CITIES 18 IMPOSSIBLE NOW UNLESS
AN XT NSIVE PROGRAM OF MALARIA BRADICATION COULD B3 CARRIED
OUT. THE TWO RECOMMENDED GUATEMALAN REGIONS ALREADY CONTAIN
MANY GERMAN FINCAS, MAINLY COFFEE FARMS, ALSO SOME INFLUENTIAL
ENGLISH AND AMERICAN FARM OWNERS. SUBTROPICAL HORTICULTURE
AS YET UNEXPLOITED BUT PROMISING. government bikely TO FAVOR
IMMIGRANTS, BUT SOME FOREIGN LAND OWNERS LIKELY TO OPPOSE.
IN BOTH (EG IONS IMMIGRANTS MIGHT BETTER BE SCATTEMED THAN
CONCENTRATED IN COMPACT COLONIES. AVAILABLE LANDS OCCUR IN
LIMITED TRACTS.
BRITISH HONDURAS. (BELICE) INTERIOR HILL COUNTRY
OF THE SOUTH WOULD SEEM TO OFFER PLACE FOR MANY SETTLEPS IN
COUNTRY BETTER THAN IN BELICE WHERE OVER 1,000 WHITES ALREADY
LIVE. THIS WOULD STRENGTHEN BRITAIN'S HOLD ON THE TERRITORY
Regraded Uclassified
80
- 5 -
CA14 5/172
PANAMA. THE PACIFIC SLOPE WESTWARD FROM THE CANAL TO THE
COSTARICA BORDER WOULD SEEM TO OFFER ROOM AND SUITABLE
CONDITIONS FOR SEVERAL 10,000 GROUPS. ISOLATED VALLEYS
WITHIN THE CHIRIQUI MOUNTAINS ALSO OFFER LIMITED SITES AT
ELEVATIONS OF 1,000 to 2,000 FEET. THE COASTAL PLAINS ARE
SPARSELY INHABITED AND THE FOOTHILLS LARGELY UNDEVELOPED.
THE REGION IS DRY ENOUGH FOR HEALTHFUL LIVING, BUT WITH
SUFFICIENT RAIN FOR PASTURE, CEREAL CULTIVATION AND FRUIT
GROWING. ACCESS TO PORTS IS EASY AND A ROAD FROM THE CANAL
REACHES TO BEYOND DAVID.
SALVADOR. THIS COUNTRY PROBABLY OFFERS NO
POSSIBILITIES DUE TO DENSE POPULATION AND INTENSIVE
development. GENERAL CONSIDERATIONS.
HUMID LOWLANDS have NOT BEEN SUGGESTED BECAUSE OF
UNSUITABLE HEALTH CONDITIONS. EACH OF THE SEVERAL COUNTRIES
COULD PROBABLY ABSORB A LIMITED NUMBER OF INDIVIDUALS
PARTICULARLY OF THE PROFESSIONAL CLASSES AND THOSE
FINANCIALLY ABLE AND PREPARED TO UNDERTAKE INDUSTRIAL OR
HORTICULTURAL ENTERPRISES. WE WOULD STRESS SUBTROPICAL
HORTICULTURE FOR COLONY ACTIVITY, AS YET UNTRIED ON LARGE
SCALE BUT everywhere SUCCESSFUL ON A SMALL SCALE.
GEORGE M MCBRIDE 710 VIA DE LA PAZ
PACIFIC PALISADES CALIF.
Regraded Uclassified
81
COPY
WESTERN UNION
CA14 811 NL COLLECT 7 EXTRA 1/141 - SANTAMON ICA CALIF 19
DR ISAIAH BOWMAN
OAK PL BALTO
THE FOLLOWING STATEMENT PREPARED AFTER CONSULTATION WITH MY
COLLEAGUES DOCTORS FIT2GIBON POLITICAL SCIENCE AND HUSSEY
HISTORY BOTH OF WHOM SPENT RECENT MONTHS IN CENTRAL AMERICA.
T IS SUMMARIZES OPPORTUNITIES FOR AGRICULTURAL COLONIES,
INDUSTRIAL AND COMMERCIAL OPENINGS FOR LIMITED NUMBER MIGHT
BX EXPECTED IN TIME. WAGES FOR AGRICULTURAL AND INDUSTRIAL
LABOR EXTREMELY LOV IN ALL SECTIONS. HOAD SYSTEMS BEING
ACTIVELY EXTENDED IS MOST COUNTRIES AND AIR SERVICE MAKES
MANY REGIONS NEWLY ACCESSABLE.
COSTARICA OFFERS BEST POSSIBILITIES FOR SEVERAL
10,000 GROUPS. COUNTRY DEMOCRATIC AND SYMPATHETIC TOWARD
IMMIGRATION. UPPER RIM OF MESETA CENTRAL AND UPPER SLOPES
BEYOND THAT RIM CONTAIN FERTILE VOLCANIC SOIL WELL DRAINED
BASILY CLEARED AT elevat ion OF 3,000 to 6,000 FEET. WHILE
LOTER elevations OF MESETA ARE THICKLY PEOPLED BIGHER
ELEVATIONS ARE SPARSELY INHABITED. DISTANCE TO MARKET NOT
GREAT OVER FAIR ROADS RAPIDLY BEING IMPROVED. CLIMATE
EXCELLENT. WESTWARD SLOPE TOWARD MICARAGUA ALSO SPARSELY
Regraded Uclassified
82
- 2 -
CA14 2/160
INHABITED AND ABOVE 3,000 FEET OFFERS POSSIBILITIES
PARTICULARLY ABOUT HEADWATERS OF SANCARLOS AND ON PACIFICWARD
SLOPE. PENINSULA OF NICOYA ALSO OFFERS POSSIBILITIES AS Does
RATHER ROUGH MOUNTAIN TERRAIN OF TALAMANCA CORDILLERA. MOST
OF REGIONS MENT IONED ARE SUITABLE FOR CEREALS BEANS AND FRUITS
FOR SUBSISTANCE AGRICULTURE AND COFFEE FOR EXPORT. THIS
COUNTRY PARTICULARLY ATTRACTIVE BECAUSE POPULATION IS MOSTLY
WEITE.
HONDURAS. MOST OF SIGHLAND 3,000 TO 5,000 FEET
ELEVATION CONTAINS SPAREE POPULATION. THE SOIL IS GOOD THE
RAIN VARIES FROM 30 - - 50 INCHES RESULTING IN A GOOD GROWTH
OF VEGETATION ND EXCELLENT FORESTS OVER MUCH OF THE AREA.
LONG DRY SEASON FROM NOVEMBER TO APRIL OFFERS h PROBLEM AND
H.S HELPED TO K EP AGRICULTURAL DEVELOPMENT DOWN BUT SHOULD
NOT PREVENT EXTENSIVE PROFITABLE GRAIN FARMING IF ROADS ARE
CONSTRUCTED AS OUTLETS TO MARKET THOUGH INTENSIVE AGRICULTURE
MAY NEVER BE POSSIBLE. A MUCH LARGER ANIMAL POPULATION
SHOULD BE POSSIBLE ALSO WITH INTELLIGENT ME/SURES AGAINST
TICKS WHICH NOW CONSTITUTE A SERIOUS HANDICAP.
Regraded Uclassified
83
- 3 -
CA14 3/160
MINING TOO OFFERS GOOD possibilities KNOWN DEPOSITS OF GOLD
AND SILVER BEING numerous. THESE AREAS ARE SUITABLE FOR
PIONEER SETTLEMENTS AND WITH FURTHER EXTENSION OF ROADS AND
RAILROADS SHOULD SUPPORT MANY 10,000 GROUPS. PINE LUMBERING
INDUSTRY ALSO PROMISING. ATTITUDE OF GOVERNMENT TOWARD
IMMIGRATION DOUBTFUL.
NICARAGUA. UPLANDS FROM MATAGALPA TO UPPER SEGOVIA
REGION SPARSELY INHABITED BUT CAPABLE OF SUSTAINING TWO OR
THREE 10,000 CROUPS BY SUBSISTANCE AGRICULTURE, TROPICAL AND
SUBTROP ICAL HORTICULTURE, AND COFFEE PRODUCING FOR EXPORT
IF MARKET EXISTS. ROADS FROM MANAGUA AND TO ATLANT IC COAST
RIVERS BEING IMPROVED.
guatemala. TWO REGIONS OFFER GOOD PROSPECTS.
BIGHLANDS OF ALTA vera PAZ 3,000 to 4,000 FEET ELEVATION
date HEALTHFUL CLIMATE, RICH SOIL, ABUNDANT VEGETATION;
HEAVY RAINS, BUT WITH GOOD DHAINAGE DUE TO UNDERLYING
LIMESTONE. ROAD SYSTEM UNDER CONSTRUCTION; RAILWAY AND RIVER
OUTLET TO LIVINGSTON; AIR LINE TO GUATEMALA CITY. ANOTHER
BEGION IS HIGHER PART OF WESTERN END PACIFIC COASTAL PLAIN
EAST AND WEST FROM COATEPEQUE AND ALONG FOOT OF VOLCANIC RANGE
Regraded Uclassified
84
- 4
CA14 4/178
EASTWARD FROM THERE. THIS IS PIEDMONT SLOPE ABOUT 1,000 FEET
HIGHER THAN NEIGHBORING UNITED FRUIT COMPANY BANANA REGION,
WELL DRAINED VOLCANIC SOIL SUFFICIENT RAINFALL AND EXCELLENT
WATER SUPPLY. SOME DANGER OF MALARIA. GOOD FOR CATTLE, SUGAR
CANE, CORN, BEANS, TROPICAL AND SUBTROPICAL FRUITS. ROADS
LEAD TO GUATEMALAN HIGHLANDS AND RAILROADS TO PORTS OF 0C08
AND CHAMPERICO. PRESUMABLY THE PETIN REGION THOUGH ONCE
OCCUPIED BY POPULOUS MAYAN CITIES IS IMPOSSIBLE NOV UNLESS
in XT NSIVE PROGRAM OF NALARIA BRADIC TION COULD BE CARRIED
OUT. THE TWO RECOMMENDED GUATEMALAN REGIONS ALREADY CONTAIN
MANY GERMAN FINCAS, MAINLY COFFEE FARMS, ALSO SOME INFLUENTIAL
ENGLISH AND AMERICAN FARM OWNERS. SUBTROPICAL HORTICULTURE
AS YET JNEXPLOITED BUT PROMISING. government likely TO FAVOR
IMMIGRANTS, BUT SOME FOREIGN LAND OWNERS LIKELY TO OPPOSE.
IN BOTH REGIONS IMMIGRANTS MIGHT BETTER BE SCATTERED THAN
CONCENTRATED IN COMPACT COLONIES. AVAILABLE LANDS OCCUR IN
LIMITED TRACTS.
BRITISH HONDURAS. (BELICE) INTERIOR HILL COUNTRY
OF THE SOUTH BOULD SEEM TO OFFER PLACE FOR MANY SETTLERS IN
COUNTRY BETTER THAN IN BELICE WHERE OVER 1,000 WHITES ALREADY
LIVE. THIS WOULD STRENGTHEN BRITAIN'S HOLD ON THE TERRITORY
Regraded Uclassified
85
- 5 -
CA14 5/172
PANAMA. THE PACIFIC SLOPE WESTWARD FROM THE CANAL TO THE
COSTARICA BORDER WOULD SEEM TO OFFER ROOM AND SUITABLE
CONDITIONS FOR SEVERAL 10,000 GROUPS. ISOLATED VALLEYS
WITHIN THE CHIRIQUI MOUNTAINS ALSO OFFER LIMITED SITES AT
ELEVATIONS OF 1,000 to 2,000 FEET. THE COASTAL PLAINS ARE
SPARSELY INHABITED AND THE FOOTHILLS LARGELY UNDEVELOPED.
THE REGION IS DRY ENOUGH FOR HEALTHFUL LIVING, BUT WITH
SUFFICIENT RAIN FOR PASTURE, CEREAL CULTIVATION AND FRUIT
GROWING. ACCESS TO PORTS IS EASY AND A ROAD FROM THE CANAL
REACHES TO BEYOND DAVID.
SALVADOR. THIS COUNTRY PROBABLY OFFERS NO
POSSIBILITIES DUE TO DENSE POPULATION AND INTENSIVE
DEVELOPMENT. GENERAL CONSIDERATIONS.
HUMID LOWLANDS HAVE NOT BEEN SUGGESTED BECAUSE OF
UNSUITABLE HEALTH CONDITIONS. EACH OF THE SEVERAL COUNTRIES
COULD PROBABLY ABSORB A LIMITED NUMBER OF INDIVIDUALS
PARTICULARLY OF THE PROFESSIONAL CLASSES AND THOSE
FINANCIALLY ABLE AND PREPARED TO UNDERTAKE INDUSTRIAL OR
HORTICULTURAL INTERPRISES. WE WOULD STRESS SUBTROPICAL
HORTICULTURE FOR COLONY ACTIVITY, AS YET UNTRIED ON LARGE
SCALE BUT EVERYWHERE SUCCESSFUL ON A SMALL SCALE.
GEORGE M MCBRIDE 710 VIA DE LA PAZ
PACIFIC PALISADES CALIF.
Regraded Uclassified
86
TREASURY DEPARTMENT
INTER OFFICE COMMUNICATION
CONFIDENTIAL
DATE November 21, 1938
TO
Secretary Morgenthau
FROM
Mr. Haag IH
Subject: The Business Situation,
Week ending November 19, 1938.
AA
Conclusions
(1)
A marked improvement in new buying during October and
early November, which has built up backloge of unfilled
orders in the steel and automobile industries, will be an
important sustaining factor in production during the remainder
of the year. An FRB index of about 100 is expected for
November, as compared with 95 in October.
(2)
The sensational upturn in automobile output, which
dominates the current business rise, is backed up by consumer
buying in excess of current production and by low levels of
new- and used-car inventories. Production has apparently
not yet reached the level of basic demand, according to
tentative estimates for November, although it 1s approaching
that level.
(3)
Somewhat greater caution in appraising the early 1939
outlook 18 suggested by (a) an apparent further weakening
in the economic situation abroad, reflected in declines in
foreign currencies and heaviness in foreign security markets;
(b) declines in domestic stock prices to below the pre-
election lows; and (c) a closer approach of industrial pro-
duction to the estimated demand level, making it temporarily
more vulnerable to adverse influences.
Regraded Uclassified
87
Secretary Morgenthau - 2
Automobile excension speeds recovery
Looking at the business situation as of mid-November,
we find it dominated by B sensational recovery in the auto-
mobile industry. Automobile output has expanded in successive
weekly gains since the middle of September, this week'e out-
out of 96,700 units establishing the highest production rate
since August 1937. (See Chart 1.) The automobile industry has
been largely responsible for the rapid fall improvement in
steel output, and for increased production in several related
industries.
The foundation for the abrupt recovery was laid last
spring and summer, when the efforts of automobile companies
to work off heavy new-car inventories resulted in production
being depressed fer below the level of demand. By this cur-
tailment of production the companies were successful in
reducing not only new-car stocks, but stocks of used oars B.B
well, to normal or sub-normal levels in relation to sales,
thus creating B. situation where new-car demand would be re-
flected immediately in production.
The combination of decided changes in 1939 modele,
reduced prices, and increased business optimiem, has resulted
in an excellent sales response this fall. General Motors'
average daily sales to domestic consumers during the first
10-day period of November, 4,500 unite, equalled that for the
same period last year. A more satisfactory production out-
look than last year 18 indicated by the fact that General
Motors' output of 80,900 units during the first two weeks of
November compares with 91,500 units produced during the oor-
responding period B. year ago, while its stocks of new care
et the end of October, 72,800 units, compares with stocks of
151,600 units at the same date a year ago. The immediate
outlook for the industry, as indicated by data of this cor-
poration, appears B. healthy one.
Trade reports mention that backlogs of orders for
practically all automobile companies are at the best levels
in at least 12 months, and that retail deliveries in several
instances are being delayed 8.8 much 88 five weeks. This is
expected to hold production at relatively high levels during
the remainder of the year.
Regraded Uclassified
88
Secretary Morgenthau - 3
In the longer term outlook, the trend of consumer demand
will be the determining factor in production. A total domes-
tio production of about 385,000 units now seeme likely during
November, which would raise the FRB adjusted index of automo-
bile production to about 100. We have made a tentative estimate
of basic demand for November ( Shown on Chart 2), which rises
above the level of production, due to an expected further in-
orease in factory payrolls and an expected rise (on a seasonally
adjusted besis) in farm incomes. It will be noted in Chart 2
that on a few occesions in the past several years automobile
production has increased beyond the level of basic demand, but
that in each 0888 8 setback has shortly followed.
Steel output at higher rate
Steel ingot output increased this week to & new high for
the year at 62.6 per cent of capacity, representing a gain of
1.6 points over the previous week. New orders reported this
week by the U. 8. Steel Corporation were at the equivalent of
62 per cent of capacity, approximately the seme 8.8 the current
operating rate for the industry. This represents e decline
from last week's orders, which were at an equivalent rate of
71 per cent. With the support of large backlogs of unfilled
orders booked at recent low prices, nearly all mille, according
to the Iron Age, will be able to maintain their present
operating rates to the end of the year.
The rise in steel operations has been accompanied by a
general advance in steel scrap prices, which has raised the
Iron Age composite price to 8. new high for the year at $14.88
a ton. This compares with 8 price of $14.50 last week.
Some observers in the steel trade, 88 well 88 economic
analysts, express the opinion that eteel production currently
18 in excess of actual consumption, since mille have speeded
up production in order to complete delivery by the end of
December on recent orders for automobile steel taken at low
prices. Nith these orders the automobile companies have filled
at least B. part of their requirements for the firet quarter of
1939.
Tentative estimates of basic demand for steel (See Chart 3)
indicate that steel production during November has increased
to soproximately the level of demand. On several occasions in
the past few years production has exceeded the demand level, 8.6
estimated by this method, but in most of these cases 8 temporary
decline has almost immediately followed the excessive production.
An exception was in the fell of 1936 and the first half of 1937,
when an extended period of over-production was followed by a
prolonged recession in steel output,
Regraded Uclassified
89
Secretary Morgenthau -
Some possibility of a flattening out of steel operations
around present levels is suggested by declines scheduled for
next week in several districts. The Chicago district will start
the week at 57.4 per cent, down 3 points, and Youngstown at
61 per cent, off 2 points. The rate at Pittsburgh, less
affected by automobile demand, 18 estimated for next week at
48 per cent, down 3 points.
New orders in October sharply higher
Industrial activity during November is being supported
by an increase in new orders during October, which has raised
our monthly index (preliminary estimate) to the highest level
since August 1937. (See Chart 4.) Substential increases are
reported in orders for steel, automobiles, textiles, and
building materials.
Weekly data indicate that the rising trend of orders con-
tinued through the first week of November, but some setback
was recorded during the following week, probably because of
the election and Armistice Day holidays.
Bome uncertainty in outlook for early 1939
Indications suggesting some degree of caution in apprels-
ing the outlook for early 1939 have assumed more prominence
this week. They include (1) an apparent further weakening in
the foreign situation, ae reflected in declines in sterling
and franc exchange to below the closing quotations on the day
of the Munich lowe, and heaviness in foreign security prices;
(2) a decline in domestic stock prices to levels below the pre-
election lowe; and (3) indications that industrial production
has risen to about the level of demand, and has therefore become
temporarily more vulnerable to adverse influences.
Weakness in the foreign situation, affecting our domestic
economy at a number of points, appears the most important handi-
cap in the road to continued domestic recovery, A substential
decline in sterling and the franc this week, together with week-
ness in the leading stock markets abroad, which has carried
British rail stocks below the "war scare" levels established in
September, seems to indicate a deterioration in the foreign
situation as it effects American business.
To bring about & continued expansion of business activity
after production of the major consumer goods has reached the
current levels of demand, one of two things eeeme necessary:
(1) en expansion of production in the capital goods industries,
or of such consumer goods BB have not yet reached the demand
Regraded Uclassified
90
Secretary Morgenthau - 5
level, or (2) an increase in consumer demand. Both of these
will be affected by sentiment regarding the business outlook.
For this reason any developments in the foreign R1 tuation, in
prices, or in the stock market, which tend to affect sentiment
regarding the outlook for business, may be particularly Influ-
ential as business factors at the present levels of production.
From the foregoing point of view, the spearance of weak-
nese in domestic stock prices this week seems of some signifi-
cance. Price averages for all three major stock groups have
declined to slightly below the lowest levels of the past month.
In view of the increase in business optimism generated by the
post-election rise, the decline in stock prices to below the
ore-election lows may have some unfsvorable reaction on busi-
ness sentiment.
Summing up the business outlook, it appears that current
backlogs of unfilled orders, together with an expected con-
tinued good demand for automobiles, should tend strongly toward
susteining production during the remainder of the year. In
past experience, however, an uninterrupted business rise last-
1ng as long as six months has nearly alwaye been followed by a
period of hesitation or setback. Current business data provide
some indications of increasing uncertainty in the outlook. For
these reasons a temporary flattening out of the business trend
during the early part of 1939 would not be surprising, end would
be in line with normal tendencies in 8 general recovery trend.
to real maladjustments in the business structure that might
suggest 8 more pronounced recession have yet appeared.
Current business news
The New York Times index of business activity for the
week ended November 12 rose .7 point to B. new high for the
year at 90.3, exceeding for the first time the corresponding
1937 level. While the increase in automobile production dur-
ing the week was somewhat less than seasonal, thus lowering
the adjusted index, the steel production index showed E sub-
stentiel advance. Lumber production Wa.B sharoly lower, possibly
reflecting a greater influence of holidays than allowed for in
the seasonal adjustment. The electric power index geined 1
point, the index for "all other" carloadings was 2.3 points
lower, and other components showed minor changes. For the fol-
lowing week, the automobile index will be sharply higher and
the steel index moderately higher, these being the only two
components BO far available.
Regraded Uclassified
91
Secretary Morgenthau - 6
Federal Reserve Board statisticians unofficially look
for an FRB index of around 100 for November, on the basis of
industrial trends to date. This compares with a preliminary
index of 95 for October.
Department store sales last week made the most favorable
comparison with last year of any week in recent months. Total
sales of reporting stores were 1.3 below the sales in the
corresponding week of last year.
Regraded Uclassified
AUTOMOBILE PRODUCTION
CARS
THOUSANDS
U.S. and Canada
150
37
125
100
75
50
38
36
25
Ward's Est.
0
JAN.
MAR.
MAY
JULY
SEPT.
NOV.
S2 Chart 1
Office all the Secretary of the Treasury
Division of Research and Statistics
G-4-3
Regraded Uclassifi
Production Compared With Estimated "Basic Demand"
1923- '25 = 100
1932
1933
1934
1935
1936
1937
1938
1939
PER
PER
CENT
CENT
160
160
"BASIC DEMAND"
140
140
120
120
100
100
80
80
60
60
PRODUCTION
40
40
20
20
93
o
0
1932
1933
1934
1935
1936
1937
1938
1939
Chart 2
Office of the Secretary all the Treasury
Division of Research and Statistics
C - 239
Regraded Uclassified
BIEED
Production Compared with Estimated "Basic Demand"
1923 '23 - 100
1932
1933
1934
1935
1936
1937
1938
1939
PER
PER
CENT
CENT
160
160
140
140
120
120
"BASIC DEMAND"
100
100
80
BO
60
60
PRODUCTION
40
40
20
20
94
CO
0
0
1932
1933
1934
1935
1936
1937
1938
1939
Chart 3
Office of the Secretary of the Treasury
Division of Remark and Statistics
C - 238
Regraded Uclassified
NEW ORDERS AND FACTORY OUTPUT
1936
1937
1038
al
a
-
,
1
.
MI
M
5.
-
J
M
M
-
%
"
PER
,
1
11
PLA
CENT
cont
(new CADERS)
(PACTURY OUTPUT)
160
135
140
(25
Pactory Output
25 = 100
120
115
(00
105
80
95
New Orders, Monthly
1936-100
60
65
40
75
20
65
à - M. a % " M M M - 5 # of - M J 1 -
1936
1937
1938
New Orders Crouped by Industries
REIGHTED ACCORDING TO RELATIVE IMPORTANCE
1936
1937
1938
1936
1937
1938
PERCENTAGE
PERCENTAGE
TA
PERCENTABE
POINTS
IRDN AND STEEL
POINTS
TEXTILES
POINTS
65
ES
25
25
60
60
20
20
55
55
15
IS
50
30
10
10
45
45
5
5
40
40
0
0
1936
1937
1938
30
11
30
35
35
BUILDING WATERIALE
25
25
.
30
30
20
20
25
25
15
IS
20
20
10
10
15
15
5
5
10
10
o
o
1936
1937
1938
5
5
15
15
ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT
0
o
10
10
1936
1937
1938
25
25
AUTOMOBILES
5
5
20
20
0
0
1936
1937
1938
15
15
15
IS
PAPER AND PAPERBIARD
10
10
10
10
5
5
5
5
o
0
0
o
1936
1937
1938
1936
1937
1938
15
15
15
IS
11
WISCELLANEOUS
RAILROAD COVIRMENT
10
10
10
10
5
5
5
5
.
o
o
o
o
1937
1936
1937
1938
1936
1930
UT
to 12040
*INCLUDES WACHINE TOOLS, ASSICIATIONAL EQUIPMENT AND OTHERS
Office al the Secretary of the Transity
1-53-1
VIII
- - have
Regraded Ucl
96
TANDARD FORM No. 14A
TREASURY DEPARTMENT
APPROVED BY THE PRESIDENT
MARCH 10. 1925
WASHINGTON
TELEGRAM
CHARGE TREASURY DEPARTMENT. APPROPRIATION FOR
Official
OFFICIAL BUSINESS-GOVERNMENT RATES
(The appropriation from which payable must be stated on above line)
. a -
2-14117
COLONEL MARVIN H. McINTYRE,
WARM SPRINGS, GEORGIA.
November 21, 1938.
PLEASE DISREGARD MY TELEGRAM OF TODAY IN RE LIEUTENANT McKAY
HENRY MORGENTHAU JR.
Regraded Uclassified
87
ANDARD FORM No. 14A
APPROVED BY THE PRESIDENT
TREASURY DEPARTMENT
MARCH 10, 1926
WASHINGTON
TELEGRAM
CHARGE TREASURY DEPARTMENT, APPROPRIATION FOR
OFFICIAL BUSINESS-GOVERNMENT RATES
Official
(The appropriation from which payable must be stated - above Box)
COLONEL MARVIN H. McINTYRE,
M . I - -
FRIIT
NARM SPRINGS, GEORGIA
November 21, 1938.
LIBUTENANT McKAY COAST GUARD ARRIVES ATLANTA AIRPORT ELEVEN FIFTY FIVE
MONDAY NIGHT NOVEMBER TWENTY FIRST STOP I HAVE ARRANGED TO HAVE CAR
DRIVE HIM TO WARM SPRINGS AND WOULD APPRECIATE YOUR HAVING A ROOM
RESERVED FOR HIM STOP McKAY IS CARRYING A VERY CONFIDENTIAL AND
MOST IMPORTANT DOCUMENT WHICH I WOULD LIKE VERY MUCH FOR THE PRESIDENT
TO HAVE THE FIRST THING TUESDAY MORNING NOVEMBER TWENTY SECOND STOP
WOULD APPRECIATE YOUR COOPERATION
Henry Morgenthau, Jr.
Regraded Uclassified
TREASURY DEPARTMENT
Office of the Secretary
98
Secret Service Division
MEMORANDUM
November 21, 1938
To:
Mrs. Klotz
From:
Chief Wilson
AS requested by the Secretary we
have arranged to have an agent meet
Lieutenant McKey at the Atlanta Air-
port 11:55 tonight and convey him to
Warm Springs and bring him back to
Atlanta when his mission is performed.
Regraded Uclassifie
99
fee 11-19-38
November 21, 1938.
Dear Mr. Sproul:
For the Secretary : am acknowledging
your letter of November 19th, giving a
report as the corporate now security
financing for the past week. An usual,
Mr. Morgentheu use very much interested
in the comments contained in your letter.
Sincerely yours,
H. S. Klets,
Private Secretary.
Mr. Allan Sproul.
First Vice President,
Federal Receive Bank of How York,
New York, New York.
/ KOA 0 - / 500 BEGEIRED the
e
Ea
GRF/dbs
Regraded Uclassified
100
FEDERAL RESERVE BANK
OF NEW YORK
November 19, 1938.
Dear Mr. Secretary:
Corporate new security financing completed this week was confined
to one issue - $9,000,000 serial notes sold by Pan-American Petroleum Com-
pany, to a bank and an insurance company, to fund temporary loans used mainly
to pay for new oil tankers. Plane for an increased amount of business
borrowing are progressing, however. The Philadelphia Electric Company is to
obtain $30,000,000 of new capital through the sale of first mortgage 3 1/4 per
cent obligations to insurance companies; about $75,000,000 of utility company
new issues have been filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission under
the Holding Company or the Securities Act, principally for refunding, and
another $55,000,000 utility refunding operation is expected to be registered
in e. few days. The prospective issues, reported last week, will become eligible
to emerge from registration next week or the week following. Numerous other
transactions are reported to be in preparation.
Liquidation by investment trusts of utility company stocks, in order
to bring their holdings under 10 per cent of any one company's voting stock,
thus avoiding classification as . holding company under the Public Utility
Holding Company Act, will begin shortly to add to the volume of securities
offered. Common stock of the Worth American Company worth about $17,500,000 at
the current market has been registered for sale for the account of two invest-
ment trusts, and United Corporation has announced its more distant intention of
disposing of several large blocks of stock. In recent years practically no
flotations of common stock of utility companies have been attempted, because of
Regraded Uclassifi
2.
FEDERAL AEDERVE BANK OF NEW YORK
Secretary Morgenthau,
11/19/38
101
their low prices and public misgivings concerning their future safety. United Cor-
poration has also announced that it intends to enter the business of underwriting
security issues of all kinds of industries, devoting upwards of $30,000,000 to this
purpose. This would, of course, be a very important addition to the market's under-
writing capacity.
The largest issue floated this past week was $40,000,000 Dominion of Canada
3e of 1968 at 97 1/4, to yield 3.14 per cent, to refund notes maturing January 1.
The issue was quickly sold and quoted at 8. fractional premium. The $25,000,000
Argentine issue marketed November 3rd, having come out of syndicate, is quoted about
2 points below the offering price of 95 1/2. No other foreign government security
borrowings in this market are now in prospect.
Municipal awards this week amounted to over $31,300,000, of which the
largest was $19,400,000 Massachusetts 0.75 per cent burricane and flood damage bonds,
due 1939-43. A large award by Connecticut is scheduled for Monday, and one by New
York City sometime in the next few days.
Yours faithfully,
Mian Sproul,
First Vice President.
Hon, Henry Morgenthau, Jr.,
Secretary of the Treasury,
Treasury Department,
Washington, D.C.
Regraded Uclassified®
102
MEETING OF FISCAL AND MONETARY
November 21, 1938.
ADVISORY COMMITTEE
10:15 a.m.
Present:
Mr. Eccles
Mr. Bell
Mr. Ruml
Mr. Hanes
Mr. Taylor
Mr. Haas
Mr. White
Mr. Currie
Mr. McReynolds
H.M.Jr:
well, supposing we start. We'll teach some of these
boys around Washington what it is to be punctual.
Have you got a
....
Ruml:
I made up a little agenda. (Hands to H.M.Jr)
H.M.Jr:
I wished something on you; I don't know whether
you're going to take it on. Fortune Magazine -
did you hear about it?
Ruml:
Uh-huh.
H.M.Jr:
They're doing six round tables on Government. The
first one is Government spending. And they've got -
had a couple fellows Leon Henderson said it
wasn't so hot. I can't think of this one fellow -
always used to write for Harper's - what's his name?
Taylor:
Coyle.
H.M.Jr:
Incidentally, whose payroll is Coyle on anyway?
Taylor:
Ickes', I think.
H.M.Jr:
They wanted somebody from Treasury. I said no; so
I suggested you.
Ruml:
Well, I talked to the gentleman and I said my
presence there - "I would be very glad to go, but
don't be surprised if I don't tell you all I know."
He said, "All right, just come and be critical."
So 1 said I would.
H.M.Jr:
I thought it would be good.
Regraded Uclassified
103
-2-
Ruial:
Very timely. It comes in March.
H.M.Jr:
I thought it would be all right.
(Eccles comes in)
Good morning.
Becles:
Good morning.
H.M.Jr:
You haven't missed a thing, Marriner. Didn't even
declare a dividend.
Addles:
Dorry for that.
Rual:
Mr. Secretary, the first thing I'd like to find out
is when the next meeting will be, because I didn't
find out about this one until last Friday.
S.W.Jr:
That's what Mr. McReynolds is supposed to do. I
don't know what I told him.
(Bell comes in)
Well, I want, unless there is some material - I'd
like a little bit to skip next week, because that's
my financing week, and I'd like to go to two weeks
from today; or rather, here's the thing: we come
out with our financing on the 5th, which is 8 bad
day, 50 how about Tuesday the 6th? Is that too far
off? I can do it during the week.
Auml:
Monday the 5th - I cannot make it on Tuesday. Mr.
Secretary, I think that by next week we may have the
1937 and 1938 budgets analyzed from this point of
view. If we can make it Monday the 5th, perhaps,
or
H.M.Jr:
Well, I can, but - if you don't mind my jumping up
and down a couple times.
Huml:
Well, Monday the - when we take this presentation
of the two budgets, it's going to be, I think, quite
dramatic.
H.M.Jr:
Must it be in the morning?
Regraded Uclassified
104
-3-
Ruml:
No, I'd rather have it in the afternoon.
H.S.Jr:
Have a press conference Monday. I guess we'll have
to make It Monday the 5th. It's ell right with me.
A.8 I say, let's start by 10:30; by that time we'll
know mether the bonds are successful or not. 10:30
Monday the 5th - telephone and telegraph.
MeR:
Yes, sir.
H.M.Jr:
Is that all right with you, Marriner?
seeles:
ies, that suits me fine. Isn't it
h.M.Jr:
Yes, by 10:30 we'll know whether the issue is 8
success.
Accles:
You're not worrying, are you?
H.M.Jr:
I always worry until it's over. I'm like the actor;
they say if ne doesn't worry on the opening night, he
gives 8. bum performance.
accles:
I see.
H.R.Jr:
Well, lacking somebody else's having an agenda,
I'll accept Mr. Ruml's. And he's got down here -
and I want you to know that I'm never prepared - I
mean ne just writes it during his sleep, so you
wen - anybody that wants anything down on the agenda
see dr. Ruml. I take it ES he gives it to me, so
the meeting as far as I'm concerned is not - there
is no trading going on before.
"1. National income and budget - Treasury."
Ruml:
That's - I might say, Mr. Secretary, that all I've
done is to list the seven topics that we have had
consistently before us, so the meeting has not been
jemmed. This is Mr. Heas's report.
H.M.Jr:
"National income and budget - Treasury. " Recementure Rec 11/14/28
Beas:
You might re call the last time, Mr. Secretary, that
I said that we had it worked up on one basis, and
you asked if anybody was interested in seeing that
basis, they should come in and see me. I talked with
Currie about it, but ne wasn't interested in that
Regraded Uclassified
105
-4-
phase. But we have that worked up on one basis,
and I'm working it up on this more complex basis
which will take till some time in January. That's -
the status of that is the same - somewhat skeptical
whether we can even complete it in January - the
complex one.
H.M.Jr:
This is so brief, I don't understand it. What is it,
George?
Haas:
It is the determination of what on the basis of the
present tax structure - what would be the tax yield
at various levels of national income, by various
price levels.
H.M.Jr:
on, by price levels.
Hass:
National income can be arrived at - you can get the
same netional income by having different price levels.
H.M.Jr:
But you gove us one.
Hoas:
Yes, but that just assumes one condition with regard
to price levels. You get all kinds of combinations.
That's what takes the tremendous computation. I
think, though, that if Mr. Ruml - some of us get
together, that what I have done may fit the immediate
purpose. Don't have to go through all that.
H.M.Jr:
Well then, we've got to see some
Haas:
Well, I've got what I've already done here. You've
seen that.
H.M.Jr:
But nothing since then.
Heas:
No.
H.M.Jr:
Because, going over to the President - Hanes, Bell
and I - we're using those figures, I mean; the
President is much more national-income-minded now,
which I take it pleases all of you. And he'll want
to know about various levels of national income, how
much revenue could be expected on the present tax
base; and Hanes was giving him those figures. Is
that right, John?
Hanes:
That's right.
Regraded Uclassified
106
-5-
H.M.Jr:
Now, if those "ain't" right
....
Haas:
Oh, they all right.
H.M.Jr:
What?
Heas:
They're all right. You canget national income -
they're all right, on these assumptions, Mr.
Secretary. For example, one assumption we have
made, which is clearly indicated, is that we assumed
arbitrarily the price level would rise from 80
somewhat to 100 in ten years. We just assumed
that.
H.M.Jr:
Well now, look, I'm not going out on the end of a
limb for anybody, and I'm not going to put the
President out on the end of a limb. We're telling
him that at $60,000,000,000 on the present basis
he canget around $5,000,000,000.
Hanes:
Four billion, 992.
H.M.Jr:
Well, five. And then the President says, at 70
billion, which is a hope, as he puts it, we could
get
Hanes:
Six billion seven.
H.M.Jr:
How much?
Hanes:
Six, seven.
H.M.Jr:
Six, seven.
Bell:
But based on other indices, too - price level and
Federal Reserve Board.
H.M.Jr:
Yes. Is that all right?
Haas:
with the combination of indices as indicated on the
chart, that's all right, but it doesn't mean this,
Mr. Secretary, that when we say that the - when this
chart shows at the end 100 billion dollars national
income with 149 in the Federal Reserve index of
industrial production, and also have there 100 (price
level) - well, that particular combination of those
two indices is purely arbitrary. We say with that
combination you et 100 billion dollars national
Regraded Uclassified
107
-6-
income, and with 100 billion dollars national
income you get such and such revenue.
H.M.Jr:
Well now, wait a minute, George, if we can tell the
President that at 60 billion dollars he'll get -
with the present tax base, he gets so much revenue,
at 70 he gets so much, why can't you tell him at
80, 90, and 100?
Haas:
That's right, you can.
H.M.Jr:
Well, what are we waiting for? Why do I have to
wait until January?
Haas:
Well, Mr. Ruml, some of the other people, were
interested in a 100 billion dollar national income
and an 80 billion dollar national income which would
be arrived at at price levels other than the ones
we assumed.
H.M.Jr:
Let me just - because - let me just thrash this out,
I mean, here, because it's important, I want to get
it. If what we're telling the President - George
Haas is willing to sign it and stake his professional
reputation on the figures that we're giving him,
which the President most likely would use publicly,
that at 60 billion dollars the Treasury tells him
he'll get roughly five billion dollars and at 70
billion dollars, he'll et roughly
...
Hanes:
Six, seven.
H.M.Jr:
... six, seven - now, what the hell more does
anybody want?
Haas:
Well, this point
....
H.m.Jr:
What I'm trying to get at is, are we over-complicating
this thing - I mean making it so complicated that
everything is stalled?
Ruml:
No.
H.M.Jr:
See?
Ruml:
It is very important, on the intermediate - I don't
care about 100 billion dollars, we'll take that when
Regraded Uclassified
108
-7-
we get it - but it's very important on the inter-
mediate that we find out how much disorganization
is produced by a changed assumption on price level.
You may have to get your income without an increase
in price level; have to find out what that is.
H.M.Jr:
What I'm g etting at, Ruml, is that I want them to
do everything that they can here to help all of us,
but on the other hand - I mean why are the figures
satisfactory for 60 and 70 and not satisfactory for
80, 90, and 100?
Ruml:
Because the assumptions with respect to price level
may not be realistic.
H.M.Jr:
Are they all right at 60 and 70?
numl:
I should think SO.
Haas:
Yes.
Ruml:
I should think they're probably all right at 80,
but I think it's very important at a
...
H.M.Jr:
Put when this curve begins to go up and reaches
100, that's when you're worried.
Rum1:
The thing I'm worried about is, you may not get an
increase in the price level as much as 20 percent,
or as much as 25 percent; if you don't get an
increase of 25 percent, you're going to have an
entirely different figure at 100 billion than you
have at the present figure.
H.N.Jr:
But you're not worried about the estimates at 60
or 70.
Ruml:
No, nor even at 80. There may be variations, but
I'm not worried about them.
H.M.Jr:
But when we get in these other things, that's when
you're worried.
Ruml:
Not worried, but I'm simply concerned about the
accuracy in realistic terms of the figures.
Haas:
I think we realize that, and we've got that stated
in the memorandum. And I think, Mr. Secretary, you
Uclassifie
109
-8-
should have clearly in mind that the tax yield is
not a direct function of a particular level of
national income, because you get a different yield
depending upon the composition. For instance, you
have two national incomes, achieved at different
times, of a hundred billion dollars. They may yield
different amounts of taxes because the composition
may be different. For instance, in one case you
may have a larger proportion in wages and salaries;
in another instance you may have a larger proportion
of dividends. And the tax rates on dividends are
different from the tax rates on wages and salaries.
So in any case these figures are purely rough approxi-
mations, and you have to keep that in mind.
H.M.Jr:
Let me just - well, let me just digress - well, it
isn't 8 digression. Currie, or Mr. Eccles - Mr.
Eccles first - have you people made any estimate
over there as to what you think the national Income
will be for the calendar year '39?
accles:
"hy, we have made an estimate as to what the Federal
Reserve index of production would be. I don't know
that that's been interpreted into national income.
Has it, Currie?
Currie:
(Nods no)
Locles:
We figure that - the last figures I saw 8 week ago
estimated that the year as a whole would run at 105.
H.M.Jr:
The calendar year.
Locles:
Yes, the calendar year. Which would mean that there
possibly would be a high point during the year of
as much as 115 or maybe even 120; that the first part
of the year would likely be & good deal lower than the
latter part of the year, but, taking the year as a
whole, 105. Now, you have to - that naturally would
bear a very close relationship to the national income.
It hasn't - we haven't undertaken to convert it or
to interpret it into national income figures. It
could be done, on a rough estimate.
H.M.Jr:
Could you do it for this committee?
Lccles:
Yes, I think we could get at it, don't you, Currie,
on certain price level assumptions? 105 should not
Regraded Uclassified
110
-9-
necessarily incur increased - any increases in the
average price level. That is, the capacity of the
country and the available unskilled labor supply
should be such that unless we get up higher than
those figures there shouldn't be a material - it
should have very little effect upon the price level.
It is only when the production index and the national
income - and this is what I think Ruml is talking
about - get substantially above the prospective
levels that we can now see at the moment
H.M.Jr:
That's why I'm going to ask if you'd be willing,
at the meeting of December 5th, to come in with a
memorandum on what the best estimate is as to
national income for '39. I'll ask Haas to do the
same thing separately, you see,
What I'm getting at 1s, if we're down below 80
billion dollars, and I'm quite sure you will be in
your estimates - well then, what we're worrying
about is at least something for '40.
Ruml:
(Nods yes)
H.M.Jr:
what? And then if Haas says, well, he can't bring it
in until January, that's all right. But I'd like to
have something to be able - an estimate - well, I
think you've got two weeks to make an estimate, by
December 5th, of what you think the national income
will be. The Treasury organization will do one and
the Fed will do one, too.
Eccles:
What is it?
H.M.Jr:
The Fed will do one, too.
Eccles:
That's right.
H.M.Jr:
Swell. Make a note of that, George.
Haas:
Uh-huh.
H.M.Jr:
Well now, I think we could move on, don't you,
Marriner, from number one? We really have been
talking about number two also, haven't we?
Ruml:
Number two, there's nothing new to report. The
chart I gave last week is all we can do on that,
Regraded Uclassified
111
-10-
all that's necessary.
H.M.Jr:
I see.
Ruml:
Nothing to do on number two.
H.M.Jr:
All right.
Ruml:
Number two is in as good form
H.M.Jr:
Now we come to good old bottlenecks, number three.
Accles:
We had that. This - it was also the question of
timing and bottlenecks - was given to us. And in
connection with the matter of timing, that isn't
on the agenda today, but we have been doing con-
siderable study on it. And Mr. Currie last week
brought those charts over, and we worked up some
additional charts that should be helpful in
approaching this question of timing.
However, it is difficult for us to proceed in this
matter until we canisome more information with
reference to the 1939-1940 budget figures. We've
got here: "The work of a quantitative nature on
this problem of timing in '38 and 139 awaits upon
the completion of revised budget estimates for the
fiscal year '39, and preliminary estimates for the
calendar year '40."
Now, both of these - this work is being carried on
by the Treasury, and I assume that we ought to be
able to get those revised figures, had we not,
George,
H.M.Jr:
No, ...
Eccles:
... because ...
H.M.Jr:
we haven't got them ourselves.
Eccles:
Well, I don't mean immediately, but I mean when you
get them.
H.M.Jr:
Oh, sure. But I'm telling you - I think it's all
right to say what I'm going to say - that we haven't
got anything, and this is strictly in this room, as
Regraded Uclassified
112
-11-
a figure from the President on this so-called new
program for national defense. So we're completely
in the dark. You (Bell) don't mind my saying that.
Bell:
No, that's all right.
H.M.Jr:
What?
Bell:
That's all right.
H.M.Jr:
The President left town yesterday leaving Dan and
me completely in the dark as to what he wants. So
I think ... And we're completely in the dark on
the unemployment figures.
Bell:
That's right.
H.M.Jr:
So until we have those two figures, anything we
give you would be just kidding you. We could give
you the figures as we had them before we started
talking national defense, but it's no use giving
you those, and I'm not going to kid you.
Eccles:
What that refers to, of course, is the preliminary
estimate for the fiscal year '40. There is also the
question of the revised estimate for the year '39.
H.M.Jr:
Well, that's available.
Eccles:
Well, it hasn't been available yet, has it, Currie?
Bell:
Not the revised estimates since the budget estimate
in July.
Haas:
That's the thing we worked up, Mr. Secretary, to
put in the January budget.
Bell:
15th of December is the earliest and possibly the
25th, around Christmas, the latest.
Eccles:
Well, as soon as we could get ...
H.M.Jr:
When would you have it? - excuse me.
Bell:
Some time between the 15th of December, the earliest
date, and the 25th, 28th, somewhere in there.
McR:
Of course, that involves the financial program for
the last half of this fiscal year.
Regraded Uclassified
113
-12-
Bell:
Oh yes, that's right.
McR:
You're still almost as much in the dark on that as
you are on the other.
Bell:
Except that there is only one item in the 1939 that
we will change materially, and that's the WPA program
for the last six months.
Eccles:
Yes. Well, of course, there's got to be certain
things assumed on all this program. That goes
without saying.
H.M.Jr:
Well, you know everything that we know, and we know
damn little.
Eccles:
Well, I merely mentioned that in connection with
the problem of timing. For us to do any more on it
other than just - we've worked out what we feel is
a satisfactory method. Now what we need is, as soon
as we can get more accurate information, why, then
it can be interpreted as to its effect, but without
the information, of course, we can do nothing more
about it.
H.M.Jr:
Well, I just want you to know that we haven't
got anything.
Bccles:
Well, I'd understood that - that it wasn't avail-
able yet.
H.M.Jr:
The President doesn't get back until the 5th, and
unless Dan insists on going to Warm Springs ....
Bell:
I'm liable to.
H.M.Jr:
... why, we're not apt to have much more information.
Bell:
I should think they could take the budget summation
for 1939, possibly adding 500 million dollars for
WPA - or 400 million would be plenty to add.
H.M.Jr:
Huh? Write that and sign your name to it?
Bell:
For 139, yes. Yes, I think on the cash outlay I
will. I hope it will be down to 250, but I say 400
as & maximum.
Regraded Uclassified
114
-13-
Eccles:
That'll be five months.
Bell:
Yes, there's already in the budget 500 million for
the five months; then increase that item by 400.
H.M.Jr:
Oh.
Bell:
And I think you've got plenty in 1939 for the whole
program.
H.M.Jr:
Oh, you mean 900 million.
Eccles:
But increase the present budget.
Bell:
Yes, sir. I'm not worried about the other estimates.
Eccles:
Well, of course, there's a question too - the
R.F.C. put in certain estimates as to what they're
going to use, and Public Works, and then it never
carries - it doesn't materialize that they - the
estimates are made up often from figures that these
people submit as to what they're going to use and
they don't even come close.
H.M.Jr:
You saw our bubble chart.
Eccles:
That's what I say.
McR:
The trouble with these estimates of Danny is
that they do, though.
H.M.Jr:
The WPA
Eccles:
You know the ones you're going to use, but you've
got to take these budget estimates and, based on
past experience, make your own estimates.
H.M.Jr:
We always knock off Jesse Jones 90 percent.
Bccles:
At least 90.
Well now, the question of bottlenecks there. Some
work has been done on that in connection with what
appears to be one of the most obvious developments,
and that's the case of the railroads - railroad
equipment. Currie, you have those charts, don't
you?
(Currie places chart on chair near H.M.Jr)
Regraded Uclassified
115
-14-
Eccles:
Yes. Do you want to present the chart first or
the memorandum?
Currie:
I think perhaps the memorandum and then the chart.
Bccles:
Here, you go ahead with it.
Currie:
"Under the topic 'Bottlenecks' a study has been
initiated of the ability of the railroads to handle
the peak loads of prosperous years. As a result of
the preliminary survey, certain tentative conclusions
emerge, which, if borne out by more intensive study,
appear to be highly significant. Although attention
has been mostly directed toward freight cars, it is
believed that the findings apply to other types of
equipment."
The findings are as follows:
"1. It is estimated that to handle the volume of
peak traffic consequent upon full recovery within,
say, three years, total car requirements would
have to approximate 2,000,000 cars."
You notice (on chart) they're down now to one
million seven - that's total cars owned, that top
line - " indicating a shortage of 300,000 cars.
Adding retirements, the total requirements for" -
adding retirements to this, which amounts to about
a hundred thousand EL year, and making allowance
also for putting more of the bad-order cars into
service, that gap between those two upper lines -
"the total requirements for new cars would amount
to about 600,000 units in three years, or approxi-
mately 200,000 per year."
H.M.Jr:
Excuse me - new cars?
Currie:
New cars.
H.M.Jr:
New.
Currie:
Now, If we take a more modest assumption, "we
assume a sufficient degree of recovery by 1940 to
represent about the same degree of utilization of
our plant capacity in general as prevailed through-
out the twenties, which would correspond with a
Federal Reserve Board index of production of
Regraded Uclassified
116
-15-
between 125 and 130" - which doesn't seem out of
the realms of possibility to achieve in 1940 - "total
car requirements would amount to 1,900,000. Taking
retirements at about 100,000 per year, this would
call for total new car construction of 400,000 in
two years" - in the next two years.
"3. To the extent to which new cars produced in
1939 fall short of 200,000, requirements in 1940,
to handle the assumed volume of peak traffic, would
have to be correspondingly higher than 200,000.
"4. The maximum number of new cars produced in any
one year was 150,000 in 1923. This suggests that
the capacity in the car making field may be inade-
quate to handle the volume of possible new require-
ments. Further study is necessary to verify this
indication." The meximum they have ever produced
is 150,000 and we're estimating a need for 200,000
a year.
"5. The same general conclusions apply to other types
of equipment. Thus, under the first assumption of
full recovery in three years, annual new locomotive
requirements would amount to 3,400 locomotives" a
year.
Haas:
Full recovery is how much?
Currie:
Full recovery, 145.
H.M.Jr:
Two years - am I right - they made 15 or 25 locomo-
tives, What was it, 15 or 25 - somewhere in there.
White:
I think it was 15.
H.M.Jr:
It was either 15 or 25 that they made.
White:
I have a table on that, yes.
H.M.Jr:
It was the most amazing thing.
Eccles:
They haven't made any for years here to amount to
anything; that's the trouble.
Currie:
Now, putting this in dollar terms - "Construction
activity in new equipment of this magnitude would
require a total annual outlay of approximately
Regraded Uclassified
117
-16-
$800,000,000" 8. year.
H.M.Jr:
That's for cars?
Currie:
Cars and locomotives and passenger trains, carrying
these estimates right through on that basis.
"7. In view of the financial condition of the
railroads, and the tendency for orders to be
postponed until absolutely necessary, it appears
unlikely that expenditures for new equipment of
such magnitude will be undertaken in the near
future.
"8. Assuming, therefore, the continuance of recovery
at a desirable rate, there appears to be a very dis-
tinct possibility of a shortage of equipment in
1940, of a bottleneck in equipment making capacity,
and of a comparatively sudden and relatively large
demand for steel from the railroads superimposed
on what are likely to be heavy demands from other
industries."
H.M.Jr:
Will you read that sentence again?
Currie:
"Assuming, therefore, the continuance of recovery
at a desirable rate" - that is, a rate that would
get us around 125 somewhere in 1940, and then rom
there on - "there appears to be a very distinct
possibility of a shortage of equipment in 1940,
of a bottleneck in equipment making capacity, and
of a comparatively sudden and relatively large
demand for steel from the railroads superimposed
on what are likely to be heavy demands from other
industries."
And you will notice from the chart, Mr. Secretary,
that the steady decline in the railway cars owned
since the twenties - it's gone down steadily; even
the purchase of the 65,000 cars last year was not
sufficient to arrest that decline, because retire-
ments are about 100,000 a year.
H.M.Jr:
I'd like to ask a couple questions. I've been
sitting in on this airplane business. I think that -
if I'm right, that the locomotive people have kept
their prices up - I mean whether they sold 15
118
-17-
locomotives or whether they sold 500 locomotives.
I think I'm right. I don't know that they keep
their price right up - just about the same, I
mean. Has anybody ever talked to the locomotive
people - I mean that if they got an order for a
thousand locomotives, whether they would really
go into production and do something over a two-
or three-year basis.
Haas:
I did once.
H.M.Jr:
What?
Haas:
I did once, some years back, and they said - talked
to the vice president of one of the companies - the
Lima Locomotive
H.M.Jr:
He represents - they have an association and the
President of Lima has been down to see us.
Haas:
I talked to him, and I asked him why they didn't
do that, and he said the main difficulty was that
a locomotive was largely a custom job, that you
had a certain - the tracks were not uniform, and
even the type of trains they had to haul - in other
words, they had to design the locomotive largely,
he said, to fit certain situations; but he didn't -
that was his argument.
H.M.Jr:
That's just like the plane people. But I was won-
dering if the railroad people could get this down
to two or three types - I mean whether then they
couldn't go into production on a chain-belt basis
and really produce some at a reasonable price.
Eccles:
Well, we had last year in a part of the recovery
program - we did B good deal of work on this whole
question of railroad equipment, and I had several
conferences with Wright, who is the R.F.C. adviser.
H.M.Jr:
Good man.
Eccles:
Yes, very good man. He did some work for us. We
also had discussed the matter with Averill Harriman
a couple of times, and we had their controller,
a fellow that's experienced, to check a lot of
our figures and estimates. And as I recall, Currie,
Regraded Uclassified
119
-18-
they pretty well agreed upon this problem; they
indicated that there was, of course, a lot of
bad-order equipment and there was a real danger
of a shortage of equipment. What we were trying
to get them to favor, which they weren't particularly
favorable to - they came back with an alternative
program - we tried to get them to favor a program
whereby a Government corporation would purchase the
equipment and would - and the railroads would be pre-
vented from buying their own equipment, 30 far as
it could be first furnished by this corporation,
the idea being to do just this thing: to place
orders for thousands of cars, to try to get the
equipment standardized, and thus to place orders
at a time when the steel mills and the equipment
companies had no business, no orders; and then the
equipment would be available to lease to them.
That would, of course, give the Government this
self-liquidating project that could be financed
outside of the budget through the R.F.C. And over
a period of three years it was estimated that at
least a billion to a billion and a half could be
done in that field.
The whole equipment field couldn't be taken over
at once; it would take time, of course, because
there was the passenger equipment and certain loco-
motives - it was felt that most of the railroad
freight equipment could be standardized, and also
certain types of locomotives, these switch engines -
and a certain type could be standardized. We've
got a - we've done a lot of work on it, and it ...
-
however, that's out, and
H.M.Jr:
Why is it out?
Eccles:
Well, it's out unless Congress would set up that
kind of a set-up.
S.M.Jr:
Why is it out?
White:
I think one of the essential preliminaries for bring-
ing it back in again is an appreciation of just this
problem. Once it's realized the bottlenecks that
would exist, then some proposal to eliminate that
possibility comes to the fore, and if they could sift
the various possibilities, this one is
Regraded Uclassified
120
-19-
Eccles:
Of course, the railroads say this - Wright and this
fellow from Union Pacific and Harriman, too, said
that you could avoid this trouble if there was a
sufficiently favorable loan basis made by the
R.F.C.; that there would be a great deal of equip-
ment purchased if it wasn't a question of putting
out funds by the railroads; that many of them
didn't have funds and those that did were very
hesitant at this time to impair in any way their
cash position; and that if the R.F.C. would make
hundred percent loans, taking the equipment as
security, and loan it on a basis of, say, two
percent or two and a half, just about what the
money would cost the Government, that - and give
them, say, "In order to get the benefit of this,
you must place so many orders now, so many in
six months, so many in six months more" - in
other words, the railroads under that kind of a
program would come under - would place a good
deal of equipment because it would not r equire
the cash outlay. And they contended - and I think
it's correct - that the cost of maintaining a great
portion of their present equipment - lot of it is
old and it's obsolete, it's expensive to operate
it, and the cost of maintaining it and operating
it is far more than an interest rate of, say, two
or two and a half percent and the amortization over
8. period of twenty years. Therefore, it would
actually be cheaper to buy new equipment and scrap
a lot of the old equipment than it would be to try
to keep this equipment in repair.
H.M.Jr:
May I just ask this a minute. I mean I know a
little but not an awful lot about the railroad
situation; but I do know about their debt situa-
tion, and I mean I wouldn't be worrying about
having to get a law that they'd have to buy this
or rent this thing first; because if this thing
was done and the people had - shops had two- or
three-year orders, they could cut their prices
so that no railroad could buy as cheaply as this
central agency. DO there wouldn't be any ques-
tion - I mean you could cut, most likely, loco-
motives in half if you gave them enough orders
for two or three years.
In this talk that you had - I mean is it - maybe
it's all been done - the idea of the Government
Regraded Uclassified
121
-20-
doing this and then leasing this equipment to the
railroads?
Eccles:
That's right.
H.M.Jr:
Was that Currie's memorandum originally? I'm not
teasing.
Eccles:
It was worked up there by ...
H.M.Jr:
Well, I mean ....
Eccles:
Don't know whether you saw it or not.
H.M.Jr:
Well, I don't want to tease; I saw it, but I saw
it in the press.
Currie:
Mr. Taylor had a copy of it.
Eccles:
Wayne - this thing was discussed with him.
H.M.Jr:
Does that need legislation?
Eccles:
Yes.
H.M.Jr:
Well, why don't you do this? This is what bothers
me, and I don't know whether # bothers the rest of
you - the thing about this present recovery that
bothers me so much is that so much of it depends
upon the automobile business. I mean the more you
read - I mean, for instance, if the automobile
business should go sour tomorrow I'd be worried
like hell, and
Eccles:
And you've got to
....
H.M.Jr:
If I may just finish a second now - and to have some-
thing in its place, to take its place, why wouldn't
it be proper to have this committee develop this
thought of a Government corporation to build rail-
road equipment and lease it? And why wouldn't it
be proper - I mean let's divide this up, and as
long as you did it before, if the rest are willing,
you take it up with Jesse and see whether you can't
push this thing, see? The idea of 8. Government
corporation. And, Marriner - and have it sell its
own
Regraded Uclassified
122
-21-
Eccles:
Oh yes, sell its own lebentures against the
equipment.
H.M.Jr:
Sell its own debentures. And the life of that
equipment is what, about 20 years?
Eccles:
Yes; I think at least the life of the debentures
should be. The equipment may be maintained -
depends on the type of equipment, of course, and
the usage; but debentures should not exceed 20
years.
H.M.Jr:
And I'd like a sinking fund and - I mean write off
Taylor:
Of course, regular equipment trust type of obliga-
tion.
Eccles:
Amortized installment payment program.
H.M.Jr:
And then have it - I'd talk in terms of a billion
dollar corporation.
Eccles:
It ought to be a billion if you're going to do it
at all.
H.M.Jr:
Billion dollar corporation. And then do with this -
publicize it in advance the way they have done on
the utility thing, see? I mean get this out - this
committee could get it out as a committee and publi-
cize it and educate the public, and then this thing -
again, all of this is in the room - the President
doesn't feel that he's going to get any railroad
legislation, for this very important reason, that
Burt Wheeler is sitting back and taking the atti-
tude "Whatever's going to happen, I'm going to
hang this on the President," and the President is
very fearful that he can't get anywhere.
And for you people, if you'd care to see it, Mac
and I - which happened to be my idea; Mac worked
it out for me, worked out in the greatest detail
for the President eight months ago a bill just for
a transportation department. If any of you people
would like to see that, it's available.
Eccles:
Think it would be very well to see it, Currie, in
connection with this study.
Regraded Uclassified
123
-22-
H.M.Jr:
And very ably done. So we have a bill for a
transportation department which was worked out
here.
White:
The beauty of this procedure, Mr. Secretary, is
that it has any number of excellent selling points.
The one you mentioned about not being dependent on,
not one crop but in this case one industry's pros-
perity. Second, this proposal, as it could be
developed, could fit into that plan or any other
plan which the Government saw fit to do with respect
to the railroads; it doesn't commit the Government
to a course of action which would hamper it in later
developments.
H.M.Jr:
Well - and then you can do this; we can be a little
bit - slightly intellectually dishonest, we can call
this a part of national defense.
White:
Well, that's definitely a part of it.
Ruml:
Perfectly sound.
Eccles:
It's perfectly
H.M.Jr:
All right, thank you, gentlemen. Thank you, thank
you. I thought I'd rather say it than have somebody
else say it.
McR:
You're clear.
H.M.Jr:
I wanted to say it first.
Bell:
Sounds familiar to the Director of the Budget.
Currie:
Right on that point
H.M.Jr:
I thought I'd better say it before some of these
...
Currie:
...the surplus cars this fall, with this very low
peak of traffic down here, was not greater than
in the twenties, really, which is the absolute -
I mean the reilroads are just not equipped to
handle any decent expansion of traffic.
H.M.Jr:
You know, a month ago you were talking to the
Director General of the Railroads, and Danny Bell
Regraded Uclassified
124
-23-
took that title a month ago. Danny Bell took that
title.
Eccles:
He didn't know it, either, until somebody told him.
H.M.Jr:
Yes, I did.
Taylor:
Stationery with a locomotive on it.
H.M.Jr:
I could have gotten railroad passes and everything.
McR:
He refused to use railroad passes.
H.M.Jr:
I feel - we had six employees.
Bell:
I was Assistant Director General, and as railroad
experts we
H.M.Jr:
You wiped me off on that, didn't you?
Bell:
Yes, we closed it up.
Accles:
I don't know of any program that has more selling
points than this program has. We haven't even
scratched the surface of it this morning, but last
year we were prepared for all of them, and I dis-
cussed this thing with the President and he was very -
he was for it, but he ran right into this problem
that you know developed last fall with Wheeler and
with the railroads themselves asking for a freight
increase.
But it seems to me that if we're going to approach
the problem of a compensatory budget policy, it can't
be done unless we bring in just this sort of thing,
because that after all is what it amounts to.
Haas:
That's right. Sweden has those things under their
control. Sweden has the big industries which they
expand and contract expenditures, and this is one
way of doing it.
Eccles:
Without running the railroads, without taking over
the obligations of the railroads - you can enter
this field in - and in no way assume their obliga-
tions, whereas ....
Regraded Uclassified
125
-24-
H.M.Jr:
Well, Marriner, would you carry the ball on this
and have something further on it in two weeks?
Eccles:
Be glad to,
H.M.Jr:
Because inasmuch as you all think this is a matter
of national defense (smiling), I think we ought to
carry it forward rapidly.
White:
And national safety, because the equipment is reach-
ing a point at which a ccidents will occur.
H.M.Jr:
Would you in doing it - the thought, I mean, that
as near as possible standardize the freight car
and standardize the locomotive down to everal
types. I mean that if they need special types,
let them buy those themselves, but - in other words,
if the railroads - so many coal cars and so many this
and so many that - I mean if we could get down to
three types of locomotives and three types of freight
cars, and we'd specialize in that, and if they need
the other stuff - in other words, what I'd like to
see is to get out a freight car which would be accept-
able to every railroad, and then when one railroad
doesn't need it and it's slack, you can give it to
another. And depending upon - as the wheat crop
moves, the freight car would follow the wheat crop.
And keep it down to that sort of thing, so that kind
of locomotive could be used almost on any type.
Then if they get into a highly specialized thing
that has to take them over the Rocky Mountains, let
them buy those themselves.
Currie:
This corporation could also be used for direct
negotiation for the railroads on complete stream-
lined trains, something like that, built for a
long-term lease. Doesn't do away with the possi-
bility of specifications for individual railroads.
H.M.Jr:
No, but I've just - I've sat in on this airplane
business at the President's invitation, and I'm
more and more convinced that if we can simplify
this thing
How many different kinds of tires
do we buy for the Army? You remember that time
we
McR:
I don't know -tremendous.
Regraded Uclassified
126
-25-
H.M.Jr:
It's just perfectly silly. And then we got down
to a certain type of tire. I mean it's Just per-
fectly silly, the number of kinds of tires that we
buy for the Army through Procurement; it's just
asinine.
Eccles:
There would have to be some compulsory legislation
on this. The discussions I had indicated that
these railroad fellows are RS finicky and tempera-
mental as a woman. They have some different little
variations in equipment of different companies,
because of different foolish ideas, and I think
you'd have to have B
H.M.Jr:
Marriner, may I just say
...
Eccles:
Go ahead.
H.M.Jr:
if you don't mind, I'd rather - if I'm going to
have something to do with, I'd as a last resort -
let's make it democratic and voluntary. I mean I'd
hate to be party to something that's going to force
something on the railroads. Let's make it so attrac-
tive to them on a price basis that their directors
and their stockholders are going to say, "Well, if
you canget a locomotive from the Government at
$50,000, why the hell should you spend a hundred
thousand?" I mean I hate this legislation which
superimposes this Administration on anything.
Becles:
Well, what you could do, I suppose, would be to
lease it on a cheap enough basis
H.M.Jr:
that they got to take it.
Eccles:
that the railroads couldn't afford to use their
own funds.
H.M.Jr:
Good old Jesse Jones, who beat me down to a half
of one percent for his money. Now, on a 20-year
basis, there's no reason in the world why - I mean
if we had to raise money - but you're going to sell
these things - why these people should pay at the
outside more than two to three percent for their
money.
Eccles:
No, they shouldn't; they can go out and get money
for themselves at three or three and & half.
Regraded Uclassifie
127
-26-
H.M.Jr:
But they can't on their own credit. The B & 0,
for instance, can't do it; but the B & O undoubtedly
would be a good customer.
Taylor:
They can do it on equipment trust
....
Eccles:
They can all do it on an equipment trust basis,
on an 80 percent trust basis - pay 20 down and the
balance is amortized; but the rate is three, three
and a half percent.
H.M.Jr:
Would you go into it? But try and not to make it -
how shall I say - compulsory on the part of the
railroads.
McR:
Don't prevent the railroads from doing what they
want to do; merely create a situation where they
can't afford to do anything else.
Eccles:
You could do that if you made it cheap enough,
if you put the rental low enough.
H.M.Jr:
That's - sure, that's the point. It's the same
thing on a housing - your F.H.A. loan; you don't
make the man take an F.H.A. loan, but you make it
so attractive that he can't afford to take any
other kind of loan.
Eccles:
That's right.
H.M.Jr:
Well, will you carry it?
Eccles:
This thing has a further important aspect. It is
this: that in times of depression, where the
railroads are in bad, having difficulty, you could
drop the rate of rental down to a very low point
and thus tend to assist them. In times of real
business prosperity, when they're making substan-
tial earnings, you could raise the rental charge.
So that this could be used as a means of leveling
out the earning conditions of the railroads, and
would tend to stabilize
H.M.Jr:
I don't think you could do that.
Eccles:
... their income or securities, instead of increas-
ing - what they do now is increase and decrease
freight rates to meet the problem, which is the wrong
Regraded Uclassified
128
-27-
way to do it.
H.M.Jr:
But in making the study would you also see whether
the kind of steel that goes into freight cars and
locomotives is in competition with automobiles? I
don't think it is, but that's important.
Eccles:
I think it's much heavier.
H.M.Jr:
I don't think so; but that would be important,
Currie.
Currie:
Yes.
H.M.Jr:
What?
Currie:
Yes.
H.M.Jr:
I think you'll find it's a different kind, b ecause
there are certain of these mills now running at a
hundred percent - I understand Inland Steel is
running at a hundred percent on sheets for auto-
mobiles - their capacity. But I'd be interested
to see whether some of the other units which go
into locomotives and cars
...
And of course, it
would use a lot of wood too.
Currie:
That's true.
Eccles:
We'll make this study, but there is this alterna-
tive, which doesn't involve legislation, that would
help to meet this problem. And that would be that
the R.F.C. would offer them a hundred percent loan,
which there is no legal r eason why they can't do,
and then can loan it st two percent; they in other
words could induce the railroads today to go out on
a very large scale and anticipate or buy equipment.
That is, assuming of course that you don't want to
get legislation or if you can't get legislation,
still we can do a lot toward meeting this bottleneck
situation.
H.M.Jr:
May I make two others?
White:
Except that this is one of the best cases which you
might be able to sell Congress. It has so much to
speak for itself that it is an excellent beginning
in that type of operation.
Regraded Uclassified
129
-28-
H.M.Jr:
May I make two other suggestions? One, that if we have
this kind of corporation it would be set up, Mac, with
a little board, the board on the same basis that we've
set up Commodity Credit as a model. I'm the only
stockholder in Commodity Credit, but the board goes
ahead and functions, and they have all the authority.
In other words, I'd like to set this up so that if
there is a railroad administration it would be taken
out of the Treasury and transferred right there; we'll
give it up like that; but if it's some other indepen-
dent agency, they might hang on to it a little longer.
See what I mean? What I'm trying to say is, I wouldn't
put it in R.F.C., and if we have it here simply with
myself as stockholder, but with this board functioning
purely independently, then if you get a railroad admin-
istration, why, that can be - and if you look at that
bill you'll see how we can do it - that thing can be
transferred right over to the railroad administration.
But leave it here as a resting place until you have it.
But my own inclination is, I would not put it in
R.F.C.
Taylor:
Probably keep the stock here anyhow.
H.M.Jr:
What?
Taylor:
Probably keep the stock here anyhow.
H.M.Jr:
Marriner, if you look at how we set up Commodity
Credit, we think that's a model.
Eccles:
The R.F.C. furnishes that money, don't they, for
Commodity Credit?
Taylor:
No, the market does.
Eccles:
I know, but what I mean - does
Taylor:
Once in a while the R.F.C. eases them over a spot,
but they do their own financing.
Eccles:
What I meant was that to the extent that the R.F.C.
needs to come in, the R.F.C. has sponsored and
furnished the money in the first instance for
Commodity Credit.
H.M.Jr:
Yes, but they don't control it. It's not controlled -
we've changed it; it's not controlled
Regraded Uclassified
130
-29-
Eccles:
The stock of it
H.M.Jr:
The stock of it is here.
Eccles:
It's held here instead of R.F.C.
Taylor:
Yes.
Eccles:
Was it originally the R.F.C.?
Taylor:
You had a rather peculiar situation in which there
was stock scattered between the Secretary of
Agriculture, Farm Credit Administration - who was
the other one?
Bell:
Mr. Hull, wasn't it?
Taylor:
Not on Commodity Credit, was it? He may have been
in on that too. There was a minimum of common
stock, you see; then they built up this big R.F.C.
holding when they increased the capital to make up
for the losses. In addition to that, the R.F.C.
financed them through borrowing, and the R.F.C.
in turn got the funds from us. But that's all been
washed out in this new legislation.
H.M.Jr:
Wayne worked this out. de's largely responsible for
this, and I think it's a good model. And all we
do - we hold the stock. And as I say, the beauty
of the thing is, the directors are made up of repre-
sentatives of Agriculture, Farm Credit, and R.F.C.,
but nobody controls it; nobody controls it.
Eccles:
This would likely be, in order to get the lowest
possible rate - to be able to rent this equipment
at a price that would be 8 great inducement, likely
would have to have a guaranty.
Taylor:
Have to sell it with a Government guaranty, just the
way we sold Commodity Credit debentures.
H.M.Jr:
What I'm getting at, Marriner, is that we haven't
been very lucky in getting Jesse to do this kind of
thing, and if we're going to do this thing, set the
thing up so it will go to town - and I think we'll
get further, that's all, if
Regraded Uclassified
131
-30-
Eccles:
Well, I agree with you a hundred percent.
H.M.Jr:
And it isn't - if you study the thing, it isn't
that - I don't control Commodity Credit, it's con-
trolled by the representatives of Farm Credit,
Agriculture, and R.F.C. They run it.
Eccles:
The structure is a lot simpler, after all. Anyway,
why have the Treasury own stock in the R.F.C. and
then the R.F.C. have stock in another corporation?
You're building up a super-holding company. So
why not have the Treasury hold directly the stock?
Taylor:
That's what we were doing; and this is, we think,
a model that should be applied to all the rest of
them, not only the existing ones but any which may
be created in the future. And over a period we're
going to try to get the other ones adjusted to this
model.
Eccles:
Well, I think it's all right; I'm for it.
H.M.Jr:
I think it is. The only reason I'm stressing it is
that if it's set up that way and the President wanted
it, and the rest of it, I think we could go to town
on it - and Congress wanted it; and we wouldn't have -
well, as I say, it's the record of Jesse that he says
he'll lend a hundred million and then he lends ten
million.
Taylor:
He's loaned plenty to the railroads.
H.M.Jr:
Well, will you carry this and come in in two weeks
with something?
Eccles:
Yes, all right.
Currie:
Mr. Secretary, I think it would be helpful in this
thing if we could get in touch with and get some
support from the Army people on this national defense,
just as we did on the power program.
H.M.Jr:
Well, whatever Mr. - whatever Mr. Eccles wants; it's
up to him.
Taylor:
You won't have any trouble getting support for this
at this time, Marriner. Last spring, why, it was a
Regraded Uclassified
132
-31-
little more clouded, but I think now, why, the time
is much more propitious for it.
Eccles:
It's like everything else. It was too new; they hadn't
digested it.
H.M.Jr:
I don't like to lean so heavily on the automobile
industry.
Eccles:
Well, certainly if the railroad industry and housing
do not continue to go forward on an increasing scale,
the automobile industry is likely to bog down. The
one thing that will tend to maintain the automobile
industry would be to - this sort of E thing has not
only the effect of giving employment within this
particular industry, but the fact that it gives this
employment is going to help to sustain and maintain
the automobile industry and it will help to push
housing because it will help the whole problem of
employment.
H.W.Jr!
It's all to the good.
White:
One of the studies just completed by the National
Resources Board supplies a factual basis for that
statement rather clearly; it shows a fact we have
all observed, how the automobile industry responds
most quickly and is most sensitive to changes in
national income. So what you say has that to
support it.
H.M.Jr:
Do you feel all right on this, John?
Hanes:
Yes, sir; good, fine.
H.M.Jr:
All right. See anything the matter with it?
Hanes:
No. I like it.
H.M.Jr:
All right?
Hanes:
Yes.
H.M.Jr:
All right. Does that clear that up, Marriner?
Eccles:
Yes, that's satisfactory to me. I think we can -
do you see any reason, Currie, why we can't have the
Regraded Uclassified
133
-32-
staff specialize in this field for the next two
weeks?
Currie:
No.
Eccles:
Bring together and dig up all the material we got
last year; revive it and shape it up for a meeting.
Taylor:
You're 90 percent in now, with the stuff that you
did last year.
Eccles:
We've got a raft of stuff on it.
H.M.Jr:
All right. Two weeks?
Eccles:
All right.
Taylor:
I can work on that with you; I can give you this
Commodity Credit set-up.
Currie:
Fine.
H.M.Jr:
Is that - anything else on bottlenecks?
Currie:
There's just one other point, Mr. Secretary, and
that is that I haven't done any work yet on the
power industry - I thought that would be the next
thing to turn to - but this chart I had made up
for another purpose indicates, I think, the possible
seriousness of it. I put capacity, output, and
capital expenditures on a base of 1929 equals 100;
they're all index-numbered. So that means not that
capacity - that your output was up to capacity in
'29, but that was the relationship in 129. See,
we're back in '37 - we got back to the 1929 rela-
tionship, and we're almost back there now, because
power is recovering again and we're not adding much
to capacity this year.
H.M.Jr:
Isn't there a committee on that - Louis Johnson... ?
Currie:
I believe there is.
H.M.Jr:
Is there anything we ought to do on it?
Currie:
I don't know - unless we bring it into our g eneral
study on bottlenecks.
Regraded Uclassified
134
-33-
Bell:
A national defense program, - I don't think it goes
to the commercial end of it.
Eccles:
It doesn't make any difference whether it's battleships
or power, what it is, it all has an influence on this
question we're dealing with - that if you're going
to have this power situation deferred, its develop-
ment deferred to a point where then it's a rush Job
to try to g et equipment and build power facilities,
it's just like building railroad equipment all at
once.
H.M.Jr:
Well, if you listen - excuse me - if you listen to
Louis Johnson, he's got it all done. But why not
ask him?
Eccles:
Well, I think we ought to point out the danger of
bottlenecks wherever they are.
H.M.Jr:
No you want to find out what they have done?
Eccles:
I think we ought to do it, Currie. After all, we
can't study the question of bottlenecks
H.M.Jr:
unless you've got all the bottlenecks.
Eccles:
Yes - where the possible problem is going to
develop.
Currie:
There is one little sour note, Mr. Secretary; that
was in the press report of that conference after
you left the White House, in the Times - that's all
I know about it - to the effect that some of the
utilities privately expressed the view that this
was really work they were going to do anyway.
H.M.Jr:
Well, Hanes knows something, if he'll talk.
Hanes:
Well, I don't know who made that statement, but my
understanding is that that was not a true statement
nor was it the opinion of the people that attended
the conference; that they said they would not have
spent anything like this sum of money - by 500
million dollars, I think they said. So whoever
made that statement, they say - Grosbeck said it
was a misstatement of the fact. I saw that too,
the same thing you were talking about, and I asked
him about it immediately.
Regraded Uclassified
135
-34-
H.M.Jr:
Well, aren't they asking for legislation too?
Bell:
They will, I think.
H.M.Jr:
Yes, they need legislation.
Eccles:
Who is it, the Power ...
H.M.Jr:
The Power Commission.
Eccles:
It's a problem of equity financing to quite an
extent with the power people, as well as, of
couse, an understanding with eference to their
legal status.
H.M.Jr:
Didn't they ask
....
Eccles:
Jones came out and said he would underwrite it up
to 250 million dollars.
H.M.Jr:
I think they've done it, but why don't you ask them,
Marriner, what they've done?
Eccles:
All right.
H.M.Jr:
Louis Johnson will tell you, maybe.
Eccles:
No, I'll talk to Woodring, I guess.
H.M.Jr:
No, Johnson is chairman of that.
Bccles:
Yes, I see. It isn't really a War Department thing,
it's a special committee, isn't it? He simply heads
up the committee.
H.M.Jr:
That's right.
Any other thing? Anything else on bottlenecks?
All right, that sounds encouraging.
Eccles:
We're going to study this, the question of bottlenecks,
in housing, in the construction field. We haven't
anything on it yet, but it's something that I think
we ougnt to begin to think about; because you can't
get anywhere near a normal volume of construction
Regraded Uclassified
136
-35-
without running into bottlenecks at least in the
labor field.
McR:
Skilled labor.
Eccles:
That's right. Unless the labor people are willing
to start letting apprentices in and increase the
number of people they will take into the unions
and not continue the cutting of hours, you will run
into bottlenecks in the construction field with
seven or eight million still unemployed.
+aylor:
Got them right now, haven't you?
Eccles:
Not yet; haven't got any bottlenecks yet.
H.M.Jr:
Well, Marriner, will you continue this stuff?
Eccles:
Oh yes, we'll continue it.
H.M.Jr:
All right. Now - is that all, Marriner?
Accles:
Yes, that'sall, all I have today.
H.M.Jr:
Well then, "Effect of budget items."
Ruml:
Following our meeting last time, Mr. Bell and I had
a conference. We had, if you recall, from each -
from the Treasury, from the Federal Reserve Board,
and from the Federal Reserve Bank of New York, a
rough classification of the various budget items in
terms of their effect on the national income.
Following this meeting that I had with Mr. Bell, I
had assigned to me a man from the New York Bank who
is here today conferring with one of Mr. Bell's men
on the accounting side. I have a preliminary report
from him - from the Federal Reserve Bank, and I think
that at our next meeting it's going to be possible
to get these concrete illustrations, Mr. Secretary,
that we're talking about.
And the way I'll set it up is this. I'm going to
try to take the 1937 budget and the 1938 budget, set
them up realistically from this point of view, and
see how they look. I don't know how they're going to
Regraded Uclassified
137
-36-
look, but the first stuff I've got makes me believe
it'll be some rather dramatic information.
H.M.Jr:
You mean you're going to give us some concrete
examples as to what equals X?
Ruml:
That's it exactly.
H.M.Jr:
And you're going to do that?
Ruml:
Mr. Bell and I are doing that; rather, our assistants.
Haas:
The coefficient effects are really important.
Auml:
That's right.
H.M.Jr:
But you're going to give me something to put my
teeth in.
Ruml:
Yes, sir.
Bell:
I didn't have anybody that was qualified to study
these expenditure figures as related to economic
conditions. I have plenty of people to explain
the classifications and get out any kind of state-
ment that's wanted. So Mr. Ruml asked Mr. Harrison
if he wouldn't loan Mr. Sanford for a week or so.
I think some of these classifications you could
probably argue about, and when you come to putting
them in different groups, it's just a matter of
opinion, and I think on the Federal Reserve set-up
probably the lines are pretty finely drawn. I
question whether you can separate payments to WPA
workers and compensation payments to veterans, or
even the salaries of Government employees. I think
that again that's just a matter of opinion, and if
you get together you'd probably have to - instead
of having five classifications maybe you'd have
three, something like that.
White:
These differences do exist, Mr. Secretary. It's
merely a question of arriving at a composite
estimate in which you can put in these various
classes what everybody reasonably agrees on, and
what remains is in the doubtful group. But the
mere fact that it may be difficult to allocate
Regraded Uclassified
138
-37-
particular expenditures merely means that more
study is called for, not that the classes do not
exist.
H.M.Jr:
All right; then we'll wait on that patiently, with
my tongue hanging out.
Ruml:
We're working on it.
H.M.Jr:
All right. I don't want to bite my tongue off.
"5- Effect of operations outside the budget."
Ruml:
Well, we have already discussed the railroad matter.
I don't know whether ...
White:
There's several others. There's the toll roads,
which has been brought to a - been pushed pretty
far, lot of work done. It's in the form of a
memorandum. I think it's probably too long to be
taken up this morning - been prepared - but we'll
have it next time.
H.M.Jr:
Can youget it down pretty brief?
White:
Canget it down for next time.
H.M.Jr:
President pulled a good one on Johnny Hanes. Hanes
came over with a sheet of paper about twice the
length of this, as to possible sources of tax revenue.
The President said, "Well, Johnny, I said - I hear
you've heard about it - I always insist on one page;
but what a page!" It was about twice as long as
this. He said, "That's a new one." Right?
Hanes:
That's right.
H.M.Jr:
So, Harry, if they can get it on a page ...
White:
They'll try.
H.M.Jr:
It doesn't have to be the standard size.
Now, "Flexibility - Income, Expenditures."
White:
There were two other - there were several other pro-
jects which will come along also in the same category;
but toll roads was most nearly completed.
Regraded Uclassified
139
-38-
Currie:
I've had the boys this week make a survey of exist-
ing possibilities without going into new activities,
which we have a report on.
H.M.Jr:
Well, may I just - I'll get it when you talk toll -
you (White) also talk toll bridges, of course?
White:
Yes, but that was outside of the present budget
set-up. Currie is now speaking of possibilities
within the present budget.
H.M.Jr:
All right, you got something on your mind?
Eccles:
Well, we've got a report. I don't know whether you
want to go into that or not. It's a preliminary
survey of the possible expenditures that can be
made outside the budget
H.M.Jr:
Well ...
White:
: . now included within the budget.
H.M.Jr:
Think we ought to do it or think I ought to read it,
Marriner?
Eccles:
It isn't long - a couple pages here.
Bell:
Let him hit the high spots.
Eccles:
Go ahead, Currie, hit the high spots. You can read
that, I think.
Currie:
This is really just a summary of a long memorandum
which contains the findings in very rough terms.
First finding is this: "Over $1 billion of guaranteed
debt might be substituted at any time for public debt,
if suitable administrative and legislative action
were taken." And then under that: "(a) The R.F.C.
has $600 million of borrowings from the Treasury which
it could retire by issuing its own lebentures."
H.M.Jr:
Well, that's in the works.
Taylor:
In process of being done.
Currie:
That requires no legislation.
Regraded Uclassified
140
-39-
"(b) If new legislation were enacted, enother one-
half billion dollars of direct public debt might be
retired by issuing guaranteed bonds against existing
assets. The R.F.C. might retire part of its capital
stock" - that is, its earned surplus, two hundred
million dollars - "and the HOLC might take over
shares of savings and loan associations owned by
the Treasury. Assets of the emergency crop loan
program, assets of the rural rehabilitation program
and assets that have been transferred to the U. S.
Maritime Commission might form the security for
issues of newly authorized bonds or notes of Federal
agencies. Any such immediate reduction of the public
debt would be at the expense of a corresponding te-
duction in läter years."
That's on what could be done in shifting at any
time. Now, if we had enabling legislation "II -
Expenditure programs now in existence or contem-
plated to the amount of some half billion dollars
a year might be financed without the use of direct
public debt, providing suitable administrative and
legislative action were taken.
"This conclusion rests on the following considerations:
"(a) A number of Federal corporate agencies, whose
capital stock is owned in whole or in part by the
Treasury, will automatically continue to make loans
largely without further use of the direct public
debt. Among these are the United States Housing
Authority, the Commodity Credit Corporation, the
Federal Home Loan Banks and the banks and corpora-
tions of the Farm Credit Administration. The one of
these which will clearly be expanding its assets
steadily is the United States Housing Authority; its
loans, to be financed with guaranteed bonds, may reach
a total of $150,000,000 by next June end may increase
by another $300,000,000 in the following fiscal year."
H.M.Jr:
Excuse me - get somebody, Marriner, to g ive you the
Treasury's position on United States Housing bonds.
Ask Wayne to give you that.
Eccles:
On the tax picture?
H.M.Jr:
The reason why we don't want them to sell the 90 percent
local is because they're totally tax-exempt; that's
Regraded Uclassified
141
-40-
the whole story.
Eccles:
I know that one.
Taylor:
There's another important reason.
H.M.Jr:
Will you give him that?
Taylor:
I'll give him a copy of the letter that wasn't sent.
H.M.Jr:
We wrote a letter, and Straus has asked us not to
send it until we can think of something better.
That'll be the best way.
Currie:
"(b) If the R.F.C. undertakes to finance all its
further loans by issuing guaranteed notes, a loan
expansion which might amount to anything from
$50,000,000 to $250,000,000 could be financed
without instead of with the use of direct public
debt. This would include loans to municipalities
in connection with the P.W.A. program, loans to
railroads, loans to public utilities, and loans
through the R.F.C.'s subsidiaries, the Export-
Import Bank, the R.F.C. Mortgage Company and the
Federal National Mortgage Association.
(c) If suitable legislation were enacted, certain
other expenditure programs already in existence,
which may run from $100,000,000 to $200,000,000 a
year, might be financed without instead of with the
use of direct public credit. The most promising
of these programs for this purpose include Rural
Electrification loans (now financed partly through
the R.F.C.), F.C.A. emergency crop loans, Bankhead-
Jones farm tenant loans, Farm Security Administration
rural rehabilitation loans, and U. S. Maritime
Commission ship construction.
"III - The possibilities of shifting any substantial
part of current budgetary expenditures to self-
financing agencies appear limited. However, an
extension of certain activities of the Government
through self-financing corporations would lessen
the necessity for other large and continuing budget-
ary expenditures such as work relief and public works.
Thus a shift of certain existing programs to a self-
financing basis plus an extension of Government
Regraded Uclassified
142
-41-
activities that could be so financed would permit,
either directly or indirectly, a budgetary balance
to be attained more quickly, yet with no more danger,
than is now possible."
H.M.Jr:
Can I have that?
Currie:
Yes. (Hands memorandum to H.M.Jr)
Taylor:
We've got a lot of work done that's corollary to
that.
H.M.Jr:
I know; this is not so easy.
Eccles:
Well, this is just a preliminary sketch of it; and
each of these would require a good deal of thought
and study, and we just got a lot of this stuff in
the mill, so that
...
H.M.Jr:
Well, without handing this committee any bouquets,
I think if the work last spring had been done in
this very careful manner - I don't think the Presi-
dent and Bell and Hanes and I would be having such
a headache now about the unexpended funds which are
going to be carried over to next year and what the
hell we're going to do about it. I mean that's the
thing that's the headache now - when you see the
money which was voted and isn't going to be spent
this year.
Eccles:
No timing. I say the timing was terrible, wasn't it?
H.M.Jr:
What?
Bell:
If this is going to be done
H.M.Jr:
Well, the timing, yes - 24 hours - huh?
Eccles:
Yes.
H.M.Jr:
24 hours.
Eccles:
You appropriated this money last year with the idea
of having it expended, and it was done in a way that
it isn't expended, and therefore it didn't work out
in accordance with the timing schedule.
Regraded Uclassified
143
-42-
S.M.Jr:
And that was my fight which I lost.
You (Ruml) want to say something?
Ruml:
No.
H.M.Jr:
Bell?
Bell:
Just going to say, if these suggestions of Currie's
are going to be adopted, we certainly would want to
follow literally the Commodity Credit set-up, because
you've got many organizations in there whose assets
you cannot carry on the balance sheet at full face
value, and you'd have to write off some of them e very
year, and those write-offs ought to appear in the
budget as expenditures, just the same as the losses
of Commodity Credit.
Taylor:
Should be done anyhow.
Bell:
Yes, of course, it should be done anyhow. Today
they are carried as expenditures. Take the crop
loans; you only collect an a verage of 65 percent
of face value, and you lose interest on all your
loans at the same time. Same way with your
tenant loans; have to write off every year, it
seems to me, at least 35 percent of them, to
keep your budget on an even keel. Otherwise,
ten years from now you're going to have to write
off a whole lot
bocles:
But if each of these outfits were put on their
own feet, with the idea they'dhave to try to
operate and collect - and to the extent they
couldn't, then naturally it's a loss and it would
have to come out of the budget. But you'd know
each year just what it was and it wouldn't come
all at once, like it does now; it would come at
the time the loss was incurred.
McH:
The selling point to Congress, I think, Marriner,
will be the very fact that under the Commodity
Credit form of set-up you've got to go back to
Congress every year to make up your losses, so
Congress is really passing on it and it becomes
B. budget expenditure. Perfectly sound.
Regraded Uclassified
144
-43-
H.M.Jr:
Naster, will you have 8 copy made of this memorandum
and give it to the people here who are not connected
with the Federal Reserve. Ne can do it.
Currie:
I have three more here.
H.M.Jr:
Well, that would be enough. Mr. Ruml hasn't got
one.
"uml:
I should like one very much.
H.M.Jr:
Give Mr. Ruml one.
Does that finish that, on this timing?
riuml;
The flexibility matter - I think Mr. Haas has had
some conversations with Mr. Oliphant.
Haas:
The question was raised at the last meeting whether
the President could be given power by Congress to
lower taxes or possibly raise taxes, whether or
not it would be constitutional for Congress to grant
such power to the President. I talked to Oliphant
about it and Oliphant says, yes - they couldn't -
the Congress - could be worked out this way: that
they couldn't grant the President power to raise
taxes, but Congress could put it this way, that
under a specified condition the President would be
instructed by Congress to raise or lower taxes. And
then all the President would have to do is to make
a fact-finding as described in the act. In other
words, I mean - take a simple case: say the index
went - or some index or some condition exists, and
the President would have an investigation made, and
he says, "I find this condition exists." Well then,
once he finds that that condition exists, he's
obliged to make a change in the tax, up or down,
depending on how the statute is written.
And Mr. Ruml is interested in having concrete examples
worked out, and he suggests that we take this question
of Social Security payroll taxes, which are automati-
cally expected to rise. And I'll see if Herman can
do that, have it in the next meeting, if they're
interested.
H.m.-r:
Yes. Good.
Regraded Uclassified
145
-44-
Ruml:
On the expenditure side it is important, I think,
that pretty soon a determination be made - I talked
to Mr. Bell about this last time - as to a method
of getting the engineering planning done on a lot
of small projects. I think enormous effects can
be achieved there providing the planning is done;
but it's a question of some administrative determina-
tion as to how the set-up of that kind of thing should
be done.
H.M.Jr:
We McReynolds). have an administrative expert here (nodding at
Bell:
The National Resources Board has just come out with
a very large volume of public works, both large
and small, I think. of course, the plans haven't
been drawn, but there are suggestions for public
works, and the different departments could do some
preliminary work on planning.
Ruml:
There are really great opportunities
....
H.M.Jr:
Well, what'll we do with that, Dan?
Bell:
I should suppose that was a study for the National
Resources Committee. And the contacts with the
administrative officers
Ruml:
You mean make some proposal as to how it should be
done.
Bell:
Keep in touch with it.
Ruml:
I don't-think the Resources Committee ought to do
the planning.
Bell:
I don't either.
Ruml:
But we might make an administrative suggestion in
two weeks, Mr. Secretary.
H.M.Jr:
Well, I just want to say one thing, see whether
you're all in agreement. Now, the President has,
so to speak, launched this publicly. Naturally,
the newspaper men and the columnists and letter-
writers and everybody else are going to buzz everybody
as to what we're doing. I think as far as we're
Regraded Uclassified
245
-45-
concerned, if you people agree, that we oughtn't
to tell them anything; and when we do decide
something, that we take it over everybody's signa-
ture to the President for his use and disposal, and
that pending what he wants to do with it, we'll
simply tell the newspapermen and so forth and
SO on, "I'm very sorry, we're doing this for the
President; if and when we have something, we'll
send it over, and it's up to him to do what he
wants with it."
Becles:
We've told everyone that has made any inquiry that
you were the Chairman of the committee and if there
was anything to be said or given out, they'd have
to look to you for it.
H.d.Jr:
Well - well, I'm not going to give out anything.
Lecles:
and you can tell them that it will have to be given
to the President then.
H.M.Jr:
I'm going to tell them this is the President's
committee and enything we do here, if we come to
an agreement or find any recommendations, will be
over all our signatures; it will go to him and
it's his property, White House property. I mean
I'm not going to tell anybody anything.
Lecles:
Well, I think that - I think that's right. As El
matter of fact, I don't know right now what the
dickens you could tell them. It's one of those
things that's in the process of development, and
the less said the better.
B.W.Jr;
But they've been doing a lot of buzzing, a lot of
burrowing; I think we've all got to keep a united
front and tell them nothing.
If there's nothing else, I just wanted to say this,
which is & little bit outside; I just wanted to give
you a little of the headache that Bell and I have.
It's fiscal and monetary in the sense that it might
be quite a shock, but it's the President's business
also. But it's in the offing and we're doing every-
thing Bell and I can possibly do; but we're worried
like hell. AS I say, if what we've been talking about
147
-46-
before is confidential, this is triple-confidential.
Bell and I on October 10th asked Aubrey Williams to
come over with his finance officer, and at that
time we drew his attention to the fact that they
were spending more money than Congress had allotted
to them. The way the bill was originally written,
they were allotted money for seven months. They
asked for money for eight months and they compro-
mised by giving them 175 million dollars which could
be spent if the President declared a national emer-
gency.
We pointed out to Aubrey Williams - Hopkins, as far
BS we knew, was not in town, although we subsequently
learned he was in town; we didn't know about it -
that they were breaking the law; and we asked them
whether we should write a letter to the President
or they would, and they told us on that day - I've
got my notes all here - that they would notify the
President and that the letter had already been
written. And then Williams said, "Well, this is SO
important, I think we ought to see Mr. Hopkins,"
and we told them that any time Hopkins came over
we'd be delighted to see him.
And we had a long thing - and fortunately I had a
stenographer present - and both Bell and I warned
them that it was a very serious situation, they were
using - eating up this 175 million dollars illegally.
So Williams went over on the 13th, without Bell or
my knowing anything about it, and saw the President,
which was perfectly all right, and as a result of which
the papers the next day carried the statement "Roosevelt
Warns WPA To Stretch $700,000,000; He Tells Williams
Funds Must Last Until the First of March." And then
Williams made a statement as follows: "The President
told me that the balance at hand will have to last
until March first,' - "said Mr. Williams, discount-
ing persistent rumors that Congress" so forth end
so on.
Well, again feeling that Bell and I - our obligations -
we brought it to the President's attention, I think,
at least three times, that each successive week to
this statement, the WPA rolls went up, and in a
manner which I don't know - I don't know how they
did it - the WPA rolls for the next month were never
released to the public; the figures were never given
out, they were suppressed. And when this thing came
Regraded Uclassified
148
-47-
up again last week - Bell is charged with the
responsibility - you stop me any time, you tell
me He's charged with the responsibility of
apportioning this money.
Bell:
Go ahead, you're right.
H.M.Jr:
And, for instance, for November, Hopkins only
asked for 125 million - is that right?
Bell:
For the month of November he put down as a figure
or obligations 123 million dollars.
H.M.Jr:
And you said you know damn well he'd spend 200.
Bell:
That's right. I refused to approve that apportion-
ment.
H.M.Jr:
Bell has a legal or moral - I guess legal responsi-
bility.
Bell:
That's right, it's legal.
H.M.Jr:
And I have none other than my interest in the whole
picture, particularly the unemployed. And the situa-
tion that we have arrived at is that the President
has refused point blank to sign this, declare a
national emergency, and he says he won't do it, as
a result of which Hopkins told him Friday that he's
going to lay them off.
Now, we've made a rough estimate, Bell and I, that
if he does lay them off it means he's got to lay
off a million people - now! And Bell and I have
done everything possible - I mean our record - thank
God, I've got the whole thing here in the book, it's
all there - we've done everything, we've gone the
limit - I mean other than being discourteous, and
it's a matter strictly between Hopkins and the
President and the Director of the Budget.
But I wanted - not that there's anything anybody
can do, but you're meeting here, discussing fiscal
and monetary matters, and here this thing is in the
offing. And I say if the other stuff is confiden-
tial, this is triple-confidential. I just want to
let you know. And have I told the story accurately,
Bell?
Regraded Uclassified
149
-48-
Bell:
Yes, very well.
H.M.Jr:
Do you want - is there anything .... ?
Bell:
An excellent job.
H.M.Jr:
I mean have I minimized or exaggerated?
Bell:
No, sir.
H.M.Jr:
John, you've been in on some of this.
Hanes:
That's just exactly what's happened.
H.M.Jr:
What?
Hanes:
You're right. Just exactly what's happened.
H.M.Jr:
I just - all I'm trying to do is, I want you to
know so that you don't say, "Well, for heaven's
sakes, why didn't Morgenthau tell us about this,
why doesn't he have confidence in us?" I mean
the possibility of such a thing would so disrupt
the national economy, I think, and I hesitated -
I felt either we're partners or we're not partners,
and I figure we're partners, so I'm telling you this
terrible story. And Dan and I have just absolutely
gone the limit; and the President Friday told him in
my presence at Cabinet, "I will not sign that thing."
Eccles:
Well, does that - does it mean that Hopkins has spent
so much
....
H.M.Jr:
Do you mind directing it to Bell?
Eccles:
Yes - that Hopkins has spent so much money now in
the past that in order for him to come within the
funds available, he has either - he's got to cut it
down from now until the first of March, say, a
million people, or the President has got to sign
this, declare an emergency and make available this
175 million?
Bell:
That's right.
Ruml:
And has he until the first of March to get the million
off or must the million go off on the first of
December?
150
-49-
Bell:
Must go off very quickly.
McR:
Today.
Bell:
If he carries on his present rolls, he'll be out
of money by January 1.
White:
How much will that 175 million take care of, Danny,
if that were signed?
Bell:
Well, the 175 million would take care of about - the
whole 1939 program was based on an average of
2,800,000 people at about 175 million dollars a
month, see?
White:
DO that even if the emergency is declared, he still
is behind.
Bell:
He is still behind a little, but if the emergency
is declared and if he reduces his rolls probably
five or six hundred thousand - these are very rough
figures - he probably could get by to January 31.
White:
If he reduced them now by five hundred thousand at
once.
Bell:
At the time we had our conference with the President,
I believe that if Hopkins had stopped taking on
additional employees and just allowed the turnover
to reduce his rolls gradually, he could have gotten
by January 31 with 175 million dollars. But the
President would have had to declare an emergency.
And the reason the Secretary and I took it up with
him - one of the reasons was that we thought if the
President had to declare an emergency, that the
emergency was in July, August, and September, and
not in January and February.
H.M.Jr:
He could have tied it up with the New England flood.
Bell:
That was the time he should have declared the emer-
gency.
Accles:
He could, of course, now say that because of the
flood and other conditions, why, they're going to
run short after all.
Bell:
Everybody's forgotten about the flood, of course.
Regraded Uclassified
151
-50-
Currie:
Actually this is going to create an emergency.
Eccles:
Well, this is & matter - when you talk about
timing, this goes right square to the heart of
the thing.
H.M.Jr:
You fellows don't know what Dan and I have gone
through here in five years and why I'm an old
man. I mean it's things like this that Just make
you - aside from everything else, makes your heart
bleed. I mean it's just - it's just the human
beings at stake - I mean forget the economy of
the country and everything else. And I've got the
record here, and nobody, without being disrespectful,
could go further than I have - I mean without being -
to the President, I mean.
Eccles:
The railroads won't need any equipment and the auto-
mobile business will be on the - just let this thing
start down now, which it well can do, because between
now and spring is a crucial time; it is always a time
when the unemployment problem is the greatest, even
in normal times, and to accentuate that right now, it
seems to me, would be just criminal. We can lose all
the effect of what has been spent for the last six
months through this bad timing.
White:
Picking a million men off the rolls
Eccles:
I think if the President's appointed this committee,
that he should be - we should make a special report
on this particular situation. I'd like to get into
the record on it.
H.M.Jr:
Well, I'm open to any suggestions. I'm open to any
suggestions. Aren't you, Dan?
Bell:
Yes, sir. I think aside from all the points that Mr.
Eccles raises, I don't believe the President can
order a million men off the rolls, with winter start-
ing, from the human side of it. You can't do it.
H.M.Jr:
Well, again without wanting to be disrespectful, I've
seen him before talk about getting his Dutch up,
because he is Dutch, and I don't know why - I don't
understand it. After that meeting Hopkins was at -
immediately after that - let's see if my records are
Regraded Uclassified
152
-51-
right: following this meeting, Hopkins spent a full
week with him at Hyde Park - a full week. He lived
at his house for a full week, so there was ample time
to discuss the thing. I mean they were together -
they were together for a full week, and - but as I
say, if anybody has any idea
White:
Isn't there an alternative course of action that this
committee might attempt to devise, which might take
the form of speeding up expenditures to a very large
amount during the next few months, and make it possible
for him not to declare an emergency and yet not have
that increased unemployment. I don't know, but it
appears to me this would be an appropriate committee
to examine the possibilities in that direction.
H.M.Jr:
Harry, this is like so many Treasury problems; we've
got a pistol at our head. This is a 24-hour thing;
I don't know when Harry's going to move on it.
"uml:
Mr. Secretary, I take it some items were appropriated
by wongress which have not been spent - is that
correct - some things that didn't get started ES fest
as was intended?
H.M.Jr:
Oh well, I'm not telling anything, Dan, when I say
there's 60 percent of the Ickes money been carried
over to the next fiscal year.
Bell:
AS cash I think that's proximately right.
B.V.Jr:
60 percent of the Ickes money will not be spent this
year. It may be 55 or 65, but roughly 60 percent of
the money given to Ickes will not be spent in this
fiscal year.
Auml:
Well, isn't then that the real problem of finding
& psychological way of making the term "emergency"
palatable? And I wonder whether the emergency
doesn't arise due to the failure of these human
plans, like many others, to balance out exactly
the way tney were intended.
H.2.Jr:
You mean you want to get out and say that because
Mr. Ickes didn't spend his money as usual, we'll
declare a national emergency or national holiday?
duml:
That's the fact.
Regraded Uclassified
153
-52-
H.M.J.:
Well, Christ, that's what I went through last year.
The statement I made last spring was that Ickes was
a damn good honest jockey, but he's come in last
every year for five years, and why put your money
on him?
Ruml:
It simply occurred to me that the speed with which
something has to be done is so great that you can't
develop an alternative program, and that if some way
can be found to indicate that at this time we find
that the balance as between one item and another
recommended last April was not arithmetically correct,
and therefore this thing is
...
H.M.Jr:
All right, I'll tell you, maybe out of my telling,
my confession, maybe we could give him a letter and
let him hang it on us as an excuse for declaring it.
I mean we give him the reason. "Based on the recom-
mendation of my fiscal and monetary committee, who
advise me as follows, I hereby declare a national
emergency."
Ruml:
We could point out the unbalance of the whole program.
H.M.Jr:
I'm willing to be the
Eccles:
Yes.
Ruml:
We could point out that some of the items have not
been spent, others have been spent.
White:
Make a very strong supporting letter which would
follow that.
H.M.Jr:
If we did this, I wouldn't want anybody to know about
it who is not in the room. I don't want anybody not
in the room now to know a single thought about it.
What do you think about that, Dan?
Bell:
I think that's all right.
H.M.Jrt
But you fellows better come back at 4:30; I mean this
isn't something that can hang fire. This isn't some-
thing ....
Eccles:
We better take responsibility for advising him on it.
He just told the world he's appointed us, and it would
Regraded Uclassified
154
-53-
be a fine thing to have this - within thirty days
after he appoints this committee, to have things
bogging down.
H.M.Jr:
Well, maybe out of this, as I say, we could draw
up a recommendation, say, "This has been brought to
our attention and we feel that in view of the fol-
lowing facts you shoulddeclare a national emergency,"
and then give him a draft of a letter which he could
use.
Taylor:
And give him a couple charts.
H.M.Jr:
Well, whatever you want. But when does he get to Warm
Springs?
Dell:
Tomorrow night, I think.
H.M.Jr:
(On phone) Ask Secret Service when the President
arrives at Warm Springs, please. Let me know right
away.
White:
Certainly be fitting for this committee to make a
recommendation; in fact, one could go further and say
it would be very derelict in its duty if it didn't make
the recommendation.
&ccles:
That's right.
H.M.Jr:
Up to this point Danny and I have done everything
we could do without being disrespectful. We couldn't
go any further. And we've worked out, as I say, with
Williams - Hopkins didn't see fit to come to see us -
and with the President; but we have at least three
times subsequently to that shown the President the
increase in the rolls each week.
McR:
The one thing you overlooked in telling the story is
that WPA hadn't said anything to the President about
the necessity for declaring a national emergency, when
you had that first meeting.
H.M.Jr:
That's right.
McR:
The only condition or the only - the thing that made
them decide that they would tell him was because the
Regraded Uclassified
155
-54-
boss sat here and dictated a letter to the President
in which he was telling him himself; then they said,
"I guess we better tell him."
H.M.Jr:
That's right; in other words, we forced the issue.
Nobody could have done more than Dan and I have done.
And not that we want to make a record, if you know -
it's a hell of B lot of difference - we're not trying
to make a record, we've been trying to accomplish
something.
Bell:
"ell, we weren't trying to force Harry Hopkins to
throw off a million men. Don't get that impression.
What we were trying to do was keep the President's
skirts clear and not wait until February to declare
an emergency that happened in July and August, which
I don't think he could have put across with Congress.
H.M.Jr:
Well, if the President declares a national emergency
now, Dan, that gives Hopkins a chance to go up the
first ten days in January and get 900 million dollars,
whatever he needs, to carry on for the balance of the
year. It can be done in an orderly way, without dis-
rupting the national economy. Lacking the President's
doing that, it's just going to be hell.
Bell:
This has got to go up in the first deficiency bill
and get through by the end of January.
H.M.Jr ;
Well, if you gentlemen would be willing to drop the
stuff and - I don't know how you're fixed for the
rest of the day, but I'm available at 4:30; I'm
tied up until then. And see what you can do.
How you fixed, John?
Hanes:
I've got a meeting with Guy and his staff at four
o'clock. Tied up until four.
H.M.Jr:
Until four?
Hanes:
Yes, and then I've got a meeting with him and his
staff; probably take three quarters of an hour.
H.M.Jr:
I think this is important enough to postpone it.
I'd like you to sit in on it.
156
-55-
Hanes:
All right.
H.M.Jr:
I think this is our first real challenge; I think we
ought to try to meet it. I mean I'd like to go to
bed tonight feeling, "Well, I've taken another step
in trying to stop this thing from happening." And
I think that this is important enough that
....
Well now, how will we do this thing?
Bell:
Mr. Secretary, if I may make a suggestion, I might
do some work on the figures between now and, say,
3:30, g etting BS accurate figures as we can together
showing just how much money they will need for the next
three or four months and the number of people that
we'll take care of; and we could meet in my office
at - say, at 3 or 3:30 and we could discuss it for
anhour.
White:
We could in the interim draft a letter, Mr. Secretary,
if you want to appoint a small committee to meet with
me.
Bell:
An hour and a half before your 4:30.
H.M.Jr:
Excuse me.
(On phone) Hello. - When? - At 8 o'clock this
evening. - Atlanta at 8 o'clock, tonight. -
Well then, find out from the White House when does
the pouch go down, will you? And also find - there
used to be a train that left here for Atlanta at 7;
also the planes - when are there planes, see? -
Yes, when are there passenger planes to Atlanta.
And send that up on a piece of paper. When does the
pouch leave and when are there passenger planes on
a 24-hour basis to Atlanta? - Please.
Well, you (Bell) say you'll be ready by 3:30.
Bell:
I think I will. I might be ready by 3 if I rush a
little.
H.M.Jr:
Why not say 3 and meet in your office at 37 Which
one of your many offices?
157
-56-
Bell:
Budget - better room.
H.M.Jr:
3 o'clock; then you start at 3 to draft the letter.
White:
Does it have to be ready at 4:30?
H.M.Jr:
I think SO.
White:
Well, if the letter has to be ready at 4:30, I think
some of us could work on the general body of the
letter.
Bell:
I couldn't work on a letter between that time ...
H.M.Jr:
Are you available, Marriner?
Eccles:
Yes; I'll want
....
H.M.Jr:
Do you want to take some of these boys to your office
and work on a letter?
Eccles:
I'll be glad to do it.
H.M.Jr:
Or how do you want it?
Eccles:
Somebody suggested some charts here. Seems to me
that might be ...
Taylor:
This bubble chart that you've been using is very
important in that. You don't have to use the
bubbles, but you can do it as applied to only cer-
tain expenditures, showing that.
H.M.Jr:
Excuse me - couldn't you just walk across the
street to Hanes' office and then decide how you'll
divide this up? Is that all right?
Eccles:
Then we meet here at 4:30.
H.M.Jr:
Yes. May I say again, except for the people in the
room, I don't want anybody on anybody's staff to know
about it, see? But if you want to draw Herbert
Gaston in, it will be all right.
Regraded
November n, 1930.
158
RAILHOAD EQUIPMENT - A POSSIBLE BOTTLENNCE
Under the topic "Bottlenscks" a study has been initiated of the
ability of the railroads to handle the penk loads of prosperous years.
AB 8 result of the preliminary survey, certain tentative conclusions
emerge, which, If borne out by more intensive study, appear to be
highly significent. Although attention has been mostly directed toward
freight cars, it 1s believed thet the findings apply to other types of
equipment.
1. It is estimated that to handle the volume of pank traffie
coveequent upon full recovery within, say, three years, total car
requirements would have to approximate 2,000,000 cars. In contrest
with this, the total number of cars on hand at the present time is
nome 1,700,000, indicating a shortage of 300,000 cars. Adding retire-
ments, the total requirements for new cars would amount to about 600,000
units in three years, or approximately 200,000 per year.
2. If we assume a sufficient degree of recovery by 1940 to repre-
sent about the scare degree of utilization of our plant capacity in
general as prevailed throughout the twenties, which would correspond
with a Federal Reserve Board index of production of between 125 and 130,
total car requirements would amount to 1,900,000. Teking retirements
et about 100,000 per year, this would call for total new car construe-
tion of 400,000 in two years.
Regraded
Uclassified
159
5, to the extent to which new care produced in 1959 fall
short of 200,000, requirements in 1940, to headle the assumed
volume of peak traffic, would have to be correspondingly higher
than 200,000.
4, The maximum number of new care produced in any one year
was 150,000 in 1925. This suggests that the capacity in the car
making field may be inadequate to handle the volume of possible
new requirements. Further study is necessary to verify this indi-
cation.
5. The name general conclusions apply to other types of
equipment. Thus, under the first assumption of full recovery in
three years, annual new locomotive requirements would emount to
3,400 lecomotives,
6. Construction activity in new equipment of this magnitude
would require a total annual outlay of approximately $600,000,000.
7. In view of the financial condition of the reilroads, and
the tendency for orders to be postponed until absolutely necessary,
it appears unlikely that expenditures for new equipment of such
magnitude will be undertaken in the near future.
8. Assuming, therefore, the continuence of recovery at a
desirable rate, there appears to be a very distinct possibility of
a shortage of equipment in 1940, of a bottloneck in equipment making
capacity, and of a comparatively sudden and relatively large demand
for steal from the reilroads superimposed on what are likely to
be heavy demande from other industries.
Regraded Uclassified
November 21, 1938. 160
A PHELIMINARY SURVEY OF EXISTING EXPENDITURE PROGRAMS
WHICH ARE BEING FINANCED WITHOUT USE OF DIRECT PUBLIC DEBT,
OR WHICH MICHT HE 80 FINANCED.
p.238 of original n
Findings
I - Over #1 billion of guaranteed debt might be substituted at
my
any time for public debt, if suitable administrative and legislative
action were taken.
(a) the R. F. c. has $800 million of borrowings from the
Treasury which it could retire by issuing its own debentures.
This requires no legislation.
(b) If new legislation were enacted, another one-half billion
dollars of direct public debt might be retired by issuing guaran-
teed bonds against existing assets. The R. F. C. might retire part
of its capital stock and the HOLO might take over shares of savings
end loan associations owned by the Treasury. Assets of the emergency
crop loan program, assets of the rural rehabilitation program and
assets that have been transferred to the U. 8. Maritime Commission
might form the security for issues of newly authorized bonds 02
notes of Federal agencies. Any such immediate reduction of the
public debt would be at the expense of a corresponding reduction
to later general
II - Expenditure programs now in existence or contemplated to the
amount of some half billion dollars a year might be financed without
the use of direct public debt, providing suitable administrative and
legislative action were taken,
This conclusion rests on the following considerations:
Regraded Uclassified
181
(a) A number of Federal corporate agencies, whose capital
stock 18 owned in whole or in part by the Treasury, will automati-
sally continue to make loans largely without further use of the direct
public debt. Among these are the United States Housing Authority, the
Commodity Credit Corporation, the Federal Home Loan Banks and the banks
and corporations of the Farm Credit Administration. The one of these
which will clearly be expanding its assets steadily is the United
States Housing Authority: its loans, to be finenced with guaranteed
bonds, any reach a total of $150,000,000 by next June and may increase
by another $300,000,000 in the following fiscal year.
(b) If the R. F. C. underteken to finance all its further
loans by issuing guaranteed notes, 6. 10-m expansion which might amount
to anything from $50,000,000 to $250,000,000 could be financed without
instead of with the use of direct public debt. This would include
loans to municipalities in connection with the P. W. A. program, loens
to railroads, loans to public utilities, and loans through the R. P. 0.'s
subsidiaries, the Export-Import Bank, the R, 7. C. Mortgage Company
and the Federal National Mortgage Association.
(e) If suitable legislation were enacted, certain other ex-
penditure programs already in existence, which may run from $100,000,000
to $200,000,000 a year, might be financed without instead of with the
use of direct public debt. The most promising of these programs for
this purpose include Rural Electrification loans (now financed partly
through the R, 7. C.). P. C. M emergency crop leans, Bankhead-Jones
form tenant leans, Farm Security Administration rural rehabilitation
Regraded Uclassified
162
leans and U. 8. Maritime Commission ship construction.
III - The possibilities of shifting any substantial part of
current budgetary expenditures to self-financing agencies appear
limited. However, an extension of certain activities of the Govern-
ment through self-fimancing corporations would lessen the necessity
for other large and continuing budgetary expenditures such as work
relief and public works. Thus a shift of certain existing programs
to a self-financing basis plus an extension of Government activities
that could be 80 financed would permit, either directly or indirectly,
a budgetary balance to be attained more quickly, yet with no more
danger, than 16 now possible.
Regraded Uclassified
163
THE HAY-ADAMS HOUSE
HAKADAMS HOUSE
WASHINGTON, D.C.
ALL BED ROOMS
AIR CONDITIONED
next Meeting
Reports of Progress.
/, National Income X Budget
Treasury
2. Potential Income
3. Bottle necks
4. Effect of Budget Items
5. Effect of operations outside
the Budget
6. Flexibility - Income
Expenditures
7. Timing
Regraded Uclassified
184
MEETING OF FISCAL AND MONETARY ADVISORY
November 21, 1938.
BOARD (re possible WPA lay-offs)
4:50 p.m.
Present:
Mr. Eccles
Mr. Ruml
Mr. Bell
Mr. Hopkins
Mr. Hanes
Mr. Taylor
Mr. White
Mr. Currie
Mr. Oliphant
H.M.Jr:
I had a minute to explain to Mr. Hopkins that in
the meeting of our Fiscal and Monetary Committee
this morning I brought to you gentlemen's attention
in utmost confidence the fact that on Friday the
President said that he would not sign... - is Dan
here? Where's Dan?
White:
He just stepped out.
H.M.Jr:
Well, he knows what I'm saying.
(Bell comes back)
I was saying that I told these people in the utmost
confidence that as of Friday the President said he
would not sign & document declaring a national
emergency and making this 175 million dollars avail-
able, as a result of which this new-born committee
felt that if we were going to do anything and had
the possibilities of a million men being laid off
the next week or two, there wasn't much use dis-
cussing anything either fiscal or monetary. So I
asked them if they wouldn't draw up a document that
we could send down to the President, which all of
us can sign, recommending that he should sign
this. And inasmuch as you're (Hopkins) the patient,
I felt that before we performed an operation on you,
at least we'd show you the diagnosis.
I haven't seen this yet; I'll read it out loud. Is
that right?
"My dear Mr. President:
"The Acting Director of the Budget..." - and before
I start, is everybody here in agreement on this?
Anybody?
Regraded Uclassified
1C5
-2-
Eccles:
Well, we're in es full agreement as we could be on a
tentative basis. It was decided that we wouldn't
want to put our signature to it at the moment and
send it down tonight. It's too important. It's a
matter that might have to be deferred. Herman can
explain some reasons for that as well.
H.M.Jr:
All right. "The Acting Director of the Budget at
the meeting of the Fiscal and Monetary Advisory
Board on November 21, 1938, presented material to
the Board which related to the program of W.P.A.
expenditures scheduled for the next three months."
Now, why do you do it that way? He didn't do it; I
did it.
Bell:
Well, I suppose they have a reason for that.
Taylor:
He's supposed to have done it.
H.a.Jr:
It's not factual; it's not factual. Is this the
way you (Bell) want it?
Bell:
I didn't know why they did it. I was working on
sometning else. But I assumed they had a very good
reason for doing it: that it's my r esponsibility under
the Act to apportion the funds and it was my duty to
bring the situation to the attention of the President
and next, I suppose, to you. I'd just as soon turn
it around the other way.
H.M.Jr:
Well, I always think that the best way to do it is
to do it the way it happened.
Bell:
O.K. by me.
H.M.Jr:
I never like to dress up my cenery.
Bell:
It's all right by me. I thought they had a particu-
lar reason for doing it.
H.M.Jr:
I always think it's much better to tell the thing
the way it happened.
Bell:
It can very properly come from the Chairman of this
Committee.
Auml:
Chairman of the Board.
Regraded Uclassified
106
-3-
Eccles:
There was no discussion on that, I don't think.
Don't think it makes any difference. Merely a
question of the reason for the consideration.
B.V.Jr:
Then we'll say "The Secretary of the Treasury."
That's the way it happened.
"The Secretary of the Treasury at a meeting of
the Fiscal and Monetary Advlsory Board on November
21, 1938, presented material to the Board which
related to the program of W.P.A. expenditures
scheduled for the next three months.
"The Board, on the basis of the information pre-
sented to it and of study of work relief requirements
for the next three months in relation to the general
business situation, recommends that if possible you
make available the $175 million of additional funds
for work relief purposes by the authority vested in
you in accordance with the provisions of the Emer-
gency Relief Appropriation Act of 1938."
Now if I was saying this I'd recommend - I'd leave
out "If possible." Either we're going to do it
or we aren't.
Accles:
Well, there's a question
...
Aylor:
Legal reason.
H.M.Jr:
Well then, why write the letter? Why write the
letter?
Bell:
Mr. Secretary, the question raised in the meeting
was as to whether this Committee as suca should
pass on a legal matter that's going to the President.
H.M.Jr:
I wouldn't send it unless it's all right. I never
wrote a letter to the President recommending "if
possible, you should do 50 and so." Either recom-
mend it or not recommend it.
Eccles:
We'd be assuming the question of passing upon
whether or not it's possible. Now, we don't -
we're speaking of it from an economic point of
view. Now, if from an economic point of view it
ought to be done if it can be done, as to whether
it can be done from the legal point of view we don't
Regraded Uclassified
167
know.
H.V.Jr:
Well, if you don't mind, I know my President and
I'm not going to put my name to this thing unless
I can say, "I recommend that you make available."
I'm not going to say, "I recommend that if possible
you make available." I mean immediately I put &
doubt in his mind. I mean if there is some doubt -
now, I had three minutes with Harry Hopkins and I
said, "There is some legal doubt, Hanes tells me."
He said, "Well, our shop has no legal doubts."
I mean I'd rather hold the thing until there is no
doubt.
Oliphant:
well, all the discussion - none of the discussion
W&S in terms of the legal doubt. I think Ruml
pointed out that since this is the first action on
the part of the Committee, the Committee wanted to
be very careful as a committee of not stepping
outside of its bailiwick.
Ruml:
Mr. Secretary, it seemed to me that the President
had access to counsel as to the legality of this
thing; the Fiscal and Monetary Advisory Board can
only speak on the monetary aspects of the thing.
On those we are clear, but we can't presume to
search out counsel to advise him on the legality
of the matter.
H.w.Jr:
I still get back - if I'm going to sign that thing,
I'm going to say "recommend you make available" and
not "recommend, if possible, you make available."
I won't sign it.
Taylor:
Don't think that would be impossible.
White:
The assumption is the Secretary of the Treasury
should have obtained such counsel as is necessary
in order for him to make sure it is possible; that
1f it wasn't possible he should have ascertained
that aheed of time.
Ruml:
I assumed there will be some statement that goes to
him from another source that will refer to the law
and what can be done; but I - and I
Uclassified
168
-5-
B.M.Jr:
Well, the normal thing, the way that's done - and
Hopkins and Bell can check me on this thing, see,
I'm doing my home work right before you - is that
that statement, I think, would go from the Director
of the Budget, wouldn't it? Wouldn't you send him
a statement declaring a national emergency? Doesn't
that go from you, then - first from you to Mr. Hull
for his stamp? Doesn't it go down in that way?
Bell:
If it's in the form of an Executive Order, yes.
But we've been discussing another form here and
it might be a letter from the President to me, which
certainly could be drawn in the Bureau of the Budget,
with the help of proper counsel.
H.M.Jr:
Let me just check with Hopkins. If Hopkins tells
me we've got another 24 hours on it, I'd stop right
here and give these boys another 24 hours, because
I'm not going to send one of these "Maybe you can
and maybe you can't letters. It's too important;
I want to make a positive statement or keep my mouth
shut. Can you (Hopkins) wait another 24 hours?
Hopkins:
I have no intention of firing that many people.
H.M.Jr:
What?
Hopkins:
I have no intention of firing a million people off
the WPA pay-roll. I'm going down to talk to the
President about it, talk it over with him. I'm
sure he's - any judgment he's made has been made
on some very bad advice and on inconsiderate evidence,
and I want to discuss it with him.
H.M.Jr:
You're not going down tonight?
Hopkins:
I'm not going down until he gets rested, gets a lot
of sleep, and is feeling good.
H.M.Jr:
Then by holding this another 24 hours
Hopkins:
Isn't anybody going to go off that pay-roll by holding
it another 24 hours.
H.M.Jr:
Then I'm going to say this: " recommends that you
make available the $175 million of additional funds
for work relief purposes by the authority vested in
you in accordance with the provisions of the
Regraded Uclassified
189
-6-
Emergency Relief Appropriation Act of 1938.
"When in the Spring of 1938 you recommended to
Congress the comprehensive recovery legislation
of which the appropriation for work relief formed
an important part, the possibility was envisaged
by Congress that a situation might arise which
would call for expenditures beyond those anticipated
at this time.
"Although there has been a marked increase in indus-
trial production
"
Bell:
"
at that time."
H.M.Jr:
"Although there has been a marked increase in
industrial production
11
Bell:
If
would call for expenditures beyond those antici-
pated at that time. "
H.M.Jr:
"
anticipated at this time, it says.
White:
" at that time."
H.M.Jr:
"Although there has been a marked increase in indus-
trial production, and, we believe, a sound foundation
for the continuance of recovery has been established,
nevertheless the level of unemployment remains higher
than was anticipated. It has naturally been extremely
difficult to accurately determine when work on the
heavier type of projects represented by the public
works and public housing programs could become fully
effective."
Now, don't protest too loudly at this time, Harry,
that at this point
Hopkins:
I don't protest. I hope you send it.
H.M.Jr:
I thought you might not like that sentence.
"Likewise, the New England hurricane not only has
dislocated industrial production over a wide ares
with its attendant effects on normal employment, but
also has imposed additional burdens on the Works
Progress Administration. In addition, private
re-employment was further retarded by the depressing
Regraded Uclassified
170
-7-
effects on American trade and industry of the
extremely critical international political situa-
tion. Finally, there has been an unforeseen degree
of lag in relief requirements behind the turn of
industrial production."
"Finally, there has been an unforeseen degree of
lag in relief requirements behind the turn of
industrial production." What does that sentence
mean? "Finally, there has been an unforeseen
degree of lag in relief requirements
"
White:
In other words, the upturn in employment was not
nearly as large as one would expect.
H.M.Jr:
Well, that doesn't say that, Harry.
Currie:
I think part of his thought was that normally the
experience of WPA has been that there is a lag in
requirements behind business activity; but this
time there's an unforeseen larger degree of lag.
H.M.Jr:
This says the opposite.
Oliphant:
That it goes up with recovery in private re-employment.
H.M.Jr:
Say, "There has been an unforeseen lag in private
employment," not "in relief requirements." Do you
mind?
Currie:
Well, the turn in relief requirements usually comes
after you've turned upward in production.
H.M.Jr:
Do you mind my using - as the President says, the
man on the street doesn't understand that. You
economists may, but I don't. What you're saying
is that private employment hasn't kept pace with
business recovery. Isn't that what you want to say
for me?
Taylor:
He wanted to say something else.
Currie:
We're trying, Mr. Secretary, to say something more
than that.
H.M.Jr:
Well, it has to be clarified. I don't think this
says what you have in mind.
Regraded Uclassified
171
-8-
Currie:
We can clarify it.
H.M.Jr:
"A combination of these circumstances has thrown a
preponderant share of the recovery burden on the
W.P.A. portion of the program during the last five
months.'
That's all right.
"Since it was necessary to meet these unforeseen
demands it would be necessary to cut the W.P.A.
rolls by almost one million if we are to remain
within the appropriation made by Congress for the
first seven months of the fiscal year."
"Since it was necessary to meet these unforeseen
demands it would be necessary to cut the W.P.A.
rolls by almost one million if we are to remain
within the appropriation made by Congress for
the first seven months of the fiscal year. "
"Since it was necessary to meet..." - it would be
necessary to cut them now. Want to leave out the
time?
Taylor:
I think if you insert to read like this: "Since
it was necessary to meet these unforeseen demands
we understand that it would now be necessary.. "
H.M.Jr:
Yes. Say that again, Wayne.
Taylor:
"Since it was necessary to meet these unforeseen
demands, we understand that
11
H.M.Jr:
If
we understand that ff
Taylor:
"
that it would now be necessary
"
H.M.Jr:
"
it would now be necessary
fl
Taylor:
"
now be necessary ff
H.M.Jr:
n
now be necessary to cut the W.P.A. rolls by
almost one million if we are to remain within the
appropriation made by Congress for the first seven
months of the fiscal year."
Is that all right with you (Eccles)? We'll all have
time, Marriner, to do this again tomorrow.
Regraded Uclassified
172
-9-
Eccles:
That's all right. This has no critical - in fact,
we haven't been over it since it was finally written.
H.M.Jr:
If you don't - I mean I want you to have all the time
you want; I want an equal amount. But we couldn't
take it in its present form.
Bell:
Is that figure about right, Harry?
Hopkins:
What figure do you mean?
Bell:
A million people, if you're going to live within
the appropriation.
Hopkins:
(Nods yes)
Bell:
That's about right?
Hopkins:
Close enough. The language isn't accurate in several
other spots there, but it isn't important; we're going
to live within the appropriation.
H.A.Jr:
How?
Hopkins:
Why not?
Oliphant:
He means if pursuant to the appropriation you leclare
the emergency.
Hopkins:
In the letter you assume we aren't living within the
appropriation. We are completely living within the
appropriation, under my proposal. That's a matter
that isn't important, though.
Oliphant:
Should you say "such a drastic.. "?
H.M.Jr:
What?
Oliphant:
11 such a drastic"? Could cut out the ....
Taylor:
Don't need the word "such." Just "drastic curtail-
ment."
H.M.Jr:
"... would be extremely unwise from the standpoint
of continued recovery."
"It is our opinion that a drastic curtailment of
the relief rolls at this time would be extremely
unwise from the standpoint of continued recovery.
Regraded Uclassified
173
-10-
"It is essential that an increase in consumption
be maintained if recovery is to continue. A
drastic reduction in work relief expenditures will
tend to depress consumption."
Well, I think you're getting into - both those
paragraphs, I think, could be left out. I think
you're arguing too much now, but - I mean I - like
my father always said, when you've won your case,
quit.
"In view of the foregoing
....
" - I question those
two paragraphs. I question those two paragraphs.
I think that's throwing in a little extra.
"In view of the foregoing the Fiscal and Monetary
Advisory Board feels that, from the standpoint of
a proper timing of government expenditures with
the requirements of the general economic situation,
it would be exceedingly unwise to cut work elief
expenditures drastically at this time."
Well now, gentlemen, as far as I'm concerned, I'd
be willing to sign that as it is written, with a
few modifications anybody wanted to make. Let me
just - but we wouldn't be ready tonight. You won't
be ready tonight.
Hopkins:
It doesn't need to go tonight.
H.M.Jr:
Let me cut - I've got a whole chain arranged for
McKay to go down
(on phone) Lieutenant McKay, please.
(McKay comes in)
H.M.Jr:
Mac, you're not going down tonight.
McKay:
Thank you.
H.M.Jr:
Will you undo everything - Bob McHugh, Assistant
Chief Murphy - undo everything, will you? Have a
good sleep.
Regraded Iclassified
174
-11-
McKay:
All right, sir. Thank you. (Leaves)
H.M.Jr:
Well now, gentlemen, it's 5:20, and why don't we
tackle this thing again tomorrow? And then when
we got the thing a little bit more polished, maybe
Mr. Hopkins would come over again.
Hopkins:
Glad to.
H.K.Jr:
Why not? Hopkins is going to lunch with me tomorrow
at one o'clock. Then why don't we meet at 2 o'clock
or, say, 2:15, and maybe we can go into this thing
then.
Eccles:
Not meet again in the morning, then.
H.M.Jr:
Unless you and your people want to meet.
Eccles:
"hat's your situation, Beardsley?
Ruml:
I'm going back to New York for dinner tonight. I
could come back on the over-night train, if you think
it's important, but it would seem to me that with
the thing in this form it's a question of getting
the correct phraseology and being sure Mr. Oliphant
is satisfied.
H.M.Jr:
I think you've been extremely helpful today, and
when we get this thing fixed up the boys can read
it to you over the telephone. I don't like to
ride a willing horse to death. No, I don't think
it's - I mean
....
Ruml:
I'll be glad to come if you think it's necessary.
H.M.Jr:
No, I think not. You've got time, if you've got
your bag. Have you?
Ruml:
Everything is ready.
H.M.Jr:
The thing, as it is here now, which is, as far as
you're (Hopkins) concerned, would you say ....
Hopkins:
Fine.
H.M.Jr:
... 95 percent ...
Regraded Uclassified
175
-12-
Hopkins:
You're a big help to me.
H.M.Jr:
What?
Hopkins:
Fine.
H.M.Jr:
Well, there you are. Now, Hopkins, could you turn
over to Oliphant whoever has told you that it's
legally possible?
Hopkins:
Surely.
H.M.Jr:
What?
Hopkins:
Surely. Could he get in touch with Herman at 9
tomorrow morning?
Hanes:
Shouldn't we correct those few errors that Harry
Hopkins
Hopkins:
Somebody ought to work on it.
Hanes:
things in there that are not correct?
H.M.Jr:
I don't want it rewritten.
Hopkins:
Suits me. I'm not worried about that.
H.M.Jr:
I question the paragraph "It is our opinion that
such a drastic curtailment of the relief rolls at
this time would be extremely unwise from the stand-
point of continued recovery." And "It is essential
that an increase in consumption
If
-
those two
paragraphs are repetitious.
Taylor:
You can cut them out, because you say that practically
in the last paragraph.
H.M.Jr:
Well now, Dan, could you at 2:15 - could you all
come in here with an airtight thing that you feel -
if it's possible to have an sirtight thing - that
we can send down to the President in final form?
We'll argue about it at 2:15. But in the first
place, I think it's up to us in the room here to
give him something which will S tand up legally, so
it really is between you and Oliphant and somebody
to represent Hopkins. He says he's got somebody he
can throw in?
Regraded Uclassified
176
-13-
Eccles:
Well, does Harry
Hopkins:
Tomorrow morning.
H.M.Jr:
what?
Hopkins:
Tomorrow morning.
Eccles:
I'd like to ask Harry a question. Does he figure
that this 175 million is available now without
further action?
Hopkins:
Requires some action of the President.
Eccles:
Yes.
Hopkins:
Oh yes.
Accles:
Your program is on the assumption that he will make
that available.
Hopkins:
That's right, and that if he made that available,
our dollar expenditures per month for December,
January, and February would drop something over
seven million or eight million dollars, so in the
month of February you'd spend 23 or 24 million
dollars less than we spend in the month, say, of
November.
Eccles:
Yes, but I think Dan
Bell:
That's right.
Eccles:
estimated that - that's assuming this is made
available.
Hopkins:
The reason this is important for this committee to
consider - Congress has already made available three
billion dollars, and they're going to have to make
available an emergency deficit for us of X amount.
Up to the first of November, with the cash going out
of the Treasury of those two amounts, for Public Works
and for ourselves, 780 million dollars in check were
drawn out of the Treasury for the WPA and 5 million
dollars in checks were drawn out of the Treasury for
PWA.
Bell:
That's right.
Regraded Uclassified
177
-14-
Hopkins:
NOW, if that has B monetary effect you can readily
see that one of the things this committee ought to
know is how fast the dollars are going out of the
Treasury on the heavy stuff. You know that no matter
what you do, our plan is to drop - no matter, under
any circumstances, we drop in WPA a minimum of 7
million dollars a month, each month; so in three
months that would be 21 million dollars plus, under
any circumstances.
Now, if your committee, then, were to go one step
further, instead of generalizing about this, and
say that if you didn't have to consider the problem
of unemployment relief, you weren't considering that
problem, but that here is the curve that you'd like
to see go, approximately, of dollars each month, out
of the Treasury; then talk to us as to whether it
would be possible, between Ickes and myself and
others that have Government funds that they can
control to some extent - incidentally, mine are
about the only funds that are now controllable,
because the rest of it is now tied up in contracts -
B.8 to whether we could adjust our problem so that
it would substantially fit the theoretical curve
that you people would lay out.
Now, I don't know whether that's worth working out
or not, but we'd be glad to, if you thought that was
an interesting thing to nelp work with, to see to
what extent we could adapt our program to what you
think would be E. theoretically desirable thing in
terms of dollars going out of the Treasury, projected,
let's say, eight months shead, a year abead.
H.K.Jr:
But not in this letter.
Hopkins:
No, I'm thinking of something else.
Becles:
I think the thing Harry is talking about is absolutely
essential, but not in this thing.
Hopkins:
No, but as B long-range planning.
Taylor:
That's what your committee is supposed to be doing.
H.M.Jr:
That's what they're supposed to be doing.
accles:
that's the heart of the job.
Regraded Uclassified
178
-15-
Hopkins:
of course, the realities of the thing - I mean as
far as the next eight months is concerned, the only
outfit in the Government that's got any control over
real dollars - the rest of them, you can make them
for a few millions, but not any real money; isn't
that right, Dan?
Bell:
That's right.
Hopkins:
I'm perfectly frank in telling you now that we're -
just in theory, now, without ever having submitted
it to the Budget or ever having its approval, the
thing looks like a drop of a minimum of 7, and it
might run up as high as 10 million a month drop right
up to the end of the fiscal year.
Bell:
Is that a normal turnover, Harry?
Hopkins:
No, that's being pretty tough with it. That's being
pretty tough with it.
Bell:
You're not actually letting anybody 80, but those
are the people that are leaving voluntarily.
Hopkins:
We don't make any replacements right now.
Bell:
That's what I mean.
Hopkins:
That catches about a hundred thousand people a month.
Oliphant:
How much in dollars?
Hopkins:
That's about 7 million dollars a month.
Eccles:
That's cumulative, isn't it? I mean 7 million a
month
Hopkins:
That's right. Three months is 21 million a month.
White:
Doesn't make any provision for the seasonal unemploy-
ment.
Hopkins:
Well, the curve would be in our favor next spring;
we'd get a sharper drop in the spring than in winter-
time. But I think in the winter-time, if we don't
take anybody in, which is going to be a tough thing
Regraded Uclassified
179
-16-
for us to hold, we'll get at least 8 hundred thousand
a month off the WPA during the winter months.
Bell:
Runs about five percent a month when you're on such
a high level.
Hopkins:
Well, if we get five percent & month, we'll get more
than that.
Eccles:
You said from now until - the balance of the fiscal
year - next July, Harry, that your expenditure would
continue to drop at this rate.
Hopkins:
Oh, under the thing - the curves we've got in our
office - now, this is irrespective of what money we
got or what Congress or the President will do - we'd
be spending in the month of June next year about
125 or 130 million dollars a month, which is in
round figures 50 to 60 million a month less than
we are spending now. Our figures don't always run
uniform each month.
Bell:
That's about two million people.
H.M.Jr:
Yes.
Hopkins:
It will be right there about the first of July.
Eccles:
That will depend on what - if Congress should give
you more money, if the situation was such you needed
more. You're just assuming, however, that they don't
give you more; then you're estimating
Hopkins:
What you've got to do, your committee has got to do -
Ickes got a billion and a helf, I got a billion and
a half plus whatever I'm going to get until July first,
and that total is so much money and that's what the
two of us spend. Now, what you going to spend next,
what should you spend
H.M.Jr:
Harry, I admit I'm all in. I'd like to take this
up tomorrow afternoon. I'm going to pin this on you,
Johnny Banes. You're (Hopkins) lunching with me at
one o'clock. Then 2:15. And Johnny Hanes is carry-
ing the ball for me tomorrow morning. Huh?
Oliphant:
Will you tell your folks, Harry, to call me?
Regraded Uclassified
180
-17-
Hopkins:
I'll call before I leave.
H.M.Jr:
Harry, everybody in this room is pledged to secrecy.
Hopkins:
Yes, I think it's important that there be no implica-
tion that a million people are going to be dropped
from WPA.
Regraded Uclassified
181
by dear Nr. Presidents
the
Servy Acting the Treasured
at
the
meeting
of
the
Fiscal
and Monetary Advisory Heard as November 21, 1938, presented material
to the Roard which related to the program of W.P.A. expenditures
scheduled for the next three menths.
The Foard, on the basis of the information presented to it and
of study of work relief requirements for the next three senthe in
relation to the general business situation, recommends that -
rithts you make available the $175 million of additional funds for
work relief purposes to the authority vested in you in accordance with
the provisions of the Emergency Relief Appropriation Act of 1 938.
When in the Spring of 1938 you recomended to Congress the compre-
lensive recovery legislation of which the expropriation for work
relief formed an important part, the posmibility was envisaged by
Congress that a situation might arise which would call for expendi-
that
tures beyond these anticipated at time.
Although there has been a marked increase in industrial produe-
tion, and, we belief, a sound foundation for the continuance of no-
covery has been established, nevertheless the level of unemployment
remains higher than was anticipated. It has naturally been
extremely difficult to ac urately determine when work on the heavier
type of projecte represented by the public works and public housing
programs could become fully effective. Idkewise, the New England
burricane not only has disleested industrial production over a wide
area with its attendent effects on normal employment, but also has
Regraded Uclassified
182
- 2 -
imposed additional bardens an the Works Progress Administration. In
addition, private re-employment was further retarded by the depressing
effects on American trade and industry of the extremely critical
international political situation. Finally, there has been an
unforeseen degree of lag in relief requirements behind the turn of
industrial production. A combination of these circumstances has
thrown a preponderent share of the recovery burden on the W.P.A.
portion of the program during the last five months.
m understand
Since it was necessary to meet there unforessen demands it would
now be nocessary to out the W.P.A. rolls by almost one million If W are
to remain within the appropriation made by Congress for the first
seven months. of the fiscal year.
It is our opinion that such a drastic curtailment of the relief
rolle at this time would be extrasely unwise from the standpoint of
continued recovery.
It is essential that an increase in consumption be maintained if
recovery is to continue. A drastic reduction in work relief expendi-
tures will tend to depress consumption.
In view of the foregoing the Fiscal and Monetery Advisory Board
feels that, from the standpoint of a proper timing of government -
penditures with the requirements of the general economic situation,
it would be exceedingly unsice to cut work relief expenditures dresti-
cally at this time.
183
its dear Mr. President:
The Secretary of the Treasury at the meeting of the Fiscal and
Monotary Marisory Board on November 21, 1938, presented material to
the Board which related to the program of V. 3. A. expenditures
scheduled for the next three months.
is pointed out that in the spring of 1938 when you recomented
40 Congress comprehensive recovery legislation of which the eypro-
printion for work relief formed a important part, the possibility
vas envisaged by Congress that a situation might arise which would
call for expenditures beyond those anticipated at that time, and
therefore provided for an additional $175 million to be utilized If
necessary.
Although there has been a marked increase in industrial produc-
tion, and, W believe, a sound foundation for the continuance of
recovery has been established, novertholess the level of unemployment
remains higher than w anticipated. It was naturally very difficult
to predetermine sccurately then expenditures on the heavier type of
projects represented " the public works and public housing programs
would become fully effective. To find that from July FW9 1st to November
18th,1938, the total withdrawal from the Treasury Y & was only
$34 million. In this case period withdrawal w U. S. Reasing Authority
was less than 44 million.
In addition to the foregoing, the New Ingland inrricans dislocated
industrial preduction over a wide area and also imposed additional
burdens es the Werks Progress Administration. Private re-employment
Regraded Uclassified
- 2 -
164
has home and is being further retarded w the depressing effects on
incriess trade and industry of the extremely critical international
political situation. Finally, there has been as ususual lag in private
employment despite the sharp increase is industrial production. A
combination of these eirematances has thrown & preponderant share of
the recevery burden ca the W. 7. A. porties of the recovery program
during the last five months. The total expenditure W this agency
during the period amounted to approximately $682 million.
It world now be necessary to out the W. P. & relle w almost
one million workers if we are to remain within the appropriation made
by Congress for the first cover months of the fiscal year. Therefore,
the Fiscal and Monotary Advisory hard recommends that you nake
available the $175 million of additional funds for work relief purposes
by the authority vested is you in accordance with the provisions of
the Energency Relief Appropriation Act of 1938.
Faithfully,
7. 8. Appended are two charte showing the lag in private employment
dempite sharp increase is industrial production.
Chart 1 - Industrial Production ml Total Non-Agrieul bural
Employment.
Chart 2 - Total Labor Supply - Not Classified w Regular
Employment, Emergency Employment and Unexployment.
Regraded Uclassified
185
My dear Mr. Presidents
Regraded Uclassified
The Secretary of the Treasury at the meeting of the Fiscal and Benetary
Advisory Board on November n, 1938, presented material to the Board which
related to the program of the Works Progress Administration expenditures
scheduled for the next three months.
He pointed out that in the spring of 1938 when you recomended to Goog-
ress comprehensive recovery legialation of which the appropriation for work
relief formed an important part, the possibility was envisaged by Congress
that 4 situation might arise which would call for expenditures beyond those
anticipated at that time.
Although there has been 8 marked increase in industrial production,
and, we believe, a sound foundation for the continuence of recovery has
been established, nevertheless the level of unexployment remains higher
than was anticipated. It was naturally very difficult to predatermine 40-
curately when expenditures on the heavier type of projects represented by
the public works and public housing programs would become fully effective.
We find that from July 1st to November 18, 1938, the total withdrawal from
the Treasury by the 0. S. Housing Authority was less than 04 million and
by the Public Works Administration less than 834 million. Thereas, the
total withdrawal by the N. P. 4. for the same period amounted to approxi=
sately $882 million,
In addition to the foregoing, the lieu England hurricane dialocated
industrial production over a visa area and also imposed additional burd-
one on the Works Progress Administration. Private re-employment has
been and is being further retarded by the depressing effects as incri-
can trede and industry of the extremely critical international
186
- 2 -
political situstion. Finally, there has been an umanticipated lag in
private employment despite the sharp increase in industrial production.
A combination of these circumstaness has thrown most of the recovery
burden on the N. P. 4. portion of the recovery program during the last
five months.
It would now be necessary to cut the w. P. 4. rolls by almost clib
million workers if we are to remain within the apportionments of funds
by months hitherto made pursuant to the Emergency Relief Appropriation
Act of 1938. Moreovers
Therefore, the Fiscal and
Monetary Advisory Board respectfully recomends that you both release
all present reserves and also modify the apportionments by months hither-
to made by reducing the period of apportionment from eight to DETER months.
Faithfully,
P. 8. Appended are two charts showing the leg in private explayment dear.
pite sharp increase in injustrial production.
Chart 1 - Industrial Production end Total Non-Agricultural
Employment.
Chart 2 - Total Labor Supply - - Classified by Regular
Employment, Emergency Employment and Unexployment.
Regraded Uclassified
187
my dest yr. Presidents
The ceretary of the Treasury at the meeting of the Fiscal and
Yonetery dvisory loard en Seventer 21, 1930, presented material to the
heard which related to the program of V. F. A+ expenditures scheduled for
the next three sonths.
4 pointed out that in the Spring of 1938 when you recomended to
Congress comprehensive recovery legislation of which the appropriation
for work relief formed an important part, the possibility vse envisaged
by Congress that a situation might arise which would call for expenditures
beyond there anticipated at that time.
'Ithough there has been a marked increase in industrial production,
and, et believe, a sound foundation for the continuance of recovery bas
been antablished, nevertheless the level of unemployment remains higher
than vas anticipated. It was naturally very difficult to predetermine 40-
curately when expenditures on the heavier type of projects represented by
The public works and public housing programs would become fully effective.
le find that from July let to November 18, 1938, the total withdrawal free
the reasury by the U. E. Housing authority was less than 14 million and
to the ublie Forks Administration under the program authorised by the
Margeney Relief Appropriation let of 1938, exclusive of Federal projects, of
about 80 villion dollars, of which only 34 million was withdrawn under the
1938 Pelief et. Theress, the total withdrawal by the Borks Progress Admin-
istration anounted to appreximately $882 million.
In addition to the foregoing, the New England burricane dislocated
industrial production over a wide area and also Imposed additional burdens
- the forks Progress Adm nistration. Private re-employment has been
and to being further retarded by the depressin effects on American
trade and industry of the extremely critical international
Regraded Uclassified
188
GROUP MEETING
November 21, 1938.
9:30 A. M.
Present:
Mr. Oliphant
Mr. Gaston
Mr. Haas
Mr. Hanes
Mr. Taylor
Mr. Duffield
Mr. Lochhead
Mr. White
Mr. Gibbons
Mr. McReynolds
Mrs. Klotz
H.M.Jr:
Mac?
McReynolds:
(Nods "Nothing.")
H.M.Jr:
I haven't had time to get down to earth.
McReynolds:
Nothing.
H.M.Jr:
Good morning. How's sterling?
Lochhead:
Well, it's shaded off a little bit since the time
you spoke last; it is now about 4.694 - 4.70;
apparently not much excitement in the market, but
a little pressure. Had no further cables since
the earlier one.
H.M.Jr:
Well, I'll try to do my home work on sterling
today; I'll get an hour and I'll read that stuff.
We'll see how it goes along.
Lochhead:
Knoke is back; I had him in my office this morning.
H.M.Jr:
You're going to turn him over to the White House?
Lochhead:
(Nods "Yes.")
H.M.Jr:
Work out a very definite schedule for him.
(Nods to Mr. Gibbons.)
Regraded Uclassified
189
- 2 -
Gibbons:
Nothing startling in mine.
H.M.Jr:
Harry?
White:
There was some information from Brazil last week
that they have renewed their compensation arrange-
ments with Germany, on a small scale, but they have
renewed it.
H.M.Jr:
The Brazilian Financial Attache, at my invitation,
is coming in at ten thirty tomorrow.
White:
We have had a proposal - what might be done for
Brazil, if you want to take a look at it.
H.M.Jr:
Supposing you boys come in at ten - Taylor, White,
and Archie.
White:
Oliphant's working on a particular
H.M.Jr:
I'll just take it in memorandum form, huh?
White:
Yes.
H.M.Jr:
All right.
Oliphant:
You know my slant on the thing, anyway.
H.M.Jr:
Yeah. If you want - you want to sit in at ten
o'clock?
Oliphant:
No, I don't think so.
H.M.Jr:
What?
Oliphant:
(Nods "No.")
H.M.Jr:
(Nods to Mr. Duffield.)
Duffield:
(Nods "Nothing.")
H.M.Jr:
(Nods to Mr. Hanes.)
Hanes:
Could I see you about five minutes? I've got some
matters in the Bureau I don't want to bring up here -
not important enough. I just want to hand you some
papers.
H.M.Jr:
Yeah. Well, how about - well
.....
Regraded Uclassified
190
- 3 -
Hanes:
Any time is all right; there's no hurry about
this; any time you want.
H.M.Jr:
Two forty-five?
Hanes:
0. K.
H.M.Jr:
Or have you got an appointment of your own?
Hanes:
No, I don't think I've got any. I'll let you
know if it isn't all right, but I am sure it is
all right.
H.M.Jr:
How is the game?
Hanes:
Pretty well.
H.M.Jr:
Outside or inside?
Hanes:
Both.
H.M.Jr:
Is that all?
Hanes:
Yes.
H.M.Jr:
Ah - Wayne?
Taylor:
We got a letter from the President on Saturday
about this stamped envelope problem, and so on -
the same thing arises there that did about
illustrating stamps themselves.
H.M.Jr:
Why did that go to you?
Taylor:
Well, it was just an accident.
H.M.Jr:
I'd already turned it over to Oliphant about
three days earlier. That fellow Clark was in here,
from the stock company.
Taylor:
Well, there was a letter that come through for
signature with an "Acting Secretary" stamp on it
and I signed it.
H.M.Jr:
Did you say he could or couldn't?
Taylor:
Did a little "weasel" wording on it.
Regraded Uclassified
191
- 4 -
H.M.Jr:
Well, let's see what Oliphant did on it.
Taylor:
It's being reconsidered, I understand, this morning.
Oliphant:
I understood that letter that came over from the
President, it went from you to Bernie, and Bernie
told me he was working on it and it will be ready
today.
Taylor:
That is right.
H.N.Jr:
That's all right; then we do work together.
Without knowing anything about the law, if you
can illustrate - take a stamp and illustrate 1t,
I don't see why you can't take a stamp on an
envelope and illustrate it.
Taylor:
It seems that way to me.
H.M.Jr:
Yeah.
What else, Wayne?
Taylor:
That's about the only one.
H.M.Jr:
If you've got anything on Brazil, you will let
me know, won't you?
Oliphant:
Would you mind reporting, Wayne, on the status
of that letter from the State Department we are
waiting on?
Taylor:
Hasn't it been received yet?
Oliphant:
No. On the German thing.
H.M.Jr:
I haven't received any answer.
Oliphant:
I haven't either.
Taylor:
The last I heard about it was that it was on
Secretary Hull's desk.
H.M.Jr:
That's the one they told Kieley that he had taken
it home with him.
Taylor:
I ran into him, Friday night I guess it was, at
dinner, and he said, "What more trouble is the
Treasury cooking up for me?" and I said I didn't
know of any.
Regraded Uclassified
192
- 5 -
H.M.Jr:
Who was this, Hull?
Taylor:
Yes. That may be what he was talking about, but
he wasn't very explicit.
on
H.M.Jr:
Well, that's all right. He jumped/Herbert Feis
because he said that there wasn't any - also on
Sayre.
Taylor:
On the lack of coordination or cooperation between
the two Departments. You see that letter that
Hull wrote me, which was written about the same
time I was talking to Sayre, was written by Feis,
and he didn't know that I'd talked to Sayre, and
he didn't know that Sayre talked to the British
Ambassador, and so, naturally, when Hull gets my
letter, sort of putting him on the spot, he
naturally was sore, and he wanted to know how come,
and so Feis jumps on Sayre. But the letter, you
see, that Feis wrote for Hull's signature, was
written just at the time I was talking to Sayre,
and he didn't know Sayre had sent us the memo,
and Feis didn't even know Sayre was talking to
the British Ambassador. If it enclosed a copy of
Sayre's conversation, which it did, he can
H.M.Jr:
We got Sayre's thing the day before.
Taylor:
Yes, but when Feis writes the letter for Hull's
signature, which mentions
H.M.Jr:
If I was in Hull's shoes, I'd be sore too; I mean
getting my letter. I refused to be on the spot,
so I put him on the spot, and the reason - he
never would have written the letter, I believe,
if Sayre and Feis had gotten together. Just passing
it along, as you are my contact. This is a State
Department matter. I'd be sore too - good and
plenty. But we'll wait until that letter - I am
not going to call up Mr. Hull any more; we called
him three weeks today; we called him three times
last week, and I spoke to Sayre last week at
lunch. I asked Sayre, where was that letter, and
he said it was on Mr. Hull's desk. Called the
man three times, and called the Assistant Secretary
one; that's about all. I'll wait.
Regraded Uclassified
193
- 6 -
Taylor:
I've gone on two or three scouting expeditions too.
H.M.Jr:
I can wait; I have too. I can wait.
George?
Haas:
I have a few regular things here.
H.M.Jr:
George, are you going to be ready at ten fifteen
to give us an example? I don't want to embarrass
you by asking.
Haas:
Well, that doesn't embarrass me.
H.M.Jr:
Well, hell, when are you going to be ready, George?
Haas:
When you left that you asked Bell to take the
three reports and see what he could find out,
and - ah - he has them. Bell has them. Now, as
to getting illustrations of Ruml's diagram, I
don't know if I ever can do that, and I am very
doubtful if anybody else can ever do it, and
Ruml doesn't - in my discussions with him, he
doesn't feel that you - now that you can
actually get an illustration, putting numbers on
them, SO the
H.M.Jr:
I thought you said last time that you could do
it, using this year's income.
Hass:
Not to conform with that table.
H.M.Jr:
Yes.
Haas:
No.
H.M.Jr:
What's the sense of the table? It's very
pretty to have examples of.
Baes:
It is his way of illustrating a theoretical point.
Sometimes, Mr. Secretary, you can know that such
a thing exists in a quantative way, but find it
is impossible to get an illustration. Another
thing that these numbers show - I am confident,
but there is disagreement among economists - on it
is that the numbers would change with the different
phases of business activities on the outside.
Regraded Uclassified
194
- 7 -
H.M.Jr:
I tell you, not to embarrass either you or
Ruml, suppose the two of you stay behind and I'll
see you both. It is terribly important; I don't
want to put either of you on the spot.
Haus:
It doesn't embarrass me, because I haven't
done anything about it, but I don't want to give
you something and have you think you've got some-
thing, and I feel confident you don't have anything.
H.M.Jr:
Tell the same thing to Ruml.
Hars:
I have. He told ne we should refrain from giving
you anything with numbers; I told him he didn't
have to worry about me, with that standing.
H.M.Jr:
The two of you stay behind today.
Haas:
I had a long talk with Curry. You asked ne to
go over that, and we are working
.....
H.M.Jr:
On my weekly business report?
Haas:
No, no; that material isn't the type of thing you
could put in your business report. As a matter
of fact, if you take it for what Curry would him-
self use it for, it is all very good, but those
figures Curry wouldn't publish; you see, it is
the very roughest figures, making approximations
to demonstrate a theory, and he wouldn't publish
them over his name, in the status they are in.
Maybe, sometime, with further improvement, he would
allow them to be published, but he told me, in the
present status he did not want to publish them.
I think that is one thing when you see charts -
whoever is presenting them. There are all kinds
of statistics, representing fact, and another
group that represents partly fact and partly
estimates; another group of statistics, like
Ruml had, are merely thoughts, quantities expressed,
and to put the three of them in the same category
is misleading. I don't think he intended to mis-
lead. They should be talked about; they should
explain what they are.
H.M.Jr:
Well - well, anyway
Regraded Uclassified
195
- 8 -
Haas:
I - I think - I mean, if I am doing it, I won't
give you anything unless I feel you can take it
anywhere you want to take it.
H.M.Jr:
I want to get out of the realm of theory so I can
show it to some other economists and let them
take a look at it. When we get this stuff, I
intend to show it to these other people - Viner
and Hanson, etc. I am not going off half-cocked
on this stuff. I haven't got anything to show to
anybody.
Heas:
I think the sooner, the better.
H.M.Jr:
I haven't got anything.
Haas:
You've got
..... Of course, I am not the one
to build up
.....
H.M.Jr:
All right. Well, you two fellows stay behind.
John, would you take this as a suggestion on
our tax forum. It may or may not be good. A
fellow that used to do some accounting for me
eight or ten years ago. (H.M.Jr. handed memo
to Mr. Hanes.)
Herbert?
Gaston:
I haven't anything this morning.
H.M.Jr:
I think the second article of Fortune on Government
bonds is going to be all right; it is all right.
(Nods to Mr. Gaston.)
Gaston:
(Nods "Nothing.")
H.M.Jr:
Well, the next thing is ten fifteen.
Oliphant:
(Nods "Nothing.")
Taylor:
Ten o'clock, you say?
H.M.Jr:
Ten fifteen.
Taylor:
I thought you said ten o'clock, Brazil.
H.M.Jr:
That's Tuesday.
Taylor:
Oh, Tuesday.
Regraded Uclassified
FOREIGN POLICY ASSOCIATION
196
Incorporated
NATIONAL HEADQUARTERS: 8 WEST 40th STREET, NEW YORK
Telephone: CHickering 4-6590
Cable Address: Forpolas
RAYMOND LESLIE BUELL
President
November 21, 1938
Honorable Henry Morgenthau
Department of the Treasury
Washington, D. C.
Dear Mr. Morgenthau:
In accordance with our conversation
on Friday, I am glad to send you a copy of some
private letters of Mr. Charles Thomson, a member
of our staff in Latin America.
Sincerely yours,
Raymond h. Puell
RLB:RR
encs.
Regraded Uclassified
Dishant Gaston
staad
Hones Taylor
Gibbons
Duffield white 197
Jochhesd
>
Bell
Note: One copy sent to
each of the above as per
H. S. K's instructions.
McH
Nov. 29/38
198
November 20, 1958.
Dear Mr. Buell:
It was very good of you to send - the copies
of the private letters from Mr. Charles Thomson, a
number of your staff. I have been met interested
is reading those and appreciate your sending them.
Sincerely,
in. 1 i I
President, Foreign Policy Association,
8 Best 40th Street,
New York, New York.
GEF/d.bs
Regraded Uclassified
199
NEWS LETTER ON PARAGUAY
Charles A. Thomson
Foreign Policy Association
Confidential
Buenos Aires
Not for Publication.
October 10, 1938
Thanks to the kindness of Ambassador Spruille Braden, I have
just witnessed the signing of the Chaco arbitral award, which de-
finitely fixes the boundary between Bolivia and Paraguay. The
ceremony was held under the white and gold magnificence of the
"salón de honor" in the Argentine Foreign Office. Thus, the road
to the long-sought peace is finally free of the last serious
hurdle. In passing, I might say that informed opinion generally
accords Spruille Braden major credit for the successful conclusion
which has happily crowned three years of delicate and arduous
negotiations.
During my recent visit to Paraguay, I found that country ready
to welcome the Chaco peace. The overwhelmingly favorable majority
in the plebiscite of August 10 surprised even the most experienced
political observers. Geronimo Zubizarreta, the Liberal leader who
had refused to sign the pact, found no support for his intransi-
gent position. The voting in the plebiscite seems to have been
essentially fair; it is reported that the government was prepared
to use pressure to secure a favorable result, but found that such
intervention would be superfluous. Opponents of the pence terms
had criticized most the failure to give Paraguay any share in the
alleged petroleum wealth along the western edgo of the Chaco.
Their chief complaint against the plebiscite W:15 that its phrasing
was loaded in favor of an affirmative vote. But they now appear
willing to accopt the popular decision, and declare that Paraguay
will loyally abide by the peace terms and that no subsequent govern-
ment will question their validity.
The war has mode the army the dominent factor in the country.
In the past, two major parties disputed control of Paraguay. At
the end of the disastrous Fivo Year's War with Argentina, Brazil
end Uruguay, a group of generols organized the Partido Nacional
Republicano, known as the Colorados. This party ruled for 34 years,
from 1870 to 1904. Meanwhile, civilian elements had formed the
Liberal Party, and this group, although plagued at times by fac-
tional strife, dominated the political scene from 1904 to 1936.
Foreign observers report that the Liberals are more blessed with
able and intelligent leaders than their traditional opponents.
In February 1936 the Liber president, Dr. Ausebio Ayala,
who had served throughout the wor, was overthrown by Colonel
Rafael Franco. The Franco movement was backed by restive ex-
service men - demobilized after fighting ended with the armistice
of June 1935 - by labor unions and by some students. These
elements considered the old parties discredited and sought a new
political and economic alignment. Moreover, Ayala's positi.
had been weakened, due to fears that he sought a second term,
Regraded Uclassified
200
and to the jealousy excited among military leaders by the special
favors heaped on General Estigarribia. Franco's regime made some
efforts at land distribution and put on the books several pieces
of social legislation, including establishment of a National De-
partment of Labor, with power to settle industrial disputes. But
politically his administration was a hybrid. Juan Stefanich, the
leading figure in the cabinet, was credited with semi-fascist
ideas and a nationalism which would return Paraguay to the dicta-
torial traditions of its first half century as a nation. Labor
and the students, on the other hand, had been influenced by com-
munist and socialist ideas. Franco failed to get his dissident
supporters to pull together, despite efforts to unite them in a
new party. He also proved unable to hold the entire support of
the army - whose war-time leader, General Estigarribia, he had
imprisoned - or to enlist the backing of the more solid and con-
servative civilian leaders. His government was overturned in
August 1937 by certain army officers, in alliance with the Liberal
politicians.
A provisional regime, headed by Felix Paiva, a professor,
was set up. But the civilians in the present government are de-
scribed as substantially "messenger boys" for the army officers,
who hold the actual reins of power. Four men particularly stand
out: Colonel hamon Paredes, a shrewd politician in uniform who
occupies the ranking cabinet post of Minister of the Interior;
Colonel Antola, commander-in-chief of the army; Major Arturo Bray,
half-English in blood, who fought with Britain's forces during the
World War, and who now is Chief if Police of Asuncion; and Major
Sosa Valdes, commander of three cavalry regiments. All of these
men are under 45 years of age. Their rule is in effect a mill-
tary dictatorship, which justifies itself on the ground that
Paraguay needs above all order and tranquillity. The press is
closely censured, and offending newspapers suspended. Many of
the most important opposition leaders are in exile. The relation
of this reigning quartette to General Estigarribia is not entirely
clear. Some observers believe that the "Four Horsemen" prefer to
keep Estigarribia in his present post in Washington, fearing that
if he returns to Paraguay, they will be eclipsed. Some sentiment
exists in the country for establishment of a strong nati nal
government, with Estigarribia at the head. On the other hand, it
is reported that Estigarribia himself would prefer not to take
office during this transitional period.
Army leaders declare that Paraguay is fundamentally 2 demo-
cratic country, and that their rule is temporary. Congressional
elections were held on September 25th. The Colorados withdrew
from the contest on August 31, charging lack of guarantees and
official pressure in favor of the liberals. In consequence, the
Liberals had no opposition and captured all seats in both houses.
Paraguay has a compulsory voting law, so the Colorados cast blank
ballots at the polls, whose number was reported to approximate
30% of the total 125,000 votes cast. Despite this none too en-
Regraded Uclassified
201
couraging venture toward democratic "normaley", hopes are expres-
sed that the convening of congress will permit civilian influences
gradually to reassert themselves, and that the process will be
continued by presidential elections next March. On the other hand,
some military leader may upset the apple-cart by another attempt
at dictatorship. The army, which is believed to number around
15,000 men, still consumes from 60 to 80 percent of the government
budget. The country's economic situation may decide the issue
between democracy and dictatorship.
Paraguay came out of the Chaco conflict with increased eco-
nomic strains; and this despite the fact that it fought the modern
world's most economical war. Paraguay ended the struggle wi thout
any major increase in its foreign debt, which now stands at
600,000 pounds sterling - for a nation of less than 1,000,000
people. Bankers estimate that the internal debt does not exceed
13,000,000 gold pesos (or about $9,000,000.). Service on the
foreign debt was suspended during the conflict, but both interest
and amortization payments have since been resumed. Food was not
rationed; agricultural production was markedly increased. Paraguay
now imposes no quotas on imports and only partial exchange control.
Government salaries are paid up to date. During the struggle the
common soldier was paid at the rote of one Paragusyan peso a day,
and the total per diem cost per man, including supplies and food
as well as pay, did not exceed, according to the Minister of War,
nine Paraguayan pesos. (The Paruguayan peso is now quoted at 70
to the Argentine peso, or approximately 280 to the dollar.)
How did Paraguay carry on its war-time financing, In addi-
tion to using its small gold reserve, it requisitioned the great
bulk of foreign exchange accruing from exports, paying exporters
its equivalent in paper pesos. With this exchange it purchased
what supplies were imported. The paper pesos were of course the
product of the printing press, and the result was serious infla-
tion, the peso declining from 19 to the Argentine peso to a ratio
of 90, before recovering to the present ratio of 70. Moreover,
the Government requisitioned annually from cattle-growers some
seven or eight percent of their herds, paying them in script,
which subsequently has been exchanged for gold peso bonds, and
was included in the figure for the internal debt just mentioned.
Local banks and business houses also made relntively small loans,
which in great part are reported to have been repaid.
Outside purchases of military supplies were cut to a minimum.
Paraguayan leaders declare that the country started the war with
an army of 3,000 men, of whom only 1,000 were in the Chaco. (Syme
informed sources, however, raise the 3,000 figure to 8,000.) It
had at the finish 80,000 to 100,000 men, but never any more than
25,000 in the front line. Officials state that foreign purchases
were principally rifle and machine-gun ammunition, some artillery
ammunition, and D. few planes, with ten the maximum number in active
service at any one time. They assert that Paraguay imported no
Regraded Uclassified
202
artillery, no hund-grenades, no airplane bombs. Supplies of the
last two items were supplied by a domestic war industry. The
hand-grenade became a very important weapon, the soldier often
preferring it to the rifle; production started at the rate of 30
8 day and finished at the rate of 130 an hour. Truck bodies at
the start were turned out at the rate of one every seven days; at
the end seven per hour. But the Paraguayans assert that their
best source of supplies was Bolivin, and that at the end of the
war 80 percent of their armament had been captured from the enemy,
including 40,000 rifles. They started the war with 44 pieces of
ortillery and finished with 66; yet, General Estigarribia told me
that for months at a time the artillery was silent for lack of
rummunition.
Paraguayan leaders are also united in denying that they re-
ceived any large-scale aid from Argentina. They assert that the
Buenos Aires government facilitated them no loan (although there
were some short-terms transactions with Argentine banks), or sup-
plied them with any munitions. However, when the League embargo
was on, Argentine officials are reported to have shut their eyes
to transit of European shipments up the Paraná River. The Para-
guayan army included a so-called Argentine regiment, but this was
recruited in the Argentine province of Formosa, which is largely
populated by Paraguayans. An Argentine military mission was sta-
tioned at Asuncion when the war broke out, but this was promptly
withdrawn. The Paraguayan army had the help of Ω few foreign
officers, including a number of White Russions, but only a handful
of Argentines. These Paragunyan denials, however, have not served
to convince some foreign observors of the entire absence of Argen-
tine assistance. Proof of this cooperation is lacking, but sus-
picion lingers. I pass these facts and figures on to you, for
what they are worth in our present state of knowledge.
It is largely true that Paraguay is a country of no statistics
and few definite facts. What you learn is always approximate,
nás 0 menos, more or less. Written sources are few, and verbal
statements need to be checked and re-checked. For example, take
the rise in the cost of living which the Chaco har and inflation
have brought to Paraguay. A leading lawyer told me that since
1932 it had gone up three times, reporting that he had to send his
servant to market with 600 Paraguayan pesos now instead of 200.
Then I came upon the manager of a foreign bank wrestling in his
office with a sheet of prices; the salary of his Paraguayan employees
shifts with the price level. He ventured with some caution that
the cost of living had gone up between 300 and 400 percent. Then
I talked with n group at the National Confederation of Labor who
asserted that the rise was 600 percent. I put it down as a
Paraguayan fact that the increase had been at least three-fold.
Regraded Uclassified
203
-5-
But wages have lagged behind, and consequently there is some
ground for discontent. The common laborer in town makes about 150
Paraguayan pesos a day, in the country about 100 (respectively
50 and 35 cents in U.S. currency). Wage figures furnished by labor
leaders indicate a general rise of from 200 to 250 percent from
1932 to the present. The labor movement claims some 25,000 members.
The strongest unions are found among the port workers and in build-
ing construction, packing houses, textile and shoe factories, and
on the railroads and street-cars. In 1931 the labor unions were
dissolved by the Guggiari government, but with the accession of
Colonel Franco in 1936, they came out again into the open; the
National Confederation of Labor was formed, and some gains were
made. Leaders now advocate a moderate policy and "democratic"
tendencies, and play down socialist and communist ideas, which in
the past had won some ground.
Nonetheless, the danger of "communism" is cited by the military
as justification for the present dictatorial government. It
serves equally well those Paraguayans - chiefly army officers and
war veterans - who think of themselves as fascist, and who organ-
ized the "Frente de Guerra". One colonel told me, "The officers
are fascist principally because they are opposed to communism,
which is the worst type of dictatorship; and in the past communist
ideas have been strong among the masses." The "Frente de Guerra"
has attacked both old parties, criticizes "sloppy" democracy, and
argues for nationalism and dictatorship. Opinions differ widely
as to how much real influence It has. Aside from the "Frente,"
it does not appear that Nazi and fascist influences have made much
dent. Some of the newspapers carry Italian and German propaganda;
both nationalities run schools in "suncion, but chiefly for their
own children, rather than the Paraguayans. The Franco government
ordered 36 airplanes from Italy - Caproni bombers and Fiat fight-
ers. The first shipment recently reached Asuncion, out has been
held in the customs until Paraguay was ready to make payment.
But now that the Chaco war is over, the government does not need
the planes, and is reported to be shopping around to find a
customer for these unwanted goods.
The most interesting foreign influence in Paraguay is that of
Argentina. There is no doubt that this "backwoods" republic,
which has been frontier country for three centuries, falls within
Argentina's economic empire. But this is not due primarily to
heavy investments of Buenos Aires capital. Argentines are the
largest landholders in the Chaco, but at that the worth of their
vast tracts probably does not exceed $6,000,000. Argentine capi-
tal is also reported in the railroads, and In the streetcars of
the capital. It also controls the Mihanovitch line, owning the
most important steamer fleet which links Asuncion with Buenos
Aires. And it is through control of communications that Argentina
has what some Paraguayans feel is a strangle-hold on their economic
Regraded Uclassified
204
-6-
life. For most of Paraguay's foreign trade goes down the river,
the greater part of it on Mihanovitch boats, and much of it is
transshipped at Buenos Aires. If Argentina closes its ports, as
happened a year ago when yellow fever was reported in Paraguay,
this inland republic is cut off from the world. Hence, the au-
thorities at Asuncion are playing with the idea of an outlet
through Brazil, either by a road via Iguassú to open up to tourist
traffic the famous falls there; or by extending the Concepcion-
Horqueta railroad line to the northeast to meet a similar pro-
jected line on the Brazilian side. But appealing as these projects
look on the map, their economic utility is highly dubious. I must,
however, say a word for the Iguassú Falls, which the guidebook
reports are higher than Niagara and half again as wide. I flew
over them on my way from Sao Paulo to Asuncion, and they are worth
going a long way to see.
In addition to military dominance and some economic disloca-
tion, the war has bequeathed Paraguay a new outlook on the future.
Captain Bozzano, Minister of War and graduate of M.I.T. at Boston
said to me: "Now a shadow of thirty years has been lifted. In
the past we have had our thoughts contered on R war which we knew
we would have to fight sometime. But now we can look ahead to
constructive endeavors.' A professor reviewing the results of the
war declared: "It changed our nati nal morale from that of a de-
fented nation which believed it could do nothing - the heritage
of the Five Years War - to that of a victorious people with grow-
ing assurance and self-confidence." Paraguay 19 talking of recon-
struction. It recognizes it has to start almost from scratch. In
3 conversation with ex-President Ayala here in Buenos Aires, he
told me that a 1935 survey of Paraguay's 130,000 farmers revealed
that they possessed nly 5,000 steel plows. The seed commonly
used is old and run dawn. New seed, new implements would multiply
production and economic wealth. Given peace and the help of a
little foreign capital, Phraguay's leuders hope that they face
toward a future of growth and promise.
Regraded Uclassified
205
NEWS LETTER ON BRAZIL
FROM Charles A. Thomson
Foreign Policy Association
Confidential
Buenos Aires,
Not for publication.
September 25, 1938
On the night before I ended my month's stay in Brazil, I
met with at group of some twenty university professors, industrialists,
writers and economists, One of the questions we discussed referred
to Brazil's foreign policy, in the case of a European war. "Brazil
will never fight on the side of Germany," declared one member of the
group, and his statement found unanimous support. The talk brought
out - what ie always BO striking to anyone who has known the hostili-
ty to Yankee imperialism in many Spanish-American countries - Brazil's
strong tradition of close friendship with the United States. These
Brazilians hoped that the American states could keep out of a European
war, but, come what may, they held that the nations of the New World
should adopt and follow a common policy.
While realists tend to view President Vargas as a political
opportunist par excellence, no Brazilians I talked with seriously be-
lieved that Vargas would - no matter what flirtations he may have con-
sidered in the past - attempt to carry Brazil away from its century-
old alignment with the United States. In the field of trade Brazil
has been willing to talk business with all customers. In the new re-
armament program (to which I want to refer later), Germany won the
right to provide the bulk of supplies for the army. But geography,
historical tradition and economics are to be counted in the balance
on the side of the United States.
Moreover, internal factors influence Brazil's attitude to-
ward Germany. Brazilians have followed the negotiations on the Sud-
eten question with close attention. The arguments advanced for a
plebiscite and for the minority rights of German residente in Czecho-
slovakia could theoretically be urged also in favor of the German
colonies in Brazil. One journalist in a recent article opposed the
principle of plebiscites, suggesting that if one were held in Brazil,
the Dermans and their symptthizers might win a majority in the three
southern states of Parana, Santa Catharina and Rio Grande do Sul.
While this is an exaggerated statement, informed observers do not
cinimize the threat of German penetration. They believe that the
Nazis have been disposed to go just 38 far as they were permitted by
counter forces.
Representatives of one Brazilian party told me that within
the last six months they had been approached by certain Germens high
in the business world, who asked what their attitude would be should
the State of Rio Grande do Sul separate from Brazil to become a Ger-
man colony or protectorate. The Germans offered this party, in re-
turn for a pledge not to oppose such 3. move, war materials, troops
and other assistance to enable them to overturn the Vargas government
and take power in Rio, It W.B intimated that Italy would support the
German move. But the baited hook failed to bring a nibble.
There is great need for A thorough study - it would take
Biz months or a year - on the number and activities of Gormans,
Regraded Uclassified
206
-3-
Italians and Japanese in Brazil. Accurate facte are disappointingly
scarce. The last national census was taken in 1920, and the next
one 18 not due until 1940. Immigration statistics are an unsafe
guide, for no one knows to what degree their totals have been modi-
flod by emigration, deaths and other factors. The most recent govern-
ment estimatee place the number of Italiane in the country at 770,000;
of Japanese at 134,000; and of Germans at 73,000. This latter figure
seems incredioly low, since 8ao Paulo State alone estimates its Ger-
man population at 27,000; and the colonies resident in the other south-
matates of Parana, Santa Catharina and Rio Grande do Sul arellarger
in all probacility. But the Germans in Brazil have been significant
not alone for their number, but also for their close-knit organiza-
tion, and their aggressive zeal within recent years for spreading Nazi
doctrines and influence. This crusade finally became an open threat
to Brazilien unity; and the Vargas regime took steps to sootch the
darger. On April 19 last a decree barred foreigners and foreign organ-
izations from engaging in any political activity in Brazil, and also
foroade propeganda favoring political parties in the immigrante' home
lands. This measure was supplemented by laws in the States of Santa
Catharina and Rio Grande do Sul, requiring that teachers in German
and other foreign schools be Brazilians and classes be conducted in
Portuguese. Such was German resentment at these measures that the
Nazi "cultural attache" in the R1o emonesy, who was reported to have
mide éven the German Ambassador play second fiddle - the attaché was
a Nazi, while the Ambassador was not - left for Berlin by special
plane. It is not yet clear to what degree this political eet-back will
affect the German trade drive. For the first four months of 1938,
Germany retained the lead over the United States in Brazilian imports
it had won in 1936 and 1937.
At the same time President Vargas has eliminated from the
politionl scene Brazil's domestic fasciste, the Integralists. When
on November 10, 1937 he made himself absolute dictator of Brazil,
scrapped the 1934 constitution and proclaimed & more authoritarian
document, he had the active support of this strong, nation-wide par-
ty. The Integralists were led to expect they would play B. prominent
role in the new set-up, with one or more cabinet positions. (Leaders
of other Brazilian parties, experienced in the ways of local politics,
firmly believe the Integralists were receiving finanoiel aid from Ger-
many and Itely; they wore spending far more money than could reason-
aoly be secured from sources in Brazil). But once Vargas had consoli-
dated his position, the Integralists were thrown into the discard and
their party dissolved. After the abortive coup of last May, many of
their members were jailed. The party is now underground; some observ-
vr. oelieve it effectively crushed and its principal leaders discredit-
ed; other recall that it included numerous army and navy officers
among its supporters and hold that it still retains sufficient force
for at come-back should 3. favorable opportunity arise.
Thus President Vargas has taken action against both foreign
and domestic fascists, and has made clear that his rulo is dictator-
ship, Brazilian style. If you don't mind, I should like to put in
here a few words as to how Brazil, with its Portuguese tradition, lan-
suage and culture differs from Sprnish-American countries, For Var-
gas is only to be understood in connection with his milieu. One of
the lessons which 8. visit to Brazil teaches 18 that Brazilien condi-
tions must necessarily be defined in Brazilian terms.
Regraded Uclassified
207
-3-
The Brazilian largely lacks the Spanish sense of personal
dignity; he cares little for "front" or ceremony. He 16 informal,
casual. At times he 16 unbelievably casual. Witness the Integral-
1st attack on the Presidential Palace on May 11. The rebele did not
trouble to post guards at the gates of the palace grounds; people
drove in and out to see the fighting which was going on only twenty-
five yarda away. The Brazilian is tolerant, not fanatical. He
makes no fetish of abstract principle. He lacks the cruelty of the
Spaniard, He does not like to kill. The leader of the May revolt
was not shot, but given only 8 ten-year sentence. The Brazilian has
8 genius for compromise; he does not recognize sharp lines of divi-
sion: he does not make permanent enemies. Brazil does not have a
color lino, out rather a color zone - though the transition from
white to clack ranges by almost imperceptible stages. The same char-
acteristic may be applied to social and political alignments. Brazil
lacks 3. clear-cut Left and B. clear-cut Right. The men who today are
Vargas' enemies may be in his cnoinet tomorrow. It is largely true
that because President Vargas corresponde to this medium - and also
to I certain transitional stage in Brazil's political development -
he has been successful in holding power.
Hie government 16 of course a dictatorship. Talk of the
plebiscite which was to ratify the November 1937 constitution 18
seldom heard. President Vargas and his associates are reported to
feel they need not trouble with it. They apparently find it more
convenient to govern directly by decree, than bother with a legisle-
ture. Interventore or federal commissioners, named by Vargas to re-
place former governore, rule all states except one. Civil liberties
are at the whim of the authorities. Censorship muzzles the press;
there is no freedom of speech. One American remarked: "I never at-
tempt to discuss politics, except in small groups at private houses;
1 don't write about it in letters, for you nevar know when they will
be opened. Arrests are aroitrary. Just before I left Sao Paulo,
some twenty of the most important leaders in the Selles de Oliveira
party were seized at the order of the Interventor, and told they
could choose between imprisonment and exile from the city of São Paulo.
1 talked to men who had been imprisoned on suspicion for long periode.
They left no doubt in my mind 88 to the fact of extensive police bru-
tality. It was not "respectable" politicione who suffered, but al-
legud communists and to 2) lesser degree Integralists arrested after
the attempted coup of last May.
The Vargas regime rests primarily on the support of the ar-
my and navy. It is a military dictatorship; but it 18 more than that,
for it commande consideraole popular support, due to Vargas' virtuo-
sity at political juggling and conciliation, and to his courting of
the masses through social legislation and other mesns. The preoi-
dent's supreme political astuteness is accorded universal recognigion.
Varges does not talk; no one apparently knows what is in his mind, or
what ne will do next. He does not hold grudges; if he neede a man,
he will use him, no matter if that man has fought against him in the
past; but the discard awrite any man or party whose usefulness is
ended. The president oalonces the power of one political leader with
another, one state with a second, one general with his rival. A
foreign ooserver remarked: "Vargas has been double-crossing the
generale so fast, that he has them all dizzy; no one of them knows
now long he can stay on his horse." The president 18 Regraded careful Uclassified to 060
208
that no member of his administration achieves too great power or
position. Francisco Campos. Minister of the Interior and author of
the 1837 constitution, has seen his personal star wax and wane. His
reported admiration for fascist ideals is balanced by the democratic
sentiments of Dr. Oewaldo Aranha, Foreign Minister, former Ambassa-
dor at Washington and friend of the United States. In the army,
General Goes Monteiro, Chief of Staff, 18 played off against General
Dutra, Winister of War. These two men, formerly friendly, are now
reported to be at odde. Goes Monteiro 18 considered the more able and
intelligent of the two, and is rated Brazil's best stretegist; he was
the star pupil of General Gamelin, when the latter - now France's
Chief of Staff - W&B head of the French military mission in Brazil.
Gossip has it that Aranha and Goes Monteiro favor holding the consti-
tutional plebiscite and 3. gradual return to democratic norms, while
Dutra opposes the plebiscite, and is suspected by some of ambitions
to set himself up 08 the head of a neo-fasoist régime. Talk of Var-
gas' possible overthrow turne most frequently on the Dutra-Goes Mon-
teiro rivalry and friction.
President Vargas announced with his November 1937 coup the
establishment of a New State in Brazil. Democracy had failed; Bra-
zil henceforth was to have an authoritarian regime, which would uni-
fy the country in the face of a chaotic international situation, sup-
press subversive influences, and put new efficiency and drive into
government. But what in practice, as distinguished from theory, does
the New State stand for?
1. Direct government, that is, personal dictatorship. Vargas has
ruled Brazil since the revolution of 1930, but there is some truth
in the contention that events have limited his opportunities for con-
structive achievement. Between 1930 and 1934, attention necessarily
centered first on consolidation of the new regime, then its defense
against the 1932 Paulists revolt, and finally on the drafting of the
1934 constitution. The first Congress under this constitution was
characterized by one foreign resident as "worse than B. Ladies Aid
Society"; talk blocked action. But with Congress out of the way af-
ter Novemoer 1937, governmental machinery began to hum. Office-
holders were foroidden to hold more than one job; and the efficiency
of the oureau cracy was stepped up. Some of the worst grafters were
eliminated. (In this connection Vargas is generally credited with
entire personal honesty.) The president and his advisers turned out
decrees much more swiftly than Congress had produced laws. Since
November 1937 it 1s stated that 500 laws and 3000 decrees have been
issued. But much of this legislation is hastily and carelessly
drafted. Formerly debate in Congress served to iron out defocts,
but now that chance is lost.
G. Centralized government, as opposed to the former emphasis on state's
rights, which in Brazil has been carried farther than in the United
States. To use 8. word coined by Foreign Kinister Aranha in en inter-
view. the tendency was to "Chinafy" Brazil. In several cases the
state militias were armice in all but name; and some were equipped
with tanks and bomoing planos. Brazil's only anti-airornft guns were
ordered by Governor Flores da Cunha for the state forces of Rio
Grande do Sul, but arrived after he had been ousted. States had the
power to levy export duties. NOW President Varges has reduced the
Regraded Uclassified
-5-
209
power of the milities, particularly in those states where they might
be used against him; and also decreed progressive elimination of the
state export duties. Opposition to this trend toward centralization
10 strongest in Sao Paulo, Brazil's richest and most productive state,
which seeks as far aB possible to run its own affairs.
3. Nationalism. I have already mentioned the legislation against for-
eign organizations, and the quietue put on German activities. In ad-
dition the November 1937 constitution required the shareholders of
canke and insurance companies to be Brazilians (a provision not yet
enforced) and pointed toward the progressive navionalization of
mines and waterpower. Last April a decree excluded foreign interests
from the petroleum industry, just at the time when B. large refinery
of Standard 011 of New Jersey was about to begin operations,
4. Rearmament. Along with the nationalistic emphasis has gone a pro-
gram to strongthen the armed forces. This had been under discussion
for years, but the November coup freed Vargas' hands for immediate
action. Brazil plans to spend some $100,000,000 on this program dur-
Ing the next five years. According to an agreement concluded before
the President fell out with the Nazis, Germany 18 to provide the bulk
of matorial for the army - heavy artillery, light artillery, anti-
aircraft guns, etc. Brazil is scheduled to receive from Germany each
year for the next five years 60,000,000 marks worth of supplies, or
5. total of 250,000,000 marks. Of this sum, approximately five-sixths
uan be paid in compensated marks, and the balance in free exchange.
(Thus in spite of Washington's efforts to discourage Brazil's experi-
ments in barter trade, the country - barring a European war - is com-
mitted by this arms agreement to compensated marks for at least five
years. A high military authority told me he considered the dependence
of Brazil's army on German supplies a great mistake; should a Europe-
AR conflict break, Brazil would be cut off from Germany, would have
to turn to the United States for munitions, and would 00 handicapped
by at confusing variety of modele in ite armament.) For the navy
three submarines were bought from Italy, and negotiations are reported
under way for three more. Three cruisers were ordered from England,
and three others are to be built in Brazil, using fabricated material
from the United States. In this way Brazil plans to secure the
cruisers which it originally proposed to lease from the United States.
Some observers view Brazil's failure to obtain those cruis-
BTE as 2 crucial event profoundly influencing the recent trend to-
ward dictatorship. According to this theory, the success of Argen-
tinn in blocking the proposed deal spread consternation among Brazil-
ian leaders. Brazil had believed it enjoyed a favored position in
American friendship. But Argenting, its most feared rival, had boen
able to ruin its prospects. President Vargas 16 reported to have
pelled together army and navy chiefe and pledged them his support in
ouilding up Brazil's armed strength against this threatening develop-
ment. Thus was oorn the alliance which made possible the November
1937 coup. For only Vargas could give the military leaders the money
they wanted. Both of the leading candidates in the presidential cam-
polgn of that year had ooligations to various intereste end support-
ere; neither would be strong enough to take the step which alone could
make possible the enlarged expenditures for the armament program -
suspension of service on the foreign deot. go the elections were
called off, and Vargas with the backing of the army and navy made him-
self acsolute dictator. Now the armed forces are gotting what they
want, and resumption of service on the foreign debt 18 a dend issue.
Regraded Uclassified
210
5. Brazil toward the "corporative organization of national economy,
A
"mixed" economic policy. While the 1937 constitution pointed
the most important recent shift in policy - that relating to coffee
exports in the fall of 1937 - was away from regimentation and in the
direction of liberalism and free trade. The government abandoned
price defense, and the coffee export tax was reduced from 45 to 12
milreis B. bag. But in May of this year over-production again threat-
ened, and a decree required each grower to turn over to the government
a "sacrifice quote" of 30% of his production (15% in the case of the
finer coffees). However, coffee experts with whom I talked believe
that Brazil is approaching an equilibrium between production and mar-
ket demand. In the state of Bao Paulo alone between 300,000,000 and
400,000,000 trees have been out down; the coffee borer has reduced
output; there seems to be growing recognition that future emphasis
must be on improvement of quality rather than increase of quantity.
Hopes are expressed that the quota provision may be removed early in
1939, and future reestablishment of control avoided.
The fall in the world price of coffee has been compensated
in the case of Brazil by a quantitative increase in exports. None-
theless Brezil has suffered a recent recession; internal trade is
estimated at about 25% below last year, but the decline has been
less severe than in the United States.
The Brazilian government railroads have under considera-
tion purchase of 26 locomotives and 1000 freight cars, worth some
$6,000,000. The Cermans are after the order, and are reported to
have offered four-year credits, but are unable to promise prompt
delivery. Americans in Brazil, in view of the country's great need
for improved and more extensive communications, argue that it is of
strategic importance for the United States to secure this ordor. At
the time of my stay, decision promised to hinge on the ability of the
Export-Import Bank to offer credit terms which might compete with
those of the Dermans.
6. Social legislation. The Vargas regime since 1930 has been respon-
sible for = large mass of sooial legislation, including the 8-hour
day, one day's rest in seven, special protection for women and chil-
dren, and now a minimum-wage law which 18 soon to go into effect.
While labor supporters deny that this legislation has been very ef-
fective, employers report that it is enforced to an uncomfortable de-
gree. Labor organization is under government control. Unions are
organized by the government, protected by the government and subor-
dinate to the government. Strikes are forbidden. In São Paulo city
the cost of living index rose from 100 in 1934 to 161 in 1938, the
chief increases being in food items; but in other parte of Brazil,
particularly the rural districts, the rise was 1006 marked. Studies
made in Sao Paulo estimate 10 milreis (about fifty cents in U. S.
currency) to be the minimum living wage, to provide bare necessities
for a family of five; but the great bulk of the wago-earners are re-
ported to receive less than this minimum figure.
7. President Vargas has yet to show achievement in a field where a
dictator usually makes his greatest claims - that of public works.
One of the most frequently repeated charges made against him 18 that
he la not a builder, Brazilian cities, such as Rio de Janeiro, 8&o
Regraded Uclassified
211
-7-
Paulo and Bello Horizonte, have edifices been going have through erected. B. construction But
Brazil boom, has almost no paved roads, outside a ten-mile stretch
and many new government of been
south of the city of São Paulo, and the section connecting the
summer capital at Petropolis with Rio. Vargas has promised to ini-
ABCEB also have under survey the route of a railroad across the
tiste shortly paving of the road between Rio and 840 Paulo. Engi-
northern edge of the Chaco to link the Brazilian oity of Puerto Ea-
peranca with Santa Cruz in Bolivia. But these developments are still
substantially in the project stage.
Discussion 16 again under way on plans to exploit Brazil's
not 0:0 deposits in Minas Geraes, much of which run 60% pure iron.
The lack of good coal has handicapped development of heavy industry,
out : number of blast furnaces and mills are now operating with char-
coal and petroleum; this year Brazil exported some steel to Argentina.
Opticiam is expressed in certain circles at the possibilities of a
process for smelting at low temperatures. Some of Brazil's
present loaders argue that if the country is to escape from E colon
lal status, where it exports raw materials and competee with/low
economic and social levels, it must industrialize, and should exhaust
all efforts to that end.
How long oan Vargas stay in power? No one in Brazil will
anawor thia question, for no one knows. The President's wizardry at
political juggling 18 an essential element in his success. But it
also makes for almost a daily shift in guesses and for continuing un-
certainty concerning the eventual trend of Brazilian politics. No
one knows when Vargas' hand may slip and some one of the many balls
in the air may escape his grasp. The most experienced observers
take refuge in the assertion that practically anything can happen.
There are some who believe that opposition to the present régime is
gradually coolescing. Yet this opposition may lack opportunity to
strike, unless Vargas suffere defection on the part of hie military
associates, or the economic curve takes an acute turn downward.
Should he hold on indefinitely, the continuance of dictatorship or a
gradual roturn to democratic processes 18 likely to be determined by
the relative strength of the various domestic and international pres-
suree which play or. the "fox of Oattete."
I don't want to close without at least a brief reference to
the matter of cultural relations. This 18 not the time for any de-
silled analysis or definite recommendations. But my whole visit to
Brazil only served to underline the words of Foreign Minister Aranha
that "it is terribly important for our two peoples to understand each
other." It is substantially true that we in the United States know
least 18. sbout the country in South America which is most important to
Let me limit myself here to two or three items which bear
Dr. this subject. First, Brazilians reveal to B. unique degree a
idespread desire, B. genuine eagerness for closer ties of understand-
125 with the people of the United States. One American diplomatic
officer remarked, "We official representatives usually have to work
very hard to develop interest in our country; here we have that In-
that TO have come to take their friendship for granted; and that we
wrest served to ua on a silver platter." Yet many Brazilians feel
believe no particular effort is necessary to retain it. One writer
Regraded Uclassified
212
-8-
sold Be: "The United States has abandoned us; we are a nation of
43,000,000 people; we play an important role in South America; but
you win us for fasciem. They furnish material to our newspapers;
pay no attention to us. Italy and Germany are doing their best
50 (3) have our journalists in their pay. They send us professors and
lecturers. They give us radio oroadcasts in Portuguese. But the
United States 18 losing us. You need not copy fascist methods. But
" need your active interest and support.'
The situation in São Paulo University may serve as B. case
in point on the present situation. On its arts faculty are ten Ital-
tan professore and eight French. In addition to their Brazilian
salary (which is low in comparison with foreign standards of living),
their home salary is continued, their time in Brazil is considered
double for a retirement allowance, and they are granted travelling
expenses to return home once a year. The only American professor on
the faculty is without any of these perquisites, which actually do
not rank as luxuries, but serve to balance up the debit items involved
in working abroad. His role is not that of propagandist - certainly
not, in the narrow and derogatory sense of the word, He 18 trying
to do e sound and scholarly job of teaching American history. In
addition, hie command of Portuguese has opened to him newspaper
columns, which have given his interpretations of American life a
wide audience. Yet he has no support from his home land. In a Bitu-
ation which is complex and unstable he stands lone.
I cite this particular instance only because it illustrates
a definite problem, on which we have yet to make any effective at-
tack,
Regraded Uclassified
213
IM
NEWS LETTER ON BRAZIL
FROM Charles A. Thomson
Foreign Policy issociation
Confidential
Buenos Aires,
LOL for publication.
September 26, 1938
(m. the night before I ended my month's stay in Brasil, I
at with a group of some twenty university professors, industrialists,
writers and economists. One of the questions " discussed referred
to Brazil's foreign policy. in the case of a European war, "Frasil
will never fight on the side of Germany," declared one member of the
group, and his statement found unanimous support. The talk brought
out -- what is always so striking to anyone who has known the hostill-
ty to Yankee imperialism in many Spanish-American countries - Brazil's
strong tradition of close friendship with the United States. These
Brazilians hoped that the American states could keep out of AL Miropean
yes, but, date what may, they held that the nations of the New world
should adopt and follow a common policy.
while realists tend to view President Vargas AS & political
opportunist par excellence, no Brazilians I talked with seriously be-
lieved that Vargas would - no matter what flirtations he my have con-
aidered in the past - attempt to carry Brasil away from its century-
old alignment with the United States. In the field of trade Brazil
has been willing to talk business with all customers. In the new M-
armament program (to which I want to refer later), Germany won the
right to provide the bulk of supplies for the army. But geography,
historical tradition and economics are to be counted in the balance
on the side of the United States.
Moreover, internal factors influence Brasil's attitude to-
wird Germany. Brazilians have followed the negotiations on the Sud-
stea question with close attention. The arguments advanced for &
plobiacite and for the minority rights of German residents in Caecho-
slovakia could theoretically be urged also in favor of the German
colonies in Brazil. One journalist in a recent article opposed the
principle of plebiscites, suggesting that if one were held in Brasil,
the Cermans and their sympathisers might win & majority in the three
southern states of Parana, Santa Catherina and Rio Grande do Sul.
While this is an exaggerated statement, informed observers do not
minimize the threat of Derman penstration. They believe that the
Namis have been disposed to go just as far as they were permitted by
counter forces.
Representatives of one Mrasilian party told me that within
tax last six months they had been approached by certain Cermins high
in the business world, who susticed what their attitude would be should
Sam State of Rio Grande do sal separate from Brasil to become A. Gar-
RAN colony or protectorate. The Gormane offered this party. in re-
turn for & pledge not to oppose such a move, war materials, troops
and other assistance to enable them to overturn the Vargas government
Regraded Uclassified
214
8 -
now take power in Rio. It was intimated that Italy would support the
German move. But the bailed hook failed to bring a. nibble.
There is great need for a thorough study. - it would take
ore months or a year -- on the number and activities of Germans,
Italians and Japanese in Brasil. Accurate facts are di i sappointingly
The last national census was taken in 1930, and the next
one is not due until 1940. Immigration statistics are an unsafe
guide. for no one knows to what degree their totals have been modi-
find by emigration. deaths and other factors. The most recent govern-
ment estimates place the number of Italians in the country at 770,000)
of Japanese at 134,000; and of Germans at 73,000. This latter figure
seome incredibly low. since Sao Paulo State alone estimates its Oer-
seall population as 27,000: and the colonies resident in the other south-
orn states of Parana, Santa Catharina and Hio Grande do Sul are larger
in all probability. But the Germans in Brasil have been significant
not alone for their number, but also for their closs-knit organiza-
tion, and their aggressive seal within recent years for spreading Nami
doctrines and influence. This crusade finally because an open threat
to Brasilian unity: and the Vargas regime took steps to scotch the
danger. On April 19 last a decree barred foreigners and foreign organ-
isations from engaging in any political activity in Brasil, and also
forbade propaganda favoring political parties in the immigrants' home
lands. This neasure was supplemented by laws in the States of Santa
Catharina and Rio Orande do Sul, requiring that teachers an German
and other foreign schools be Brasilians and classes be conducted in
Fortuguese. Such was German resentment at these measures that the
Bazi "cultural attache" in the Rio embassy, who was reported to have
made even the German Ambassador play second fiddle -- the attache was
A Razi, while the Ambasandor was not - left for Berlin by special
plane. It is not yet clear to what degree this political set-back will
Affect the Cerman trade drive. For the first four months of 1938,
Germany retained the lead over the United States in Brasilian imports
11 and won in 1936 and 1937.
At the same time President Vargna nas eliminated from the
political scene Braxil's domestic fasciate. the Integralists. When
on November 10, 1937 he made himself absolute dictutor of Brasil,
scrapped the 1934 constitution and proclaimed A more authoritarian
document, he had the active support of this strong. nation-wide par-
W. The Integralists were led to expect they would play B. prominent
role in the new est-up, with one or more cabinet positions. (Leaders
of other Brasilian parties. experienced in the ways of local politics,
firmly believe the Integralists were receiving financial aid from Gar-
many and Italy: they were spending INT more money than could reason-
ably be secured from sources in Brasil). But onde Vargus had consoli-
dated his position, the Integralists were thrown into the discard and
Regraded Uclassified
- 3 -
their party dissolved. After the abortive soup of last May, many of
their members were jailed. The party is now underground: some observ-
era Delieve it effectively crushed and its principal leaders discredit-
ad: others recall that it included numerous Army and navy of ficers
its supporters and hold that it still retains sufficient force
for - come-back should E, favorable opportunity arize.
Inis President Vargas has taken action against both foreign
AOD domestic fascists, and has made clear that his rule is dictator-
ship. Grazilian style. If you don't mind, I should like to put in
are a few words as to how Brazil, with its Portuguese tradition, lan-
(Wift and culture differs from Spanish-American countries. For Var-
668 15 only to be understood in connection with his milieu. One of
the 1993009 which a visit to Brasil teaches is that Brasilian condi-
LIVAR mut awcessarily be defined in Brazilian terms.
The Brasilian largely lacks the Spanish sense of personal
he wares little for "front" or ceremony. He is informal,
cusual. At times he is unbelievably casual. Witness the Integral-
1st attack on the Presidential Palace on May 11. The rebels did not
trouble to poes guards at the gates of the palace grounds; people
drove in and out to see the fighting which ma coing on only twenty-
five yarus away. The Bravilian is tolerant, not fanatical. Be
makes no fetish of abstract principle. He lacks the cruelty of the
Spaniard. de doe a not like to kill. The lender of the May revolt
was not shot, but given only EL ten-year sentence. The Brazilian has
& genius for compromise: he does not recognize sharp lines of divi-
sicnt he does not make permanent enemies. Brasil does not have a
color line, but rather & color zone - though the transition from
shite to black ranges by almost imperceptible stages. The same char-
acteristic may be applied to social and political alignments. Brazil
lacks a clear-cut Left and & clear-cut Right. The nen who today are
Vargas' enemies may be in his cabinet tomorrow. It 1n largely true
that because President Vargas corresponds to this medium -- and also
to A. certain transitional stage in Brasil's political development -
he are been successful in holding power.
His government is of course A. dictatorship. Talk of the
plobiscite which was to ratify the November 1937 constitution is
amizon heard. President Vargas and his associates are reported to
feol they need not trouble with 11. They apparently find 1t more
convenient to govern directly by decree. than bother with a. legiala-
ture. Interventors or federal commissioners, named by Vargna to :-
place former governors. rule all states except one. Civil liberties
are B.C the whim of the authorities. Censcrship missles the press:
Regraded Uclassified
216
there is no freedom of speech. One American remarked: *1 never at
tempt to discuss politics, except in small groups at private houses;
I don't write about it in letters. for you never know when they will
be opened." Arrosts are arbitrary. Just before I left Sao Paulo,
some twenty of the most important leaders in the Salles de Oliveira
party were seised at the order of the Interventor, and told they
could choose between imprisonment and exile from the city of See Paulo.
I talked to men who had been imprisoned on suspicion for long periods.
They left до doubt in my mind as to the fact of extensive police bru-
tality. It was not "respectable" politicians who suffered, but al-
leged comministe and to a lesser dagree Integraliste arrested after
the attempted coup of last May.
The Vargas regise reste primarily on the support of the ar-
my and navy. It is & military dictatorship; but it is more VIAD that,
for it commands considerable popular support, due to Vargas' virtuo-
sity at political juggline and conciliation, and to his courting of
the masses through social legislation and other means. The presi-
dent's supreme political astuteness is accorded universal recognition.
Vargas does not talk; no one apparently knows what is in his mind, or
what he will do next. He does not hold grudges; if he needs a man,
he will use him, no matter if that man has fought against him in the
past: but the discard awaits any man or party whose usefulness is
ended. The president balances the power of one political leader with
another, one state with & second, one general with his rival. A
foreign observer remarked: "Vargas has been double-crossing the
generals so fast, that he has them all dissy: no one of them knows
how long be can stay on his horse." The president is careful to ses
that no member of his administration achieves too great power or
position. Francisco Campos, Minister of the Interior and anthor of
the 1937 constitution, has seen his personal star all and walls. His
reported admiration for fascist ideals is balanced by the democratic
sentiments of Dr. Oswaldo Aranha, Foreign Minister, former Ambasca-
dor at Washington and friend of the United States. In the army,
General Goes Monteiro, Chief of Staff, is played off against General
Dutra, Minister of War, These two men, formerly friendly. are now
reported to be at odds. Goes Monteiro is considered the more able and
intelligent of the two, and is rated Brazil's best strategist; he was
the star pupil of General Gamelin, when the latter -- now France's
Chief of Staff - WILLS head of the French military mission in Brasil.
Gossip has 16 that Aranha and Goes Monteiro favor holding the consti-
tutional plebiscite and a gradual return to democrable Borms, while
Dutra opposes the plebiscise, and is suspected by BOZE of embitions
to set himself up se the head of a neo-fascist regime. Talk of Var-
possible overthrow turns most frequently on the Datra-Goes Mon-
teiro rivalry and friction.
Regraded Uclassified
217
- 5 -
President Vargas announced with his November 1937 coup the
establ ishimit of & New State in Brazil. Democracy had failed: Bra-
sil henceforth was to have an authoritarian regime, which would uni-
IV the country in the face of & chaotic international situation, oup-
press subversive influences, and put new efficiency and drive into
government. But what in practice, AS distinguished from theory, does
the Sew State stand for?
1. Direct government, that 1s. personal dictatorship. Vargas has
ruled Brazil since the revolution of 1930, but there is some truth
in the contention that events have limited his opportunities for con-
structive achievement. Between 1930 and 1934, attention necessarily
centered first on consolidation of the new regime, then its defense
against the 1932 Paulista revolt, and finally on the drafting of the
1934 constitution. The first Congress under this constitution was
characterised by one foreign resident as "worse than a Ladies Aid
Society": talk blocked action. But with Congress out of the way af-
ter November 1937, governmental machinery began to hum. Office-
holders were forbidden to hold more than one job; and the efficiency
of the bureaucracy was stepped up. Some of the worst grafters were
eliminated. (In this connection Vargas is generally credited with
entire personal honesty.) The president and his advisers turned out
decrees much more swiftly than Congress had produced laws. Since
November 1937 it is stated that 500 laws and 3000 decrees have been
issued- But much of this legislation is hastily and carelessly
drafled. Formerly debate in Congress served to iron out defects,
but now that chance is lost.
2. Centralized government. as opposed to the former emphasis on state's
rights, which in Brasil has been carried farther than in the United
States. To use a word coined by Foreign Mainster Aranha in an inter-
view, the tendency was to "Chinafy" Brazil. In several cases the
state milities were armies in all but name: and some were equipped
with tanks and bombing planes. Braxil's only anti-aircraft guns were
ordered by Governor Flores da Cunha for the state forces of Rio
Grande do Sul, but arrived after he bad been ousted. States had the
power to levy export duties. Now President Vargas has reduced the
power of the militins. particularly in those states where they might
be used against him: and also decreed progressive elimination of the
state export duties. Opposition to this trend toward centrolization
is strongest in Sao Paulo, Brasil's richest and most productive state,
which seeks AS far as possible to run its own affairs.
3. Nationallam. I have already mentioned the legislation against for-
eign organizations, and the quietus put on German activities. In ad-
dition the dovember 1937 constitution required the shareholders of
Regraded Uclassified
218
- 6 -
banks and insurance companies to be Brazilians (a provision not yet
enforced) and pointed toward the progressive nationalization of
mines and waterpower. Last April n decree excluded foreign interests
from the petroleum industry, just at the time when a large refinery
of Standard Oil of New Jersey was about to begin operations.
4. convent- Along with the nationalistic emphasis has gone a pro-
gram to strengthen the arned forces. This had been under discussion
for yours, but the November coup freed Vargas' hands for impediate
action. Brazil plans to spend some $100,000,000 on this program dur-
ing the next five years. According to an agreement concluded before
the President fell out with the Masis, Germany 1a to provide the bulk
of material for the army - heavy artillery, light artillery. enti-
aircraft etc. Brasil is scheduled to receive from Germany each
your for the next five years 50,000,000 marks worth of supplise, or
8. total of 250,000,000 marks. of this sum, approximately five-sixths
can be paid in compensated marks, and the balance in free exchange.
(Thus in spite of Washington's efforts to discourage Brazil's experi-
ments in barter trade, the country - barring 8 European war -- is 008-
mitted by this arm agreement to compensated marks for at least five
years. A high military authority told me he considered the dependence
of Brazil's army OA German supplies a great mistake: should a Europe-
an conflict break, Brasil would be out off from Germany, would have
to turn to the United States for munitions, and would be handicapped
by & confusing variety of models in its areament.) For the navy
three submarines were bought from Italy, and negotiations are reported
under way for three more. Three cruisers were ordered from Ragland,
and three others are to be built in Brasil, using fabricated material
from the United States. In this way Brasil plans to secure the
cruisers which it originally proposed to lease from the United States.
Some observers view Brasil's failure to obtain those cruis-
ora as & crucial event profoundly influencing the recent grand to-
ward dictatorship. According to this theory, the success of Argen-
tine in blocking the proposed deal spread consternation among Brasil-
isn leaders. Brasil had Melieved it enjoyed & favored position in
American friendship. But Argentina, its most feared rival, had been
able to ruin its prospects. President Vargas is reported to have
called together army and DATY chiefe and pledged them his support in
building up Brazil's armed strength against this threatening develop-
ment. Time was born the alliance which made possible the November
1957 coup. For only Vargas could give the military leaders the money
they munted. Both of the leading candidates in the presidential onli-
paign of that year had obligations to various interests and support-
*7*1 neither would be strong enough to take the stop which alone could
Regraded Uclassified
219
- 7 -
make possible the enlarged expenditures for the areament program -
suspension of service on the foreign debt. So the elections were
called off. and Vargas with the backing of the army and havy made him-
self absolute dictator. Now the armed forces are getting what they
want, and resumption of service on the foreign debt is a dend issue.
5. A "mixed" economic policy. While the 1937 constitution pointed
Brasil toward the "corporative organisation of national economy,"
the most important recent shift in policy - that relating to coffee
exports in the fall of 1937 - was away from regimentation and in the
direction of liberalism and free trade. The government abandoned
price defense. and the coffee export tax was reduced from 45 to 12
milrois B. bas. But in May of this year over-production again threat-
ened, and & decree required each grower to turn over to the government
5. "sacrifice quota" of 30% of his production (15% in the case of the
finer coffees). However, coffee experts with whom I talked believe
that Brasil is approaching an squilibrium between production and mr.
ket demand. In the state of Sao Paulo alone between 300,000,000 and
400,000,000 trees have been out down: the coffee borer has reduced
output: there seems to be growing recognition that future suphasis
must be on improvement of quality rather than increase of quantity.
Hopes are expressed that the quota provision may be removed early in
1939, and future recatablishment of control avoided.
The fall in the world price of coffee has been compensated
in the case of Brasil by a quantitative increase in exports. None-
theless Brasil has suffered at recent recession; internal trade is
estimated at about 25% below last year, but the decline has been
less severe than in the United States.
The Brasilian government railroads have under considers-
tion purchase of 26 locomotives and 1000 freight cars, worth some
$6,000,000. The Germans are after the order, and are reported to
have offered four-year credits, but are unable to promise prompt
delivery. Americans in Brasil, in view of the country's great need
for improved and more extensive comminications, argue that 11 is of
strategic importance for the United States to secure this order. AL
the time of my stay, decision promised to hings on the ability of the
Export-Import Bank to offer aredit serms which might compete with
those of the Germans.
6. Social legislation. The Vargas regime since 1930 has been respon-
sible for a large mass of social legislation, including the B-hour
day. one day's rest in seven, special protection for woman and ahil-
dren, and now a minisum-wa.go law which 19 soon to 60 into effoot.
Regraded Iclassified
220
- 8 -
Regraded Uclassified
while labor supporters design that this legislation has been very of-
fective. employers report was it is enforced to an uncomfortable no-
gree. Labor organisation is under government control. Unions are
organised by the government. protected by the government and subor-
dinete to the government. Strikes are forbidden. In Sao Peulo city
the coat of living index rose from 100 in 1934 to 161 in 1938, the
chief indreases being in food items; but in other parts of Brasil,
particularly the rural districts, the rise was lecs marked. Studies
made in Sao Paulo estimate 10 Milrois (about fifty cente in U. S.
currency) to be the minimum living wage, to provide bare necessities
for a family of five: but the great bulk of the wage-earners are re-
ported to receive less than this minimum figure.
7. President Vargas has yet to show ashievement in & field where a
dictator usually makes his greatest claims - that of public works.
One of the most frequently repeated charges made against him is that
he is not & builder. Brazilian cities, such as Rio de Janeiro, 8no
Paulo and Bello Horizonte, have been going through a construction
boom, and many new government edifices have been erected. But
Brazil has almost no paved roads, outside of a ten-mile stretch
south of the city of Sao Paulo, and the section connecting the
summer capital at Petropolis with Rio. Vargas has promised to ini-
tiate shortly paving of the road between Rio and Sao Paulo. Engi-
neers also have under survey the route of a railroad across the
northern edge of the Chaco to link the Brasilian city of Puerto 30-
peranda with Santa Crus in Bolivia. But these developments are otill
substantially in the project stage.
Discussion is again under may on plans to exploit Brasil's
vast ore deposits in Minas Geraes, much of which run 60% pare iron.
The Lack of good coal has handicapped development of heavy industry,
but & number of blast furnaces and mills are now operating with char-
coal and petroleum; this year Brasil exported some stool to Argentina.
Optimism 18 expressed in certain circles at the possibilities of a
new process for smalting at low temperatures. Some of Brasil's
present leaders argue that if the country is to escape from a colon-
ial status, where it exports raw materials and competes with plantation
countries with low economic and social levels, it must industrialise,
and should exhaust all afforts to that and.
How long can Vargas stay in power? No one in Brasil will
answer this question, for no one known. The President's wisardry at
political juggling is all examintial alement in his success. But it
Also makes for almost a daily shift in guesses and for continuing -
certainty concerning the eventual trend of Brasilian polition. No
one knows when Targas' hand may slip and some one of the may balls
in the air may escape his grasp. The most experienced observers
221
-
take refuge in the assertion that practically anything own happen.
There are some who believe that apposition to the present regine is
gradually coalescing. Yet this opposition my lack opportunity to
strike, unless Vargas suffers defection on the part of his military
associates. or the sconomic curve takes an agute turn downward.
Should be hold on indefinitely, the continuance of dictatorship or a
gradual return to democratic processes is libely to be determined by
the relative strength of the various domestic and international pres-
sures which play on the "fox of Cattete."
I don't want to close without at least a brief reference to
the matter of cultural relations. This is not the time for eny de-
tailed analysis or definite recommendations. But my whole visit to
Brazil only served to underline the words of Foreign Minister Aranha
that "1t is terribly important for our two peoples to understand each
other." It is substantially true that we in the United States know
least about the country in South America which is most important to
us.
Let me limit myself here to two or three items which bear
on this subject. First, Brasilians reveal to & unique degree &
sidespread desire, & genuine eagerness for closer ties of understand-
ing with the people of the United States. One American diplomatic
officer remarked, "Ve official representatives usually have to work
very hard to develop interest in our country; here we have that in-
terost served to us an & silver platter." Yet many Brazilians feel
that we have come to take their friendship for granted: and that we
believe no particular effort is necessary to retain it. One writer
told me: "The United States has abandoned us; NO are & nation of
40,000,000 people: we play an important role in South America: but
you pay no attention to us. Italy and Germany are doing their best
to win us for fascism. They furnish material to our newspapers:
they have our journalists in their pay. They send us professors and
lecturers. They give us radio broadcasts in Portuguese. But the
United States is losing us. You need not copy fascist methods. 2N15
ve need your active interest and support."
The situation in Sao Paulo University my serve as & case
in point on the present situation. On its arts faculty are ten Ital-
lan professore and eight French. In addition to their Brasilian
salary (which is low in comparison with foreign standards of living),
their home salary is continued, their time in Brasil is considered
double for a retirement allowance, and they are granted travelling
expenses to return home once a year. The only American professor on
the faculty is without any of these perquisites. which actually do
not rank as luxuries, but serve to balance up the debit item involved
Regraded Uclassified
222
- 10 -
in working abroad. His role is not that of propagandist - certainly
not, in the narrow and derogatory sense of the word. He is trying
to do a sound and scholarly job of teaching American history. In
addition, his command of Portuguese has opened to him newspaper
columns, which have given his interpretations of American life a
wide audience. Yet he has no support from his home land. In a situ-
ation which is complex and unstable he stands alone.
I cite this particular instance only because it illustrates
& definite problem, on which we have yet to make any effective at-
tack.
Regraded Jclassified
Relations
belongs_to
belongs_to